Transaction Hash:
Block:
14963711 at Jun-14-2022 08:35:35 PM +UTC
Transaction Fee:
0.017550692462411976 ETH
$55.39
Gas Used:
406,668 Gas / 43.157298982 Gwei
Emitted Events:
| 160 |
FiatTokenProxy.0xddf252ad1be2c89b69c2b068fc378daa952ba7f163c4a11628f55a4df523b3ef( 0xddf252ad1be2c89b69c2b068fc378daa952ba7f163c4a11628f55a4df523b3ef, 0x000000000000000000000000afdae0ab2a6351ab57b10c9f0031aa59ab40e6ea, 0x00000000000000000000000074de5d4fcbf63e00296fd95d33236b9794016631, 00000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000006fc23ac00 )
|
| 161 |
FiatTokenProxy.0xddf252ad1be2c89b69c2b068fc378daa952ba7f163c4a11628f55a4df523b3ef( 0xddf252ad1be2c89b69c2b068fc378daa952ba7f163c4a11628f55a4df523b3ef, 0x00000000000000000000000074de5d4fcbf63e00296fd95d33236b9794016631, 0x000000000000000000000000220bda5c8994804ac96ebe4df184d25e5c2196d4, 00000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000006fc23ac00 )
|
| 162 |
Fei.Transfer( from=0xdf50Fbde8180c8785842C8E316EBe06F542D3443, to=0x220bdA5c8994804Ac96ebe4DF184d25e5c2196D4, value=30005628948147938851312 )
|
| 163 |
FiatTokenProxy.0xddf252ad1be2c89b69c2b068fc378daa952ba7f163c4a11628f55a4df523b3ef( 0xddf252ad1be2c89b69c2b068fc378daa952ba7f163c4a11628f55a4df523b3ef, 0x000000000000000000000000220bda5c8994804ac96ebe4df184d25e5c2196d4, 0x000000000000000000000000df50fbde8180c8785842c8e316ebe06f542d3443, 00000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000006fc23ac00 )
|
| 164 |
0xdf50fbde8180c8785842c8e316ebe06f542d3443.0xc42079f94a6350d7e6235f29174924f928cc2ac818eb64fed8004e115fbcca67( 0xc42079f94a6350d7e6235f29174924f928cc2ac818eb64fed8004e115fbcca67, 0x000000000000000000000000220bda5c8994804ac96ebe4df184d25e5c2196d4, 0x000000000000000000000000220bda5c8994804ac96ebe4df184d25e5c2196d4, fffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffff9a5643f984b88430610, 00000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000006fc23ac00, 0000000000000000000000000000000000000000000010c65d27cdebb38939be, 0000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000f5d4e70fdf1a825a3a, fffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffbc899 )
|
| 165 |
Fei.Approval( owner=0x220bdA5c8994804Ac96ebe4DF184d25e5c2196D4, spender=Vault, value=30005628948147938851312 )
|
| 166 |
Vault.Swap( poolId=90291319F1D4EA3AD4DB0DD8FE9E12BAF749E84500020000000000000000013C, tokenIn=Fei, tokenOut=[Receiver] WETH9, amountIn=30005628948147938851312, amountOut=25120686804254053317 )
|
| 167 |
Fei.Transfer( from=0x220bdA5c8994804Ac96ebe4DF184d25e5c2196D4, to=Vault, value=30005628948147938851312 )
|
| 168 |
Fei.Approval( owner=0x220bdA5c8994804Ac96ebe4DF184d25e5c2196D4, spender=Vault, value=0 )
|
| 169 |
WETH9.Transfer( src=Vault, dst=0x220bdA5c8994804Ac96ebe4DF184d25e5c2196D4, wad=25120686804254053317 )
|
| 170 |
WETH9.Withdrawal( src=0x220bdA5c8994804Ac96ebe4DF184d25e5c2196D4, wad=25120686804254053317 )
|
| 171 |
0x881d40237659c251811cec9c364ef91dc08d300c.0xbeee1e6e7fe307ddcf84b0a16137a4430ad5e2480fc4f4a8e250ab56ccd7630d( 0xbeee1e6e7fe307ddcf84b0a16137a4430ad5e2480fc4f4a8e250ab56ccd7630d, 0xbd5c436f8c83379009c1962310b8347e561d1900906d3fe4075b1596f8955f88, 0x000000000000000000000000afdae0ab2a6351ab57b10c9f0031aa59ab40e6ea )
|
Account State Difference:
| Address | Before | After | State Difference | ||
|---|---|---|---|---|---|
|
0x829BD824...93333A830
Miner
| (F2Pool Old) | 3,942.922707334006394068 Eth | 3,942.923520670006394068 Eth | 0.000813336 | |
| 0x90291319...AF749E845 | |||||
| 0x956F47F5...73E7f87CA | |||||
| 0xA0b86991...E3606eB48 | |||||
| 0xAfdaE0Ab...9ab40E6eA |
3.878334109493032803 Eth
Nonce: 234
|
28.760650353121194018 Eth
Nonce: 235
| 24.882316243628161215 | ||
| 0xBA122222...d566BF2C8 | (Balancer: Vault) | ||||
| 0xC02aaA39...83C756Cc2 | 5,366,917.578987245582964677 Eth | 5,366,892.45830044132891136 Eth | 25.120686804254053317 | ||
| 0xdf50Fbde...F542D3443 | (Uniswap V3: FEI-USDC 4) | ||||
| 0xF326e4dE...3c79f1915 | (MetaMask: DS Proxy) | 26,889.477471613751583008 Eth | 26,889.698291481915063134 Eth | 0.220819868163480126 |
Execution Trace
Metamask: Swap Router.5f575529( )
FiatTokenProxy.23b872dd( )
-
FiatTokenV2_1.transferFrom( from=0xAfdaE0Ab2a6351aB57b10C9f0031AA59ab40E6eA, to=0x74de5d4FCbf63E00296fd95d33236B9794016631, value=30000000000 ) => ( True )
-
MetaMask: Swaps Spender.e3547335( )0xdfa7bd39ded0051b2ecc48f7e17f63ecd165cae1.92f5f037( )FiatTokenProxy.dd62ed3e( )
-
FiatTokenV2_1.allowance( owner=0x74de5d4FCbf63E00296fd95d33236B9794016631, spender=0x1111111254fb6c44bAC0beD2854e76F90643097d ) => ( 115792089237316195423570985008687907853269984665640564039457583531530552207764 )
-
AggregationRouterV4.swap( caller=0x220bdA5c8994804Ac96ebe4DF184d25e5c2196D4, desc=[{name:srcToken, type:address, order:1, indexed:false, value:0xA0b86991c6218b36c1d19D4a2e9Eb0cE3606eB48, valueString:0xA0b86991c6218b36c1d19D4a2e9Eb0cE3606eB48}, {name:dstToken, type:address, order:2, indexed:false, value:0xEeeeeEeeeEeEeeEeEeEeeEEEeeeeEeeeeeeeEEeE, valueString:0xEeeeeEeeeEeEeeEeEeEeeEEEeeeeEeeeeeeeEEeE}, {name:srcReceiver, type:address, order:3, indexed:false, value:0x220bdA5c8994804Ac96ebe4DF184d25e5c2196D4, valueString:0x220bdA5c8994804Ac96ebe4DF184d25e5c2196D4}, {name:dstReceiver, type:address, order:4, indexed:false, value:0x74de5d4FCbf63E00296fd95d33236B9794016631, valueString:0x74de5d4FCbf63E00296fd95d33236B9794016631}, {name:amount, type:uint256, order:5, indexed:false, value:30000000000, valueString:30000000000}, {name:minReturnAmount, type:uint256, order:6, indexed:false, value:24479459670694368357, valueString:24479459670694368357}, {name:flags, type:uint256, order:7, indexed:false, value:4, valueString:4}, {name:permit, type:bytes, order:8, indexed:false, value:0x, valueString:0x}], data=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 ) => ( returnAmount=25120686804254053317, spentAmount=30000000000, gasLeft=39969 )FiatTokenProxy.23b872dd( )
-
FiatTokenV2_1.transferFrom( from=0x74de5d4FCbf63E00296fd95d33236B9794016631, to=0x220bdA5c8994804Ac96ebe4DF184d25e5c2196D4, value=30000000000 ) => ( True )
-
1inch: Aggregation Executor 1.2636f7f8( )Uniswap V3: FEI-USDC 4.128acb08( )-
Fei.transfer( recipient=0x220bdA5c8994804Ac96ebe4DF184d25e5c2196D4, amount=30005628948147938851312 ) => ( True )
-
FiatTokenProxy.70a08231( )
-
1inch: Aggregation Executor 1.fa461e33( ) -
FiatTokenProxy.70a08231( )
-
1inch: Aggregation Executor 1.ad0e7b1a( )-
Fei.balanceOf( account=0x220bdA5c8994804Ac96ebe4DF184d25e5c2196D4 ) => ( 30005628948147938851312 )
-
1inch: Aggregation Executor 1.eb5625d9( ) -
Vault.swap( singleSwap=[{name:poolId, type:bytes32, order:1, indexed:false, value:90291319F1D4EA3AD4DB0DD8FE9E12BAF749E84500020000000000000000013C, valueString:90291319F1D4EA3AD4DB0DD8FE9E12BAF749E84500020000000000000000013C}, {name:kind, type:uint8, order:2, indexed:false, value:0, valueString:0}, {name:assetIn, type:address, order:3, indexed:false, value:0x956F47F50A910163D8BF957Cf5846D573E7f87CA, valueString:0x956F47F50A910163D8BF957Cf5846D573E7f87CA}, {name:assetOut, type:address, order:4, indexed:false, value:0xC02aaA39b223FE8D0A0e5C4F27eAD9083C756Cc2, valueString:0xC02aaA39b223FE8D0A0e5C4F27eAD9083C756Cc2}, {name:amount, type:uint256, order:5, indexed:false, value:30005628948147938851312, valueString:30005628948147938851312}, {name:userData, type:bytes, order:6, indexed:false, value:0x, valueString:0x}], funds=[{name:sender, type:address, order:1, indexed:false, value:0x220bdA5c8994804Ac96ebe4DF184d25e5c2196D4, valueString:0x220bdA5c8994804Ac96ebe4DF184d25e5c2196D4}, {name:fromInternalBalance, type:bool, order:2, indexed:false, value:false, valueString:False}, {name:recipient, type:address, order:3, indexed:false, value:0x220bdA5c8994804Ac96ebe4DF184d25e5c2196D4, valueString:0x220bdA5c8994804Ac96ebe4DF184d25e5c2196D4}, {name:toInternalBalance, type:bool, order:4, indexed:false, value:false, valueString:False}], limit=1, deadline=1655325297 ) => ( amountCalculated=25120686804254053317 )
-
1inch: Aggregation Executor 1.14284aab( )-
WETH9.balanceOf( 0x220bdA5c8994804Ac96ebe4DF184d25e5c2196D4 ) => ( 25120686804254053317 )
-
WETH9.withdraw( wad=25120686804254053317 )
-
1inch: Aggregation Executor 1.32ce0a7c( )-
1inch: Aggregation Executor 1.70bdb947( ) -
1inch: Aggregation Executor 1.05971224( )
-
1inch: Aggregation Executor 1.14284aab( )-
1inch: Aggregation Executor 1.d1660f99( )
-
- ETH 25.120686804254053317
MetaMask: Swaps Spender.CALL( )
ETH 0.220819868163480126
Proxy.CALL( )- ETH 0.220819868163480126
GnosisSafe.DELEGATECALL( )
- ETH 0.220819868163480126
FiatTokenProxy.70a08231( )
-
FiatTokenV2_1.balanceOf( account=0x74de5d4FCbf63E00296fd95d33236B9794016631 ) => ( 0 )
-
- ETH 24.899866936090573191
0xafdae0ab2a6351ab57b10c9f0031aa59ab40e6ea.CALL( )
File 1 of 8: FiatTokenProxy
File 2 of 8: Fei
File 3 of 8: Vault
File 4 of 8: WETH9
File 5 of 8: FiatTokenV2_1
File 6 of 8: AggregationRouterV4
File 7 of 8: Proxy
File 8 of 8: GnosisSafe
pragma solidity ^0.4.24;
// File: zos-lib/contracts/upgradeability/Proxy.sol
/**
* @title Proxy
* @dev Implements delegation of calls to other contracts, with proper
* forwarding of return values and bubbling of failures.
* It defines a fallback function that delegates all calls to the address
* returned by the abstract _implementation() internal function.
*/
contract Proxy {
/**
* @dev Fallback function.
* Implemented entirely in `_fallback`.
*/
function () payable external {
_fallback();
}
/**
* @return The Address of the implementation.
*/
function _implementation() internal view returns (address);
/**
* @dev Delegates execution to an implementation contract.
* This is a low level function that doesn't return to its internal call site.
* It will return to the external caller whatever the implementation returns.
* @param implementation Address to delegate.
*/
function _delegate(address implementation) internal {
assembly {
// Copy msg.data. We take full control of memory in this inline assembly
// block because it will not return to Solidity code. We overwrite the
// Solidity scratch pad at memory position 0.
calldatacopy(0, 0, calldatasize)
// Call the implementation.
// out and outsize are 0 because we don't know the size yet.
let result := delegatecall(gas, implementation, 0, calldatasize, 0, 0)
// Copy the returned data.
returndatacopy(0, 0, returndatasize)
switch result
// delegatecall returns 0 on error.
case 0 { revert(0, returndatasize) }
default { return(0, returndatasize) }
}
}
/**
* @dev Function that is run as the first thing in the fallback function.
* Can be redefined in derived contracts to add functionality.
* Redefinitions must call super._willFallback().
*/
function _willFallback() internal {
}
/**
* @dev fallback implementation.
* Extracted to enable manual triggering.
*/
function _fallback() internal {
_willFallback();
_delegate(_implementation());
}
}
// File: openzeppelin-solidity/contracts/AddressUtils.sol
/**
* Utility library of inline functions on addresses
*/
library AddressUtils {
/**
* Returns whether the target address is a contract
* @dev This function will return false if invoked during the constructor of a contract,
* as the code is not actually created until after the constructor finishes.
* @param addr address to check
* @return whether the target address is a contract
*/
function isContract(address addr) internal view returns (bool) {
uint256 size;
// XXX Currently there is no better way to check if there is a contract in an address
// than to check the size of the code at that address.
// See https://ethereum.stackexchange.com/a/14016/36603
// for more details about how this works.
// TODO Check this again before the Serenity release, because all addresses will be
// contracts then.
// solium-disable-next-line security/no-inline-assembly
assembly { size := extcodesize(addr) }
return size > 0;
}
}
// File: zos-lib/contracts/upgradeability/UpgradeabilityProxy.sol
/**
* @title UpgradeabilityProxy
* @dev This contract implements a proxy that allows to change the
* implementation address to which it will delegate.
* Such a change is called an implementation upgrade.
*/
contract UpgradeabilityProxy is Proxy {
/**
* @dev Emitted when the implementation is upgraded.
* @param implementation Address of the new implementation.
*/
event Upgraded(address implementation);
/**
* @dev Storage slot with the address of the current implementation.
* This is the keccak-256 hash of "org.zeppelinos.proxy.implementation", and is
* validated in the constructor.
*/
bytes32 private constant IMPLEMENTATION_SLOT = 0x7050c9e0f4ca769c69bd3a8ef740bc37934f8e2c036e5a723fd8ee048ed3f8c3;
/**
* @dev Contract constructor.
* @param _implementation Address of the initial implementation.
*/
constructor(address _implementation) public {
assert(IMPLEMENTATION_SLOT == keccak256("org.zeppelinos.proxy.implementation"));
_setImplementation(_implementation);
}
/**
* @dev Returns the current implementation.
* @return Address of the current implementation
*/
function _implementation() internal view returns (address impl) {
bytes32 slot = IMPLEMENTATION_SLOT;
assembly {
impl := sload(slot)
}
}
/**
* @dev Upgrades the proxy to a new implementation.
* @param newImplementation Address of the new implementation.
*/
function _upgradeTo(address newImplementation) internal {
_setImplementation(newImplementation);
emit Upgraded(newImplementation);
}
/**
* @dev Sets the implementation address of the proxy.
* @param newImplementation Address of the new implementation.
*/
function _setImplementation(address newImplementation) private {
require(AddressUtils.isContract(newImplementation), "Cannot set a proxy implementation to a non-contract address");
bytes32 slot = IMPLEMENTATION_SLOT;
assembly {
sstore(slot, newImplementation)
}
}
}
// File: zos-lib/contracts/upgradeability/AdminUpgradeabilityProxy.sol
/**
* @title AdminUpgradeabilityProxy
* @dev This contract combines an upgradeability proxy with an authorization
* mechanism for administrative tasks.
* All external functions in this contract must be guarded by the
* `ifAdmin` modifier. See ethereum/solidity#3864 for a Solidity
* feature proposal that would enable this to be done automatically.
*/
contract AdminUpgradeabilityProxy is UpgradeabilityProxy {
/**
* @dev Emitted when the administration has been transferred.
* @param previousAdmin Address of the previous admin.
* @param newAdmin Address of the new admin.
*/
event AdminChanged(address previousAdmin, address newAdmin);
/**
* @dev Storage slot with the admin of the contract.
* This is the keccak-256 hash of "org.zeppelinos.proxy.admin", and is
* validated in the constructor.
*/
bytes32 private constant ADMIN_SLOT = 0x10d6a54a4754c8869d6886b5f5d7fbfa5b4522237ea5c60d11bc4e7a1ff9390b;
/**
* @dev Modifier to check whether the `msg.sender` is the admin.
* If it is, it will run the function. Otherwise, it will delegate the call
* to the implementation.
*/
modifier ifAdmin() {
if (msg.sender == _admin()) {
_;
} else {
_fallback();
}
}
/**
* Contract constructor.
* It sets the `msg.sender` as the proxy administrator.
* @param _implementation address of the initial implementation.
*/
constructor(address _implementation) UpgradeabilityProxy(_implementation) public {
assert(ADMIN_SLOT == keccak256("org.zeppelinos.proxy.admin"));
_setAdmin(msg.sender);
}
/**
* @return The address of the proxy admin.
*/
function admin() external view ifAdmin returns (address) {
return _admin();
}
/**
* @return The address of the implementation.
*/
function implementation() external view ifAdmin returns (address) {
return _implementation();
}
/**
* @dev Changes the admin of the proxy.
* Only the current admin can call this function.
* @param newAdmin Address to transfer proxy administration to.
*/
function changeAdmin(address newAdmin) external ifAdmin {
require(newAdmin != address(0), "Cannot change the admin of a proxy to the zero address");
emit AdminChanged(_admin(), newAdmin);
_setAdmin(newAdmin);
}
/**
* @dev Upgrade the backing implementation of the proxy.
* Only the admin can call this function.
* @param newImplementation Address of the new implementation.
*/
function upgradeTo(address newImplementation) external ifAdmin {
_upgradeTo(newImplementation);
}
/**
* @dev Upgrade the backing implementation of the proxy and call a function
* on the new implementation.
* This is useful to initialize the proxied contract.
* @param newImplementation Address of the new implementation.
* @param data Data to send as msg.data in the low level call.
* It should include the signature and the parameters of the function to be
* called, as described in
* https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/develop/abi-spec.html#function-selector-and-argument-encoding.
*/
function upgradeToAndCall(address newImplementation, bytes data) payable external ifAdmin {
_upgradeTo(newImplementation);
require(address(this).call.value(msg.value)(data));
}
/**
* @return The admin slot.
*/
function _admin() internal view returns (address adm) {
bytes32 slot = ADMIN_SLOT;
assembly {
adm := sload(slot)
}
}
/**
* @dev Sets the address of the proxy admin.
* @param newAdmin Address of the new proxy admin.
*/
function _setAdmin(address newAdmin) internal {
bytes32 slot = ADMIN_SLOT;
assembly {
sstore(slot, newAdmin)
}
}
/**
* @dev Only fall back when the sender is not the admin.
*/
function _willFallback() internal {
require(msg.sender != _admin(), "Cannot call fallback function from the proxy admin");
super._willFallback();
}
}
// File: contracts/FiatTokenProxy.sol
/**
* Copyright CENTRE SECZ 2018
*
* Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy
* of this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal
* in the Software without restriction, including without limitation the rights
* to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell
* copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to
* do so, subject to the following conditions:
*
* The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in all
* copies or substantial portions of the Software.
*
* THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR
* IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY,
* FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
* AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY,
* WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN
* CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE.
*/
pragma solidity ^0.4.24;
/**
* @title FiatTokenProxy
* @dev This contract proxies FiatToken calls and enables FiatToken upgrades
*/
contract FiatTokenProxy is AdminUpgradeabilityProxy {
constructor(address _implementation) public AdminUpgradeabilityProxy(_implementation) {
}
}File 2 of 8: Fei
pragma solidity ^0.6.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;
import "@openzeppelin/contracts/token/ERC20/ERC20Burnable.sol";
import "@openzeppelin/contracts/utils/Address.sol";
import "./IIncentive.sol";
import "./IFei.sol";
import "../refs/CoreRef.sol";
/// @title FEI stablecoin
/// @author Fei Protocol
contract Fei is IFei, ERC20Burnable, CoreRef {
/// @notice get associated incentive contract, 0 address if N/A
mapping(address => address) public override incentiveContract;
// solhint-disable-next-line var-name-mixedcase
bytes32 public DOMAIN_SEPARATOR;
// keccak256("Permit(address owner,address spender,uint256 value,uint256 nonce,uint256 deadline)");
bytes32 public constant PERMIT_TYPEHASH =
0x6e71edae12b1b97f4d1f60370fef10105fa2faae0126114a169c64845d6126c9;
mapping(address => uint256) public nonces;
/// @notice Fei token constructor
/// @param core Fei Core address to reference
constructor(address core) public ERC20("Fei USD", "FEI") CoreRef(core) {
uint256 chainId;
// solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly
assembly {
chainId := chainid()
}
DOMAIN_SEPARATOR = keccak256(
abi.encode(
keccak256(
"EIP712Domain(string name,string version,uint256 chainId,address verifyingContract)"
),
keccak256(bytes(name())),
keccak256(bytes("1")),
chainId,
address(this)
)
);
}
/// @param account the account to incentivize
/// @param incentive the associated incentive contract
function setIncentiveContract(address account, address incentive)
external
override
onlyGovernor
{
incentiveContract[account] = incentive;
emit IncentiveContractUpdate(account, incentive);
}
/// @notice mint FEI tokens
/// @param account the account to mint to
/// @param amount the amount to mint
function mint(address account, uint256 amount)
external
override
onlyMinter
whenNotPaused
{
_mint(account, amount);
emit Minting(account, msg.sender, amount);
}
/// @notice burn FEI tokens from caller
/// @param amount the amount to burn
function burn(uint256 amount) public override(IFei, ERC20Burnable) {
super.burn(amount);
emit Burning(msg.sender, msg.sender, amount);
}
/// @notice burn FEI tokens from specified account
/// @param account the account to burn from
/// @param amount the amount to burn
function burnFrom(address account, uint256 amount)
public
override(IFei, ERC20Burnable)
onlyBurner
whenNotPaused
{
_burn(account, amount);
emit Burning(account, msg.sender, amount);
}
function _transfer(
address sender,
address recipient,
uint256 amount
) internal override {
super._transfer(sender, recipient, amount);
_checkAndApplyIncentives(sender, recipient, amount);
}
function _checkAndApplyIncentives(
address sender,
address recipient,
uint256 amount
) internal {
// incentive on sender
address senderIncentive = incentiveContract[sender];
if (senderIncentive != address(0)) {
IIncentive(senderIncentive).incentivize(
sender,
recipient,
msg.sender,
amount
);
}
// incentive on recipient
address recipientIncentive = incentiveContract[recipient];
if (recipientIncentive != address(0)) {
IIncentive(recipientIncentive).incentivize(
sender,
recipient,
msg.sender,
amount
);
}
// incentive on operator
address operatorIncentive = incentiveContract[msg.sender];
if (
msg.sender != sender &&
msg.sender != recipient &&
operatorIncentive != address(0)
) {
IIncentive(operatorIncentive).incentivize(
sender,
recipient,
msg.sender,
amount
);
}
// all incentive, if active applies to every transfer
address allIncentive = incentiveContract[address(0)];
if (allIncentive != address(0)) {
IIncentive(allIncentive).incentivize(
sender,
recipient,
msg.sender,
amount
);
}
}
/// @notice permit spending of FEI
/// @param owner the FEI holder
/// @param spender the approved operator
/// @param value the amount approved
/// @param deadline the deadline after which the approval is no longer valid
function permit(
address owner,
address spender,
uint256 value,
uint256 deadline,
uint8 v,
bytes32 r,
bytes32 s
) external override {
// solhint-disable-next-line not-rely-on-time
require(deadline >= block.timestamp, "Fei: EXPIRED");
bytes32 digest =
keccak256(
abi.encodePacked(
"\\x19\\x01",
DOMAIN_SEPARATOR,
keccak256(
abi.encode(
PERMIT_TYPEHASH,
owner,
spender,
value,
nonces[owner]++,
deadline
)
)
)
);
address recoveredAddress = ecrecover(digest, v, r, s);
require(
recoveredAddress != address(0) && recoveredAddress == owner,
"Fei: INVALID_SIGNATURE"
);
_approve(owner, spender, value);
}
}
pragma solidity ^0.6.2;
/// @title incentive contract interface
/// @author Fei Protocol
/// @notice Called by FEI token contract when transferring with an incentivized address
/// @dev should be appointed as a Minter or Burner as needed
interface IIncentive {
// ----------- Fei only state changing api -----------
/// @notice apply incentives on transfer
/// @param sender the sender address of the FEI
/// @param receiver the receiver address of the FEI
/// @param operator the operator (msg.sender) of the transfer
/// @param amount the amount of FEI transferred
function incentivize(
address sender,
address receiver,
address operator,
uint256 amount
) external;
}
pragma solidity ^0.6.2;
import "@openzeppelin/contracts/token/ERC20/IERC20.sol";
/// @title FEI stablecoin interface
/// @author Fei Protocol
interface IFei is IERC20 {
// ----------- Events -----------
event Minting(
address indexed _to,
address indexed _minter,
uint256 _amount
);
event Burning(
address indexed _to,
address indexed _burner,
uint256 _amount
);
event IncentiveContractUpdate(
address indexed _incentivized,
address indexed _incentiveContract
);
// ----------- State changing api -----------
function burn(uint256 amount) external;
function permit(
address owner,
address spender,
uint256 value,
uint256 deadline,
uint8 v,
bytes32 r,
bytes32 s
) external;
// ----------- Burner only state changing api -----------
function burnFrom(address account, uint256 amount) external;
// ----------- Minter only state changing api -----------
function mint(address account, uint256 amount) external;
// ----------- Governor only state changing api -----------
function setIncentiveContract(address account, address incentive) external;
// ----------- Getters -----------
function incentiveContract(address account) external view returns (address);
}
pragma solidity ^0.6.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;
import "./ICoreRef.sol";
import "@openzeppelin/contracts/utils/Pausable.sol";
import "@openzeppelin/contracts/utils/Address.sol";
/// @title A Reference to Core
/// @author Fei Protocol
/// @notice defines some modifiers and utilities around interacting with Core
abstract contract CoreRef is ICoreRef, Pausable {
ICore private _core;
/// @notice CoreRef constructor
/// @param core Fei Core to reference
constructor(address core) public {
_core = ICore(core);
}
modifier ifMinterSelf() {
if (_core.isMinter(address(this))) {
_;
}
}
modifier ifBurnerSelf() {
if (_core.isBurner(address(this))) {
_;
}
}
modifier onlyMinter() {
require(_core.isMinter(msg.sender), "CoreRef: Caller is not a minter");
_;
}
modifier onlyBurner() {
require(_core.isBurner(msg.sender), "CoreRef: Caller is not a burner");
_;
}
modifier onlyPCVController() {
require(
_core.isPCVController(msg.sender),
"CoreRef: Caller is not a PCV controller"
);
_;
}
modifier onlyGovernor() {
require(
_core.isGovernor(msg.sender),
"CoreRef: Caller is not a governor"
);
_;
}
modifier onlyGuardianOrGovernor() {
require(
_core.isGovernor(msg.sender) ||
_core.isGuardian(msg.sender),
"CoreRef: Caller is not a guardian or governor"
);
_;
}
modifier onlyFei() {
require(msg.sender == address(fei()), "CoreRef: Caller is not FEI");
_;
}
modifier onlyGenesisGroup() {
require(
msg.sender == _core.genesisGroup(),
"CoreRef: Caller is not GenesisGroup"
);
_;
}
modifier postGenesis() {
require(
_core.hasGenesisGroupCompleted(),
"CoreRef: Still in Genesis Period"
);
_;
}
modifier nonContract() {
require(!Address.isContract(msg.sender), "CoreRef: Caller is a contract");
_;
}
/// @notice set new Core reference address
/// @param core the new core address
function setCore(address core) external override onlyGovernor {
_core = ICore(core);
emit CoreUpdate(core);
}
/// @notice set pausable methods to paused
function pause() public override onlyGuardianOrGovernor {
_pause();
}
/// @notice set pausable methods to unpaused
function unpause() public override onlyGuardianOrGovernor {
_unpause();
}
/// @notice address of the Core contract referenced
/// @return ICore implementation address
function core() public view override returns (ICore) {
return _core;
}
/// @notice address of the Fei contract referenced by Core
/// @return IFei implementation address
function fei() public view override returns (IFei) {
return _core.fei();
}
/// @notice address of the Tribe contract referenced by Core
/// @return IERC20 implementation address
function tribe() public view override returns (IERC20) {
return _core.tribe();
}
/// @notice fei balance of contract
/// @return fei amount held
function feiBalance() public view override returns (uint256) {
return fei().balanceOf(address(this));
}
/// @notice tribe balance of contract
/// @return tribe amount held
function tribeBalance() public view override returns (uint256) {
return tribe().balanceOf(address(this));
}
function _burnFeiHeld() internal {
fei().burn(feiBalance());
}
function _mintFei(uint256 amount) internal {
fei().mint(address(this), amount);
}
}
pragma solidity ^0.6.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;
import "../core/ICore.sol";
/// @title CoreRef interface
/// @author Fei Protocol
interface ICoreRef {
// ----------- Events -----------
event CoreUpdate(address indexed _core);
// ----------- Governor only state changing api -----------
function setCore(address core) external;
function pause() external;
function unpause() external;
// ----------- Getters -----------
function core() external view returns (ICore);
function fei() external view returns (IFei);
function tribe() external view returns (IERC20);
function feiBalance() external view returns (uint256);
function tribeBalance() external view returns (uint256);
}
pragma solidity ^0.6.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;
import "./IPermissions.sol";
import "../token/IFei.sol";
/// @title Core Interface
/// @author Fei Protocol
interface ICore is IPermissions {
// ----------- Events -----------
event FeiUpdate(address indexed _fei);
event TribeUpdate(address indexed _tribe);
event GenesisGroupUpdate(address indexed _genesisGroup);
event TribeAllocation(address indexed _to, uint256 _amount);
event GenesisPeriodComplete(uint256 _timestamp);
// ----------- Governor only state changing api -----------
function init() external;
// ----------- Governor only state changing api -----------
function setFei(address token) external;
function setTribe(address token) external;
function setGenesisGroup(address _genesisGroup) external;
function allocateTribe(address to, uint256 amount) external;
// ----------- Genesis Group only state changing api -----------
function completeGenesisGroup() external;
// ----------- Getters -----------
function fei() external view returns (IFei);
function tribe() external view returns (IERC20);
function genesisGroup() external view returns (address);
function hasGenesisGroupCompleted() external view returns (bool);
}
pragma solidity ^0.6.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;
/// @title Permissions interface
/// @author Fei Protocol
interface IPermissions {
// ----------- Governor only state changing api -----------
function createRole(bytes32 role, bytes32 adminRole) external;
function grantMinter(address minter) external;
function grantBurner(address burner) external;
function grantPCVController(address pcvController) external;
function grantGovernor(address governor) external;
function grantGuardian(address guardian) external;
function revokeMinter(address minter) external;
function revokeBurner(address burner) external;
function revokePCVController(address pcvController) external;
function revokeGovernor(address governor) external;
function revokeGuardian(address guardian) external;
// ----------- Revoker only state changing api -----------
function revokeOverride(bytes32 role, address account) external;
// ----------- Getters -----------
function isBurner(address _address) external view returns (bool);
function isMinter(address _address) external view returns (bool);
function isGovernor(address _address) external view returns (bool);
function isGuardian(address _address) external view returns (bool);
function isPCVController(address _address) external view returns (bool);
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity >=0.6.0 <0.8.0;
import "../../utils/Context.sol";
import "./ERC20.sol";
/**
* @dev Extension of {ERC20} that allows token holders to destroy both their own
* tokens and those that they have an allowance for, in a way that can be
* recognized off-chain (via event analysis).
*/
abstract contract ERC20Burnable is Context, ERC20 {
using SafeMath for uint256;
/**
* @dev Destroys `amount` tokens from the caller.
*
* See {ERC20-_burn}.
*/
function burn(uint256 amount) public virtual {
_burn(_msgSender(), amount);
}
/**
* @dev Destroys `amount` tokens from `account`, deducting from the caller's
* allowance.
*
* See {ERC20-_burn} and {ERC20-allowance}.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - the caller must have allowance for ``accounts``'s tokens of at least
* `amount`.
*/
function burnFrom(address account, uint256 amount) public virtual {
uint256 decreasedAllowance = allowance(account, _msgSender()).sub(amount, "ERC20: burn amount exceeds allowance");
_approve(account, _msgSender(), decreasedAllowance);
_burn(account, amount);
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity >=0.6.0 <0.8.0;
/*
* @dev Provides information about the current execution context, including the
* sender of the transaction and its data. While these are generally available
* via msg.sender and msg.data, they should not be accessed in such a direct
* manner, since when dealing with GSN meta-transactions the account sending and
* paying for execution may not be the actual sender (as far as an application
* is concerned).
*
* This contract is only required for intermediate, library-like contracts.
*/
abstract contract Context {
function _msgSender() internal view virtual returns (address payable) {
return msg.sender;
}
function _msgData() internal view virtual returns (bytes memory) {
this; // silence state mutability warning without generating bytecode - see https://github.com/ethereum/solidity/issues/2691
return msg.data;
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity >=0.6.0 <0.8.0;
import "../../utils/Context.sol";
import "./IERC20.sol";
import "../../math/SafeMath.sol";
/**
* @dev Implementation of the {IERC20} interface.
*
* This implementation is agnostic to the way tokens are created. This means
* that a supply mechanism has to be added in a derived contract using {_mint}.
* For a generic mechanism see {ERC20PresetMinterPauser}.
*
* TIP: For a detailed writeup see our guide
* https://forum.zeppelin.solutions/t/how-to-implement-erc20-supply-mechanisms/226[How
* to implement supply mechanisms].
*
* We have followed general OpenZeppelin guidelines: functions revert instead
* of returning `false` on failure. This behavior is nonetheless conventional
* and does not conflict with the expectations of ERC20 applications.
*
* Additionally, an {Approval} event is emitted on calls to {transferFrom}.
* This allows applications to reconstruct the allowance for all accounts just
* by listening to said events. Other implementations of the EIP may not emit
* these events, as it isn't required by the specification.
*
* Finally, the non-standard {decreaseAllowance} and {increaseAllowance}
* functions have been added to mitigate the well-known issues around setting
* allowances. See {IERC20-approve}.
*/
contract ERC20 is Context, IERC20 {
using SafeMath for uint256;
mapping (address => uint256) private _balances;
mapping (address => mapping (address => uint256)) private _allowances;
uint256 private _totalSupply;
string private _name;
string private _symbol;
uint8 private _decimals;
/**
* @dev Sets the values for {name} and {symbol}, initializes {decimals} with
* a default value of 18.
*
* To select a different value for {decimals}, use {_setupDecimals}.
*
* All three of these values are immutable: they can only be set once during
* construction.
*/
constructor (string memory name_, string memory symbol_) public {
_name = name_;
_symbol = symbol_;
_decimals = 18;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the name of the token.
*/
function name() public view virtual returns (string memory) {
return _name;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the symbol of the token, usually a shorter version of the
* name.
*/
function symbol() public view virtual returns (string memory) {
return _symbol;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the number of decimals used to get its user representation.
* For example, if `decimals` equals `2`, a balance of `505` tokens should
* be displayed to a user as `5,05` (`505 / 10 ** 2`).
*
* Tokens usually opt for a value of 18, imitating the relationship between
* Ether and Wei. This is the value {ERC20} uses, unless {_setupDecimals} is
* called.
*
* NOTE: This information is only used for _display_ purposes: it in
* no way affects any of the arithmetic of the contract, including
* {IERC20-balanceOf} and {IERC20-transfer}.
*/
function decimals() public view virtual returns (uint8) {
return _decimals;
}
/**
* @dev See {IERC20-totalSupply}.
*/
function totalSupply() public view virtual override returns (uint256) {
return _totalSupply;
}
/**
* @dev See {IERC20-balanceOf}.
*/
function balanceOf(address account) public view virtual override returns (uint256) {
return _balances[account];
}
/**
* @dev See {IERC20-transfer}.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `recipient` cannot be the zero address.
* - the caller must have a balance of at least `amount`.
*/
function transfer(address recipient, uint256 amount) public virtual override returns (bool) {
_transfer(_msgSender(), recipient, amount);
return true;
}
/**
* @dev See {IERC20-allowance}.
*/
function allowance(address owner, address spender) public view virtual override returns (uint256) {
return _allowances[owner][spender];
}
/**
* @dev See {IERC20-approve}.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `spender` cannot be the zero address.
*/
function approve(address spender, uint256 amount) public virtual override returns (bool) {
_approve(_msgSender(), spender, amount);
return true;
}
/**
* @dev See {IERC20-transferFrom}.
*
* Emits an {Approval} event indicating the updated allowance. This is not
* required by the EIP. See the note at the beginning of {ERC20}.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `sender` and `recipient` cannot be the zero address.
* - `sender` must have a balance of at least `amount`.
* - the caller must have allowance for ``sender``'s tokens of at least
* `amount`.
*/
function transferFrom(address sender, address recipient, uint256 amount) public virtual override returns (bool) {
_transfer(sender, recipient, amount);
_approve(sender, _msgSender(), _allowances[sender][_msgSender()].sub(amount, "ERC20: transfer amount exceeds allowance"));
return true;
}
/**
* @dev Atomically increases the allowance granted to `spender` by the caller.
*
* This is an alternative to {approve} that can be used as a mitigation for
* problems described in {IERC20-approve}.
*
* Emits an {Approval} event indicating the updated allowance.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `spender` cannot be the zero address.
*/
function increaseAllowance(address spender, uint256 addedValue) public virtual returns (bool) {
_approve(_msgSender(), spender, _allowances[_msgSender()][spender].add(addedValue));
return true;
}
/**
* @dev Atomically decreases the allowance granted to `spender` by the caller.
*
* This is an alternative to {approve} that can be used as a mitigation for
* problems described in {IERC20-approve}.
*
* Emits an {Approval} event indicating the updated allowance.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `spender` cannot be the zero address.
* - `spender` must have allowance for the caller of at least
* `subtractedValue`.
*/
function decreaseAllowance(address spender, uint256 subtractedValue) public virtual returns (bool) {
_approve(_msgSender(), spender, _allowances[_msgSender()][spender].sub(subtractedValue, "ERC20: decreased allowance below zero"));
return true;
}
/**
* @dev Moves tokens `amount` from `sender` to `recipient`.
*
* This is internal function is equivalent to {transfer}, and can be used to
* e.g. implement automatic token fees, slashing mechanisms, etc.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `sender` cannot be the zero address.
* - `recipient` cannot be the zero address.
* - `sender` must have a balance of at least `amount`.
*/
function _transfer(address sender, address recipient, uint256 amount) internal virtual {
require(sender != address(0), "ERC20: transfer from the zero address");
require(recipient != address(0), "ERC20: transfer to the zero address");
_beforeTokenTransfer(sender, recipient, amount);
_balances[sender] = _balances[sender].sub(amount, "ERC20: transfer amount exceeds balance");
_balances[recipient] = _balances[recipient].add(amount);
emit Transfer(sender, recipient, amount);
}
/** @dev Creates `amount` tokens and assigns them to `account`, increasing
* the total supply.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event with `from` set to the zero address.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `to` cannot be the zero address.
*/
function _mint(address account, uint256 amount) internal virtual {
require(account != address(0), "ERC20: mint to the zero address");
_beforeTokenTransfer(address(0), account, amount);
_totalSupply = _totalSupply.add(amount);
_balances[account] = _balances[account].add(amount);
emit Transfer(address(0), account, amount);
}
/**
* @dev Destroys `amount` tokens from `account`, reducing the
* total supply.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event with `to` set to the zero address.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `account` cannot be the zero address.
* - `account` must have at least `amount` tokens.
*/
function _burn(address account, uint256 amount) internal virtual {
require(account != address(0), "ERC20: burn from the zero address");
_beforeTokenTransfer(account, address(0), amount);
_balances[account] = _balances[account].sub(amount, "ERC20: burn amount exceeds balance");
_totalSupply = _totalSupply.sub(amount);
emit Transfer(account, address(0), amount);
}
/**
* @dev Sets `amount` as the allowance of `spender` over the `owner` s tokens.
*
* This internal function is equivalent to `approve`, and can be used to
* e.g. set automatic allowances for certain subsystems, etc.
*
* Emits an {Approval} event.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `owner` cannot be the zero address.
* - `spender` cannot be the zero address.
*/
function _approve(address owner, address spender, uint256 amount) internal virtual {
require(owner != address(0), "ERC20: approve from the zero address");
require(spender != address(0), "ERC20: approve to the zero address");
_allowances[owner][spender] = amount;
emit Approval(owner, spender, amount);
}
/**
* @dev Sets {decimals} to a value other than the default one of 18.
*
* WARNING: This function should only be called from the constructor. Most
* applications that interact with token contracts will not expect
* {decimals} to ever change, and may work incorrectly if it does.
*/
function _setupDecimals(uint8 decimals_) internal virtual {
_decimals = decimals_;
}
/**
* @dev Hook that is called before any transfer of tokens. This includes
* minting and burning.
*
* Calling conditions:
*
* - when `from` and `to` are both non-zero, `amount` of ``from``'s tokens
* will be to transferred to `to`.
* - when `from` is zero, `amount` tokens will be minted for `to`.
* - when `to` is zero, `amount` of ``from``'s tokens will be burned.
* - `from` and `to` are never both zero.
*
* To learn more about hooks, head to xref:ROOT:extending-contracts.adoc#using-hooks[Using Hooks].
*/
function _beforeTokenTransfer(address from, address to, uint256 amount) internal virtual { }
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity >=0.6.0 <0.8.0;
/**
* @dev Interface of the ERC20 standard as defined in the EIP.
*/
interface IERC20 {
/**
* @dev Returns the amount of tokens in existence.
*/
function totalSupply() external view returns (uint256);
/**
* @dev Returns the amount of tokens owned by `account`.
*/
function balanceOf(address account) external view returns (uint256);
/**
* @dev Moves `amount` tokens from the caller's account to `recipient`.
*
* Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function transfer(address recipient, uint256 amount) external returns (bool);
/**
* @dev Returns the remaining number of tokens that `spender` will be
* allowed to spend on behalf of `owner` through {transferFrom}. This is
* zero by default.
*
* This value changes when {approve} or {transferFrom} are called.
*/
function allowance(address owner, address spender) external view returns (uint256);
/**
* @dev Sets `amount` as the allowance of `spender` over the caller's tokens.
*
* Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded.
*
* IMPORTANT: Beware that changing an allowance with this method brings the risk
* that someone may use both the old and the new allowance by unfortunate
* transaction ordering. One possible solution to mitigate this race
* condition is to first reduce the spender's allowance to 0 and set the
* desired value afterwards:
* https://github.com/ethereum/EIPs/issues/20#issuecomment-263524729
*
* Emits an {Approval} event.
*/
function approve(address spender, uint256 amount) external returns (bool);
/**
* @dev Moves `amount` tokens from `sender` to `recipient` using the
* allowance mechanism. `amount` is then deducted from the caller's
* allowance.
*
* Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function transferFrom(address sender, address recipient, uint256 amount) external returns (bool);
/**
* @dev Emitted when `value` tokens are moved from one account (`from`) to
* another (`to`).
*
* Note that `value` may be zero.
*/
event Transfer(address indexed from, address indexed to, uint256 value);
/**
* @dev Emitted when the allowance of a `spender` for an `owner` is set by
* a call to {approve}. `value` is the new allowance.
*/
event Approval(address indexed owner, address indexed spender, uint256 value);
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity >=0.6.0 <0.8.0;
/**
* @dev Wrappers over Solidity's arithmetic operations with added overflow
* checks.
*
* Arithmetic operations in Solidity wrap on overflow. This can easily result
* in bugs, because programmers usually assume that an overflow raises an
* error, which is the standard behavior in high level programming languages.
* `SafeMath` restores this intuition by reverting the transaction when an
* operation overflows.
*
* Using this library instead of the unchecked operations eliminates an entire
* class of bugs, so it's recommended to use it always.
*/
library SafeMath {
/**
* @dev Returns the addition of two unsigned integers, with an overflow flag.
*
* _Available since v3.4._
*/
function tryAdd(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (bool, uint256) {
uint256 c = a + b;
if (c < a) return (false, 0);
return (true, c);
}
/**
* @dev Returns the substraction of two unsigned integers, with an overflow flag.
*
* _Available since v3.4._
*/
function trySub(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (bool, uint256) {
if (b > a) return (false, 0);
return (true, a - b);
}
/**
* @dev Returns the multiplication of two unsigned integers, with an overflow flag.
*
* _Available since v3.4._
*/
function tryMul(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (bool, uint256) {
// Gas optimization: this is cheaper than requiring 'a' not being zero, but the
// benefit is lost if 'b' is also tested.
// See: https://github.com/OpenZeppelin/openzeppelin-contracts/pull/522
if (a == 0) return (true, 0);
uint256 c = a * b;
if (c / a != b) return (false, 0);
return (true, c);
}
/**
* @dev Returns the division of two unsigned integers, with a division by zero flag.
*
* _Available since v3.4._
*/
function tryDiv(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (bool, uint256) {
if (b == 0) return (false, 0);
return (true, a / b);
}
/**
* @dev Returns the remainder of dividing two unsigned integers, with a division by zero flag.
*
* _Available since v3.4._
*/
function tryMod(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (bool, uint256) {
if (b == 0) return (false, 0);
return (true, a % b);
}
/**
* @dev Returns the addition of two unsigned integers, reverting on
* overflow.
*
* Counterpart to Solidity's `+` operator.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - Addition cannot overflow.
*/
function add(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
uint256 c = a + b;
require(c >= a, "SafeMath: addition overflow");
return c;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the subtraction of two unsigned integers, reverting on
* overflow (when the result is negative).
*
* Counterpart to Solidity's `-` operator.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - Subtraction cannot overflow.
*/
function sub(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
require(b <= a, "SafeMath: subtraction overflow");
return a - b;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the multiplication of two unsigned integers, reverting on
* overflow.
*
* Counterpart to Solidity's `*` operator.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - Multiplication cannot overflow.
*/
function mul(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
if (a == 0) return 0;
uint256 c = a * b;
require(c / a == b, "SafeMath: multiplication overflow");
return c;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the integer division of two unsigned integers, reverting on
* division by zero. The result is rounded towards zero.
*
* Counterpart to Solidity's `/` operator. Note: this function uses a
* `revert` opcode (which leaves remaining gas untouched) while Solidity
* uses an invalid opcode to revert (consuming all remaining gas).
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The divisor cannot be zero.
*/
function div(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
require(b > 0, "SafeMath: division by zero");
return a / b;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the remainder of dividing two unsigned integers. (unsigned integer modulo),
* reverting when dividing by zero.
*
* Counterpart to Solidity's `%` operator. This function uses a `revert`
* opcode (which leaves remaining gas untouched) while Solidity uses an
* invalid opcode to revert (consuming all remaining gas).
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The divisor cannot be zero.
*/
function mod(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
require(b > 0, "SafeMath: modulo by zero");
return a % b;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the subtraction of two unsigned integers, reverting with custom message on
* overflow (when the result is negative).
*
* CAUTION: This function is deprecated because it requires allocating memory for the error
* message unnecessarily. For custom revert reasons use {trySub}.
*
* Counterpart to Solidity's `-` operator.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - Subtraction cannot overflow.
*/
function sub(uint256 a, uint256 b, string memory errorMessage) internal pure returns (uint256) {
require(b <= a, errorMessage);
return a - b;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the integer division of two unsigned integers, reverting with custom message on
* division by zero. The result is rounded towards zero.
*
* CAUTION: This function is deprecated because it requires allocating memory for the error
* message unnecessarily. For custom revert reasons use {tryDiv}.
*
* Counterpart to Solidity's `/` operator. Note: this function uses a
* `revert` opcode (which leaves remaining gas untouched) while Solidity
* uses an invalid opcode to revert (consuming all remaining gas).
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The divisor cannot be zero.
*/
function div(uint256 a, uint256 b, string memory errorMessage) internal pure returns (uint256) {
require(b > 0, errorMessage);
return a / b;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the remainder of dividing two unsigned integers. (unsigned integer modulo),
* reverting with custom message when dividing by zero.
*
* CAUTION: This function is deprecated because it requires allocating memory for the error
* message unnecessarily. For custom revert reasons use {tryMod}.
*
* Counterpart to Solidity's `%` operator. This function uses a `revert`
* opcode (which leaves remaining gas untouched) while Solidity uses an
* invalid opcode to revert (consuming all remaining gas).
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The divisor cannot be zero.
*/
function mod(uint256 a, uint256 b, string memory errorMessage) internal pure returns (uint256) {
require(b > 0, errorMessage);
return a % b;
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity >=0.6.2 <0.8.0;
/**
* @dev Collection of functions related to the address type
*/
library Address {
/**
* @dev Returns true if `account` is a contract.
*
* [IMPORTANT]
* ====
* It is unsafe to assume that an address for which this function returns
* false is an externally-owned account (EOA) and not a contract.
*
* Among others, `isContract` will return false for the following
* types of addresses:
*
* - an externally-owned account
* - a contract in construction
* - an address where a contract will be created
* - an address where a contract lived, but was destroyed
* ====
*/
function isContract(address account) internal view returns (bool) {
// This method relies on extcodesize, which returns 0 for contracts in
// construction, since the code is only stored at the end of the
// constructor execution.
uint256 size;
// solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly
assembly { size := extcodesize(account) }
return size > 0;
}
/**
* @dev Replacement for Solidity's `transfer`: sends `amount` wei to
* `recipient`, forwarding all available gas and reverting on errors.
*
* https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-1884[EIP1884] increases the gas cost
* of certain opcodes, possibly making contracts go over the 2300 gas limit
* imposed by `transfer`, making them unable to receive funds via
* `transfer`. {sendValue} removes this limitation.
*
* https://diligence.consensys.net/posts/2019/09/stop-using-soliditys-transfer-now/[Learn more].
*
* IMPORTANT: because control is transferred to `recipient`, care must be
* taken to not create reentrancy vulnerabilities. Consider using
* {ReentrancyGuard} or the
* https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/v0.5.11/security-considerations.html#use-the-checks-effects-interactions-pattern[checks-effects-interactions pattern].
*/
function sendValue(address payable recipient, uint256 amount) internal {
require(address(this).balance >= amount, "Address: insufficient balance");
// solhint-disable-next-line avoid-low-level-calls, avoid-call-value
(bool success, ) = recipient.call{ value: amount }("");
require(success, "Address: unable to send value, recipient may have reverted");
}
/**
* @dev Performs a Solidity function call using a low level `call`. A
* plain`call` is an unsafe replacement for a function call: use this
* function instead.
*
* If `target` reverts with a revert reason, it is bubbled up by this
* function (like regular Solidity function calls).
*
* Returns the raw returned data. To convert to the expected return value,
* use https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/latest/units-and-global-variables.html?highlight=abi.decode#abi-encoding-and-decoding-functions[`abi.decode`].
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `target` must be a contract.
* - calling `target` with `data` must not revert.
*
* _Available since v3.1._
*/
function functionCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal returns (bytes memory) {
return functionCall(target, data, "Address: low-level call failed");
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`], but with
* `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts.
*
* _Available since v3.1._
*/
function functionCall(address target, bytes memory data, string memory errorMessage) internal returns (bytes memory) {
return functionCallWithValue(target, data, 0, errorMessage);
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
* but also transferring `value` wei to `target`.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - the calling contract must have an ETH balance of at least `value`.
* - the called Solidity function must be `payable`.
*
* _Available since v3.1._
*/
function functionCallWithValue(address target, bytes memory data, uint256 value) internal returns (bytes memory) {
return functionCallWithValue(target, data, value, "Address: low-level call with value failed");
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCallWithValue-address-bytes-uint256-}[`functionCallWithValue`], but
* with `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts.
*
* _Available since v3.1._
*/
function functionCallWithValue(address target, bytes memory data, uint256 value, string memory errorMessage) internal returns (bytes memory) {
require(address(this).balance >= value, "Address: insufficient balance for call");
require(isContract(target), "Address: call to non-contract");
// solhint-disable-next-line avoid-low-level-calls
(bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.call{ value: value }(data);
return _verifyCallResult(success, returndata, errorMessage);
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
* but performing a static call.
*
* _Available since v3.3._
*/
function functionStaticCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal view returns (bytes memory) {
return functionStaticCall(target, data, "Address: low-level static call failed");
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-string-}[`functionCall`],
* but performing a static call.
*
* _Available since v3.3._
*/
function functionStaticCall(address target, bytes memory data, string memory errorMessage) internal view returns (bytes memory) {
require(isContract(target), "Address: static call to non-contract");
// solhint-disable-next-line avoid-low-level-calls
(bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.staticcall(data);
return _verifyCallResult(success, returndata, errorMessage);
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
* but performing a delegate call.
*
* _Available since v3.4._
*/
function functionDelegateCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal returns (bytes memory) {
return functionDelegateCall(target, data, "Address: low-level delegate call failed");
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-string-}[`functionCall`],
* but performing a delegate call.
*
* _Available since v3.4._
*/
function functionDelegateCall(address target, bytes memory data, string memory errorMessage) internal returns (bytes memory) {
require(isContract(target), "Address: delegate call to non-contract");
// solhint-disable-next-line avoid-low-level-calls
(bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.delegatecall(data);
return _verifyCallResult(success, returndata, errorMessage);
}
function _verifyCallResult(bool success, bytes memory returndata, string memory errorMessage) private pure returns(bytes memory) {
if (success) {
return returndata;
} else {
// Look for revert reason and bubble it up if present
if (returndata.length > 0) {
// The easiest way to bubble the revert reason is using memory via assembly
// solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly
assembly {
let returndata_size := mload(returndata)
revert(add(32, returndata), returndata_size)
}
} else {
revert(errorMessage);
}
}
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity >=0.6.0 <0.8.0;
import "./Context.sol";
/**
* @dev Contract module which allows children to implement an emergency stop
* mechanism that can be triggered by an authorized account.
*
* This module is used through inheritance. It will make available the
* modifiers `whenNotPaused` and `whenPaused`, which can be applied to
* the functions of your contract. Note that they will not be pausable by
* simply including this module, only once the modifiers are put in place.
*/
abstract contract Pausable is Context {
/**
* @dev Emitted when the pause is triggered by `account`.
*/
event Paused(address account);
/**
* @dev Emitted when the pause is lifted by `account`.
*/
event Unpaused(address account);
bool private _paused;
/**
* @dev Initializes the contract in unpaused state.
*/
constructor () internal {
_paused = false;
}
/**
* @dev Returns true if the contract is paused, and false otherwise.
*/
function paused() public view virtual returns (bool) {
return _paused;
}
/**
* @dev Modifier to make a function callable only when the contract is not paused.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The contract must not be paused.
*/
modifier whenNotPaused() {
require(!paused(), "Pausable: paused");
_;
}
/**
* @dev Modifier to make a function callable only when the contract is paused.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The contract must be paused.
*/
modifier whenPaused() {
require(paused(), "Pausable: not paused");
_;
}
/**
* @dev Triggers stopped state.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The contract must not be paused.
*/
function _pause() internal virtual whenNotPaused {
_paused = true;
emit Paused(_msgSender());
}
/**
* @dev Returns to normal state.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The contract must be paused.
*/
function _unpause() internal virtual whenPaused {
_paused = false;
emit Unpaused(_msgSender());
}
}
File 3 of 8: Vault
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.
// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.
// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;
import "./interfaces/IAuthorizer.sol";
import "./interfaces/IWETH.sol";
import "./VaultAuthorization.sol";
import "./FlashLoans.sol";
import "./Swaps.sol";
/**
* @dev The `Vault` is Balancer V2's core contract. A single instance of it exists for the entire network, and it is the
* entity used to interact with Pools by Liquidity Providers who join and exit them, Traders who swap, and Asset
* Managers who withdraw and deposit tokens.
*
* The `Vault`'s source code is split among a number of sub-contracts, with the goal of improving readability and making
* understanding the system easier. Most sub-contracts have been marked as `abstract` to explicitly indicate that only
* the full `Vault` is meant to be deployed.
*
* Roughly speaking, these are the contents of each sub-contract:
*
* - `AssetManagers`: Pool token Asset Manager registry, and Asset Manager interactions.
* - `Fees`: set and compute protocol fees.
* - `FlashLoans`: flash loan transfers and fees.
* - `PoolBalances`: Pool joins and exits.
* - `PoolRegistry`: Pool registration, ID management, and basic queries.
* - `PoolTokens`: Pool token registration and registration, and balance queries.
* - `Swaps`: Pool swaps.
* - `UserBalance`: manage user balances (Internal Balance operations and external balance transfers)
* - `VaultAuthorization`: access control, relayers and signature validation.
*
* Additionally, the different Pool specializations are handled by the `GeneralPoolsBalance`,
* `MinimalSwapInfoPoolsBalance` and `TwoTokenPoolsBalance` sub-contracts, which in turn make use of the
* `BalanceAllocation` library.
*
* The most important goal of the `Vault` is to make token swaps use as little gas as possible. This is reflected in a
* multitude of design decisions, from minor things like the format used to store Pool IDs, to major features such as
* the different Pool specialization settings.
*
* Finally, the large number of tasks carried out by the Vault means its bytecode is very large, close to exceeding
* the contract size limit imposed by EIP 170 (https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-170). Manual tuning of the source code
* was required to improve code generation and bring the bytecode size below this limit. This includes extensive
* utilization of `internal` functions (particularly inside modifiers), usage of named return arguments, dedicated
* storage access methods, dynamic revert reason generation, and usage of inline assembly, to name a few.
*/
contract Vault is VaultAuthorization, FlashLoans, Swaps {
constructor(
IAuthorizer authorizer,
IWETH weth,
uint256 pauseWindowDuration,
uint256 bufferPeriodDuration
) VaultAuthorization(authorizer) AssetHelpers(weth) TemporarilyPausable(pauseWindowDuration, bufferPeriodDuration) {
// solhint-disable-previous-line no-empty-blocks
}
function setPaused(bool paused) external override nonReentrant authenticate {
_setPaused(paused);
}
// solhint-disable-next-line func-name-mixedcase
function WETH() external view override returns (IWETH) {
return _WETH();
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.
// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.
// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
interface IAuthorizer {
/**
* @dev Returns true if `account` can perform the action described by `actionId` in the contract `where`.
*/
function canPerform(
bytes32 actionId,
address account,
address where
) external view returns (bool);
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.
// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.
// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
import "../../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol";
/**
* @dev Interface for the WETH token contract used internally for wrapping and unwrapping, to support
* sending and receiving ETH in joins, swaps, and internal balance deposits and withdrawals.
*/
interface IWETH is IERC20 {
function deposit() external payable;
function withdraw(uint256 amount) external;
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.
// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.
// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;
import "../lib/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol";
import "../lib/helpers/Authentication.sol";
import "../lib/helpers/TemporarilyPausable.sol";
import "../lib/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol";
import "../lib/helpers/SignaturesValidator.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/ReentrancyGuard.sol";
import "./interfaces/IVault.sol";
import "./interfaces/IAuthorizer.sol";
/**
* @dev Manages access control of Vault permissioned functions by relying on the Authorizer and signature validation.
*
* Additionally handles relayer access and approval.
*/
abstract contract VaultAuthorization is
IVault,
ReentrancyGuard,
Authentication,
SignaturesValidator,
TemporarilyPausable
{
// Ideally, we'd store the type hashes as immutable state variables to avoid computing the hash at runtime, but
// unfortunately immutable variables cannot be used in assembly, so we just keep the precomputed hashes instead.
// _JOIN_TYPE_HASH = keccak256("JoinPool(bytes calldata,address sender,uint256 nonce,uint256 deadline)");
bytes32 private constant _JOIN_TYPE_HASH = 0x3f7b71252bd19113ff48c19c6e004a9bcfcca320a0d74d58e85877cbd7dcae58;
// _EXIT_TYPE_HASH = keccak256("ExitPool(bytes calldata,address sender,uint256 nonce,uint256 deadline)");
bytes32 private constant _EXIT_TYPE_HASH = 0x8bbc57f66ea936902f50a71ce12b92c43f3c5340bb40c27c4e90ab84eeae3353;
// _SWAP_TYPE_HASH = keccak256("Swap(bytes calldata,address sender,uint256 nonce,uint256 deadline)");
bytes32 private constant _SWAP_TYPE_HASH = 0xe192dcbc143b1e244ad73b813fd3c097b832ad260a157340b4e5e5beda067abe;
// _BATCH_SWAP_TYPE_HASH = keccak256("BatchSwap(bytes calldata,address sender,uint256 nonce,uint256 deadline)");
bytes32 private constant _BATCH_SWAP_TYPE_HASH = 0x9bfc43a4d98313c6766986ffd7c916c7481566d9f224c6819af0a53388aced3a;
// _SET_RELAYER_TYPE_HASH =
// keccak256("SetRelayerApproval(bytes calldata,address sender,uint256 nonce,uint256 deadline)");
bytes32
private constant _SET_RELAYER_TYPE_HASH = 0xa3f865aa351e51cfeb40f5178d1564bb629fe9030b83caf6361d1baaf5b90b5a;
IAuthorizer private _authorizer;
mapping(address => mapping(address => bool)) private _approvedRelayers;
/**
* @dev Reverts unless `user` is the caller, or the caller is approved by the Authorizer to call this function (that
* is, it is a relayer for that function), and either:
* a) `user` approved the caller as a relayer (via `setRelayerApproval`), or
* b) a valid signature from them was appended to the calldata.
*
* Should only be applied to external functions.
*/
modifier authenticateFor(address user) {
_authenticateFor(user);
_;
}
constructor(IAuthorizer authorizer)
// The Vault is a singleton, so it simply uses its own address to disambiguate action identifiers.
Authentication(bytes32(uint256(address(this))))
SignaturesValidator("Balancer V2 Vault")
{
_setAuthorizer(authorizer);
}
function setAuthorizer(IAuthorizer newAuthorizer) external override nonReentrant authenticate {
_setAuthorizer(newAuthorizer);
}
function _setAuthorizer(IAuthorizer newAuthorizer) private {
emit AuthorizerChanged(newAuthorizer);
_authorizer = newAuthorizer;
}
function getAuthorizer() external view override returns (IAuthorizer) {
return _authorizer;
}
function setRelayerApproval(
address sender,
address relayer,
bool approved
) external override nonReentrant whenNotPaused authenticateFor(sender) {
_approvedRelayers[sender][relayer] = approved;
emit RelayerApprovalChanged(relayer, sender, approved);
}
function hasApprovedRelayer(address user, address relayer) external view override returns (bool) {
return _hasApprovedRelayer(user, relayer);
}
/**
* @dev Reverts unless `user` is the caller, or the caller is approved by the Authorizer to call the entry point
* function (that is, it is a relayer for that function) and either:
* a) `user` approved the caller as a relayer (via `setRelayerApproval`), or
* b) a valid signature from them was appended to the calldata.
*/
function _authenticateFor(address user) internal {
if (msg.sender != user) {
// In this context, 'permission to call a function' means 'being a relayer for a function'.
_authenticateCaller();
// Being a relayer is not sufficient: `user` must have also approved the caller either via
// `setRelayerApproval`, or by providing a signature appended to the calldata.
if (!_hasApprovedRelayer(user, msg.sender)) {
_validateSignature(user, Errors.USER_DOESNT_ALLOW_RELAYER);
}
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns true if `user` approved `relayer` to act as a relayer for them.
*/
function _hasApprovedRelayer(address user, address relayer) internal view returns (bool) {
return _approvedRelayers[user][relayer];
}
function _canPerform(bytes32 actionId, address user) internal view override returns (bool) {
// Access control is delegated to the Authorizer.
return _authorizer.canPerform(actionId, user, address(this));
}
function _typeHash() internal pure override returns (bytes32 hash) {
// This is a simple switch-case statement, trivially written in Solidity by chaining else-if statements, but the
// assembly implementation results in much denser bytecode.
// solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly
assembly {
// The function selector is located at the first 4 bytes of calldata. We copy the first full calldata
// 256 word, and then perform a logical shift to the right, moving the selector to the least significant
// 4 bytes.
let selector := shr(224, calldataload(0))
// With the selector in the least significant 4 bytes, we can use 4 byte literals with leading zeros,
// resulting in dense bytecode (PUSH4 opcodes).
switch selector
case 0xb95cac28 {
hash := _JOIN_TYPE_HASH
}
case 0x8bdb3913 {
hash := _EXIT_TYPE_HASH
}
case 0x52bbbe29 {
hash := _SWAP_TYPE_HASH
}
case 0x945bcec9 {
hash := _BATCH_SWAP_TYPE_HASH
}
case 0xfa6e671d {
hash := _SET_RELAYER_TYPE_HASH
}
default {
hash := 0x0000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000
}
}
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.
// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.
// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
// This flash loan provider was based on the Aave protocol's open source
// implementation and terminology and interfaces are intentionally kept
// similar
pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;
import "../lib/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/ReentrancyGuard.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/SafeERC20.sol";
import "./Fees.sol";
import "./interfaces/IFlashLoanRecipient.sol";
/**
* @dev Handles Flash Loans through the Vault. Calls the `receiveFlashLoan` hook on the flash loan recipient
* contract, which implements the `IFlashLoanRecipient` interface.
*/
abstract contract FlashLoans is Fees, ReentrancyGuard, TemporarilyPausable {
using SafeERC20 for IERC20;
function flashLoan(
IFlashLoanRecipient recipient,
IERC20[] memory tokens,
uint256[] memory amounts,
bytes memory userData
) external override nonReentrant whenNotPaused {
InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(tokens.length, amounts.length);
uint256[] memory feeAmounts = new uint256[](tokens.length);
uint256[] memory preLoanBalances = new uint256[](tokens.length);
// Used to ensure `tokens` is sorted in ascending order, which ensures token uniqueness.
IERC20 previousToken = IERC20(0);
for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) {
IERC20 token = tokens[i];
uint256 amount = amounts[i];
_require(token > previousToken, token == IERC20(0) ? Errors.ZERO_TOKEN : Errors.UNSORTED_TOKENS);
previousToken = token;
preLoanBalances[i] = token.balanceOf(address(this));
feeAmounts[i] = _calculateFlashLoanFeeAmount(amount);
_require(preLoanBalances[i] >= amount, Errors.INSUFFICIENT_FLASH_LOAN_BALANCE);
token.safeTransfer(address(recipient), amount);
}
recipient.receiveFlashLoan(tokens, amounts, feeAmounts, userData);
for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) {
IERC20 token = tokens[i];
uint256 preLoanBalance = preLoanBalances[i];
// Checking for loan repayment first (without accounting for fees) makes for simpler debugging, and results
// in more accurate revert reasons if the flash loan protocol fee percentage is zero.
uint256 postLoanBalance = token.balanceOf(address(this));
_require(postLoanBalance >= preLoanBalance, Errors.INVALID_POST_LOAN_BALANCE);
// No need for checked arithmetic since we know the loan was fully repaid.
uint256 receivedFeeAmount = postLoanBalance - preLoanBalance;
_require(receivedFeeAmount >= feeAmounts[i], Errors.INSUFFICIENT_FLASH_LOAN_FEE_AMOUNT);
_payFeeAmount(token, receivedFeeAmount);
emit FlashLoan(recipient, token, amounts[i], receivedFeeAmount);
}
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.
// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.
// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;
import "../lib/math/Math.sol";
import "../lib/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol";
import "../lib/helpers/InputHelpers.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/EnumerableMap.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/EnumerableSet.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/ReentrancyGuard.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/SafeCast.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/SafeERC20.sol";
import "./PoolBalances.sol";
import "./interfaces/IPoolSwapStructs.sol";
import "./interfaces/IGeneralPool.sol";
import "./interfaces/IMinimalSwapInfoPool.sol";
import "./balances/BalanceAllocation.sol";
/**
* Implements the Vault's high-level swap functionality.
*
* Users can swap tokens with Pools by calling the `swap` and `batchSwap` functions. They need not trust the Pool
* contracts to do this: all security checks are made by the Vault.
*
* The `swap` function executes a single swap, while `batchSwap` can perform multiple swaps in sequence.
* In each individual swap, tokens of one kind are sent from the sender to the Pool (this is the 'token in'),
* and tokens of another kind are sent from the Pool to the recipient in exchange (this is the 'token out').
* More complex swaps, such as one 'token in' to multiple tokens out can be achieved by batching together
* individual swaps.
*/
abstract contract Swaps is ReentrancyGuard, PoolBalances {
using SafeERC20 for IERC20;
using EnumerableSet for EnumerableSet.AddressSet;
using EnumerableMap for EnumerableMap.IERC20ToBytes32Map;
using Math for int256;
using Math for uint256;
using SafeCast for uint256;
using BalanceAllocation for bytes32;
function swap(
SingleSwap memory singleSwap,
FundManagement memory funds,
uint256 limit,
uint256 deadline
)
external
payable
override
nonReentrant
whenNotPaused
authenticateFor(funds.sender)
returns (uint256 amountCalculated)
{
// The deadline is timestamp-based: it should not be relied upon for sub-minute accuracy.
// solhint-disable-next-line not-rely-on-time
_require(block.timestamp <= deadline, Errors.SWAP_DEADLINE);
// This revert reason is for consistency with `batchSwap`: an equivalent `swap` performed using that function
// would result in this error.
_require(singleSwap.amount > 0, Errors.UNKNOWN_AMOUNT_IN_FIRST_SWAP);
IERC20 tokenIn = _translateToIERC20(singleSwap.assetIn);
IERC20 tokenOut = _translateToIERC20(singleSwap.assetOut);
_require(tokenIn != tokenOut, Errors.CANNOT_SWAP_SAME_TOKEN);
// Initializing each struct field one-by-one uses less gas than setting all at once.
IPoolSwapStructs.SwapRequest memory poolRequest;
poolRequest.poolId = singleSwap.poolId;
poolRequest.kind = singleSwap.kind;
poolRequest.tokenIn = tokenIn;
poolRequest.tokenOut = tokenOut;
poolRequest.amount = singleSwap.amount;
poolRequest.userData = singleSwap.userData;
poolRequest.from = funds.sender;
poolRequest.to = funds.recipient;
// The lastChangeBlock field is left uninitialized.
uint256 amountIn;
uint256 amountOut;
(amountCalculated, amountIn, amountOut) = _swapWithPool(poolRequest);
_require(singleSwap.kind == SwapKind.GIVEN_IN ? amountOut >= limit : amountIn <= limit, Errors.SWAP_LIMIT);
_receiveAsset(singleSwap.assetIn, amountIn, funds.sender, funds.fromInternalBalance);
_sendAsset(singleSwap.assetOut, amountOut, funds.recipient, funds.toInternalBalance);
// If the asset in is ETH, then `amountIn` ETH was wrapped into WETH.
_handleRemainingEth(_isETH(singleSwap.assetIn) ? amountIn : 0);
}
function batchSwap(
SwapKind kind,
BatchSwapStep[] memory swaps,
IAsset[] memory assets,
FundManagement memory funds,
int256[] memory limits,
uint256 deadline
)
external
payable
override
nonReentrant
whenNotPaused
authenticateFor(funds.sender)
returns (int256[] memory assetDeltas)
{
// The deadline is timestamp-based: it should not be relied upon for sub-minute accuracy.
// solhint-disable-next-line not-rely-on-time
_require(block.timestamp <= deadline, Errors.SWAP_DEADLINE);
InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(assets.length, limits.length);
// Perform the swaps, updating the Pool token balances and computing the net Vault asset deltas.
assetDeltas = _swapWithPools(swaps, assets, funds, kind);
// Process asset deltas, by either transferring assets from the sender (for positive deltas) or to the recipient
// (for negative deltas).
uint256 wrappedEth = 0;
for (uint256 i = 0; i < assets.length; ++i) {
IAsset asset = assets[i];
int256 delta = assetDeltas[i];
_require(delta <= limits[i], Errors.SWAP_LIMIT);
if (delta > 0) {
uint256 toReceive = uint256(delta);
_receiveAsset(asset, toReceive, funds.sender, funds.fromInternalBalance);
if (_isETH(asset)) {
wrappedEth = wrappedEth.add(toReceive);
}
} else if (delta < 0) {
uint256 toSend = uint256(-delta);
_sendAsset(asset, toSend, funds.recipient, funds.toInternalBalance);
}
}
// Handle any used and remaining ETH.
_handleRemainingEth(wrappedEth);
}
// For `_swapWithPools` to handle both 'given in' and 'given out' swaps, it internally tracks the 'given' amount
// (supplied by the caller), and the 'calculated' amount (returned by the Pool in response to the swap request).
/**
* @dev Given the two swap tokens and the swap kind, returns which one is the 'given' token (the token whose
* amount is supplied by the caller).
*/
function _tokenGiven(
SwapKind kind,
IERC20 tokenIn,
IERC20 tokenOut
) private pure returns (IERC20) {
return kind == SwapKind.GIVEN_IN ? tokenIn : tokenOut;
}
/**
* @dev Given the two swap tokens and the swap kind, returns which one is the 'calculated' token (the token whose
* amount is calculated by the Pool).
*/
function _tokenCalculated(
SwapKind kind,
IERC20 tokenIn,
IERC20 tokenOut
) private pure returns (IERC20) {
return kind == SwapKind.GIVEN_IN ? tokenOut : tokenIn;
}
/**
* @dev Returns an ordered pair (amountIn, amountOut) given the 'given' and 'calculated' amounts, and the swap kind.
*/
function _getAmounts(
SwapKind kind,
uint256 amountGiven,
uint256 amountCalculated
) private pure returns (uint256 amountIn, uint256 amountOut) {
if (kind == SwapKind.GIVEN_IN) {
(amountIn, amountOut) = (amountGiven, amountCalculated);
} else {
// SwapKind.GIVEN_OUT
(amountIn, amountOut) = (amountCalculated, amountGiven);
}
}
/**
* @dev Performs all `swaps`, calling swap hooks on the Pool contracts and updating their balances. Does not cause
* any transfer of tokens - instead it returns the net Vault token deltas: positive if the Vault should receive
* tokens, and negative if it should send them.
*/
function _swapWithPools(
BatchSwapStep[] memory swaps,
IAsset[] memory assets,
FundManagement memory funds,
SwapKind kind
) private returns (int256[] memory assetDeltas) {
assetDeltas = new int256[](assets.length);
// These variables could be declared inside the loop, but that causes the compiler to allocate memory on each
// loop iteration, increasing gas costs.
BatchSwapStep memory batchSwapStep;
IPoolSwapStructs.SwapRequest memory poolRequest;
// These store data about the previous swap here to implement multihop logic across swaps.
IERC20 previousTokenCalculated;
uint256 previousAmountCalculated;
for (uint256 i = 0; i < swaps.length; ++i) {
batchSwapStep = swaps[i];
bool withinBounds = batchSwapStep.assetInIndex < assets.length &&
batchSwapStep.assetOutIndex < assets.length;
_require(withinBounds, Errors.OUT_OF_BOUNDS);
IERC20 tokenIn = _translateToIERC20(assets[batchSwapStep.assetInIndex]);
IERC20 tokenOut = _translateToIERC20(assets[batchSwapStep.assetOutIndex]);
_require(tokenIn != tokenOut, Errors.CANNOT_SWAP_SAME_TOKEN);
// Sentinel value for multihop logic
if (batchSwapStep.amount == 0) {
// When the amount given is zero, we use the calculated amount for the previous swap, as long as the
// current swap's given token is the previous calculated token. This makes it possible to swap a
// given amount of token A for token B, and then use the resulting token B amount to swap for token C.
_require(i > 0, Errors.UNKNOWN_AMOUNT_IN_FIRST_SWAP);
bool usingPreviousToken = previousTokenCalculated == _tokenGiven(kind, tokenIn, tokenOut);
_require(usingPreviousToken, Errors.MALCONSTRUCTED_MULTIHOP_SWAP);
batchSwapStep.amount = previousAmountCalculated;
}
// Initializing each struct field one-by-one uses less gas than setting all at once
poolRequest.poolId = batchSwapStep.poolId;
poolRequest.kind = kind;
poolRequest.tokenIn = tokenIn;
poolRequest.tokenOut = tokenOut;
poolRequest.amount = batchSwapStep.amount;
poolRequest.userData = batchSwapStep.userData;
poolRequest.from = funds.sender;
poolRequest.to = funds.recipient;
// The lastChangeBlock field is left uninitialized
uint256 amountIn;
uint256 amountOut;
(previousAmountCalculated, amountIn, amountOut) = _swapWithPool(poolRequest);
previousTokenCalculated = _tokenCalculated(kind, tokenIn, tokenOut);
// Accumulate Vault deltas across swaps
assetDeltas[batchSwapStep.assetInIndex] = assetDeltas[batchSwapStep.assetInIndex].add(amountIn.toInt256());
assetDeltas[batchSwapStep.assetOutIndex] = assetDeltas[batchSwapStep.assetOutIndex].sub(
amountOut.toInt256()
);
}
}
/**
* @dev Performs a swap according to the parameters specified in `request`, calling the Pool's contract hook and
* updating the Pool's balance.
*
* Returns the amount of tokens going into or out of the Vault as a result of this swap, depending on the swap kind.
*/
function _swapWithPool(IPoolSwapStructs.SwapRequest memory request)
private
returns (
uint256 amountCalculated,
uint256 amountIn,
uint256 amountOut
)
{
// Get the calculated amount from the Pool and update its balances
address pool = _getPoolAddress(request.poolId);
PoolSpecialization specialization = _getPoolSpecialization(request.poolId);
if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.TWO_TOKEN) {
amountCalculated = _processTwoTokenPoolSwapRequest(request, IMinimalSwapInfoPool(pool));
} else if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.MINIMAL_SWAP_INFO) {
amountCalculated = _processMinimalSwapInfoPoolSwapRequest(request, IMinimalSwapInfoPool(pool));
} else {
// PoolSpecialization.GENERAL
amountCalculated = _processGeneralPoolSwapRequest(request, IGeneralPool(pool));
}
(amountIn, amountOut) = _getAmounts(request.kind, request.amount, amountCalculated);
emit Swap(request.poolId, request.tokenIn, request.tokenOut, amountIn, amountOut);
}
function _processTwoTokenPoolSwapRequest(IPoolSwapStructs.SwapRequest memory request, IMinimalSwapInfoPool pool)
private
returns (uint256 amountCalculated)
{
// For gas efficiency reasons, this function uses low-level knowledge of how Two Token Pool balances are
// stored internally, instead of using getters and setters for all operations.
(
bytes32 tokenABalance,
bytes32 tokenBBalance,
TwoTokenPoolBalances storage poolBalances
) = _getTwoTokenPoolSharedBalances(request.poolId, request.tokenIn, request.tokenOut);
// We have the two Pool balances, but we don't know which one is 'token in' or 'token out'.
bytes32 tokenInBalance;
bytes32 tokenOutBalance;
// In Two Token Pools, token A has a smaller address than token B
if (request.tokenIn < request.tokenOut) {
// in is A, out is B
tokenInBalance = tokenABalance;
tokenOutBalance = tokenBBalance;
} else {
// in is B, out is A
tokenOutBalance = tokenABalance;
tokenInBalance = tokenBBalance;
}
// Perform the swap request and compute the new balances for 'token in' and 'token out' after the swap
(tokenInBalance, tokenOutBalance, amountCalculated) = _callMinimalSwapInfoPoolOnSwapHook(
request,
pool,
tokenInBalance,
tokenOutBalance
);
// We check the token ordering again to create the new shared cash packed struct
poolBalances.sharedCash = request.tokenIn < request.tokenOut
? BalanceAllocation.toSharedCash(tokenInBalance, tokenOutBalance) // in is A, out is B
: BalanceAllocation.toSharedCash(tokenOutBalance, tokenInBalance); // in is B, out is A
}
function _processMinimalSwapInfoPoolSwapRequest(
IPoolSwapStructs.SwapRequest memory request,
IMinimalSwapInfoPool pool
) private returns (uint256 amountCalculated) {
bytes32 tokenInBalance = _getMinimalSwapInfoPoolBalance(request.poolId, request.tokenIn);
bytes32 tokenOutBalance = _getMinimalSwapInfoPoolBalance(request.poolId, request.tokenOut);
// Perform the swap request and compute the new balances for 'token in' and 'token out' after the swap
(tokenInBalance, tokenOutBalance, amountCalculated) = _callMinimalSwapInfoPoolOnSwapHook(
request,
pool,
tokenInBalance,
tokenOutBalance
);
_minimalSwapInfoPoolsBalances[request.poolId][request.tokenIn] = tokenInBalance;
_minimalSwapInfoPoolsBalances[request.poolId][request.tokenOut] = tokenOutBalance;
}
/**
* @dev Calls the onSwap hook for a Pool that implements IMinimalSwapInfoPool: both Minimal Swap Info and Two Token
* Pools do this.
*/
function _callMinimalSwapInfoPoolOnSwapHook(
IPoolSwapStructs.SwapRequest memory request,
IMinimalSwapInfoPool pool,
bytes32 tokenInBalance,
bytes32 tokenOutBalance
)
internal
returns (
bytes32 newTokenInBalance,
bytes32 newTokenOutBalance,
uint256 amountCalculated
)
{
uint256 tokenInTotal = tokenInBalance.total();
uint256 tokenOutTotal = tokenOutBalance.total();
request.lastChangeBlock = Math.max(tokenInBalance.lastChangeBlock(), tokenOutBalance.lastChangeBlock());
// Perform the swap request callback, and compute the new balances for 'token in' and 'token out' after the swap
amountCalculated = pool.onSwap(request, tokenInTotal, tokenOutTotal);
(uint256 amountIn, uint256 amountOut) = _getAmounts(request.kind, request.amount, amountCalculated);
newTokenInBalance = tokenInBalance.increaseCash(amountIn);
newTokenOutBalance = tokenOutBalance.decreaseCash(amountOut);
}
function _processGeneralPoolSwapRequest(IPoolSwapStructs.SwapRequest memory request, IGeneralPool pool)
private
returns (uint256 amountCalculated)
{
bytes32 tokenInBalance;
bytes32 tokenOutBalance;
// We access both token indexes without checking existence, because we will do it manually immediately after.
EnumerableMap.IERC20ToBytes32Map storage poolBalances = _generalPoolsBalances[request.poolId];
uint256 indexIn = poolBalances.unchecked_indexOf(request.tokenIn);
uint256 indexOut = poolBalances.unchecked_indexOf(request.tokenOut);
if (indexIn == 0 || indexOut == 0) {
// The tokens might not be registered because the Pool itself is not registered. We check this to provide a
// more accurate revert reason.
_ensureRegisteredPool(request.poolId);
_revert(Errors.TOKEN_NOT_REGISTERED);
}
// EnumerableMap stores indices *plus one* to use the zero index as a sentinel value - because these are valid,
// we can undo this.
indexIn -= 1;
indexOut -= 1;
uint256 tokenAmount = poolBalances.length();
uint256[] memory currentBalances = new uint256[](tokenAmount);
request.lastChangeBlock = 0;
for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokenAmount; i++) {
// Because the iteration is bounded by `tokenAmount`, and no tokens are registered or deregistered here, we
// know `i` is a valid token index and can use `unchecked_valueAt` to save storage reads.
bytes32 balance = poolBalances.unchecked_valueAt(i);
currentBalances[i] = balance.total();
request.lastChangeBlock = Math.max(request.lastChangeBlock, balance.lastChangeBlock());
if (i == indexIn) {
tokenInBalance = balance;
} else if (i == indexOut) {
tokenOutBalance = balance;
}
}
// Perform the swap request callback and compute the new balances for 'token in' and 'token out' after the swap
amountCalculated = pool.onSwap(request, currentBalances, indexIn, indexOut);
(uint256 amountIn, uint256 amountOut) = _getAmounts(request.kind, request.amount, amountCalculated);
tokenInBalance = tokenInBalance.increaseCash(amountIn);
tokenOutBalance = tokenOutBalance.decreaseCash(amountOut);
// Because no tokens were registered or deregistered between now or when we retrieved the indexes for
// 'token in' and 'token out', we can use `unchecked_setAt` to save storage reads.
poolBalances.unchecked_setAt(indexIn, tokenInBalance);
poolBalances.unchecked_setAt(indexOut, tokenOutBalance);
}
// This function is not marked as `nonReentrant` because the underlying mechanism relies on reentrancy
function queryBatchSwap(
SwapKind kind,
BatchSwapStep[] memory swaps,
IAsset[] memory assets,
FundManagement memory funds
) external override returns (int256[] memory) {
// In order to accurately 'simulate' swaps, this function actually does perform the swaps, including calling the
// Pool hooks and updating balances in storage. However, once it computes the final Vault Deltas, it
// reverts unconditionally, returning this array as the revert data.
//
// By wrapping this reverting call, we can decode the deltas 'returned' and return them as a normal Solidity
// function would. The only caveat is the function becomes non-view, but off-chain clients can still call it
// via eth_call to get the expected result.
//
// This technique was inspired by the work from the Gnosis team in the Gnosis Safe contract:
// https://github.com/gnosis/safe-contracts/blob/v1.2.0/contracts/GnosisSafe.sol#L265
//
// Most of this function is implemented using inline assembly, as the actual work it needs to do is not
// significant, and Solidity is not particularly well-suited to generate this behavior, resulting in a large
// amount of generated bytecode.
if (msg.sender != address(this)) {
// We perform an external call to ourselves, forwarding the same calldata. In this call, the else clause of
// the preceding if statement will be executed instead.
// solhint-disable-next-line avoid-low-level-calls
(bool success, ) = address(this).call(msg.data);
// solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly
assembly {
// This call should always revert to decode the actual asset deltas from the revert reason
switch success
case 0 {
// Note we are manually writing the memory slot 0. We can safely overwrite whatever is
// stored there as we take full control of the execution and then immediately return.
// We copy the first 4 bytes to check if it matches with the expected signature, otherwise
// there was another revert reason and we should forward it.
returndatacopy(0, 0, 0x04)
let error := and(mload(0), 0xffffffff00000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000)
// If the first 4 bytes don't match with the expected signature, we forward the revert reason.
if eq(eq(error, 0xfa61cc1200000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000), 0) {
returndatacopy(0, 0, returndatasize())
revert(0, returndatasize())
}
// The returndata contains the signature, followed by the raw memory representation of an array:
// length + data. We need to return an ABI-encoded representation of this array.
// An ABI-encoded array contains an additional field when compared to its raw memory
// representation: an offset to the location of the length. The offset itself is 32 bytes long,
// so the smallest value we can use is 32 for the data to be located immediately after it.
mstore(0, 32)
// We now copy the raw memory array from returndata into memory. Since the offset takes up 32
// bytes, we start copying at address 0x20. We also get rid of the error signature, which takes
// the first four bytes of returndata.
let size := sub(returndatasize(), 0x04)
returndatacopy(0x20, 0x04, size)
// We finally return the ABI-encoded array, which has a total length equal to that of the array
// (returndata), plus the 32 bytes for the offset.
return(0, add(size, 32))
}
default {
// This call should always revert, but we fail nonetheless if that didn't happen
invalid()
}
}
} else {
int256[] memory deltas = _swapWithPools(swaps, assets, funds, kind);
// solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly
assembly {
// We will return a raw representation of the array in memory, which is composed of a 32 byte length,
// followed by the 32 byte int256 values. Because revert expects a size in bytes, we multiply the array
// length (stored at `deltas`) by 32.
let size := mul(mload(deltas), 32)
// We send one extra value for the error signature "QueryError(int256[])" which is 0xfa61cc12.
// We store it in the previous slot to the `deltas` array. We know there will be at least one available
// slot due to how the memory scratch space works.
// We can safely overwrite whatever is stored in this slot as we will revert immediately after that.
mstore(sub(deltas, 0x20), 0x00000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000fa61cc12)
let start := sub(deltas, 0x04)
// When copying from `deltas` into returndata, we copy an additional 36 bytes to also return the array's
// length and the error signature.
revert(start, add(size, 36))
}
}
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
/**
* @dev Interface of the ERC20 standard as defined in the EIP.
*/
interface IERC20 {
/**
* @dev Returns the amount of tokens in existence.
*/
function totalSupply() external view returns (uint256);
/**
* @dev Returns the amount of tokens owned by `account`.
*/
function balanceOf(address account) external view returns (uint256);
/**
* @dev Moves `amount` tokens from the caller's account to `recipient`.
*
* Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function transfer(address recipient, uint256 amount) external returns (bool);
/**
* @dev Returns the remaining number of tokens that `spender` will be
* allowed to spend on behalf of `owner` through {transferFrom}. This is
* zero by default.
*
* This value changes when {approve} or {transferFrom} are called.
*/
function allowance(address owner, address spender) external view returns (uint256);
/**
* @dev Sets `amount` as the allowance of `spender` over the caller's tokens.
*
* Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded.
*
* IMPORTANT: Beware that changing an allowance with this method brings the risk
* that someone may use both the old and the new allowance by unfortunate
* transaction ordering. One possible solution to mitigate this race
* condition is to first reduce the spender's allowance to 0 and set the
* desired value afterwards:
* https://github.com/ethereum/EIPs/issues/20#issuecomment-263524729
*
* Emits an {Approval} event.
*/
function approve(address spender, uint256 amount) external returns (bool);
/**
* @dev Moves `amount` tokens from `sender` to `recipient` using the
* allowance mechanism. `amount` is then deducted from the caller's
* allowance.
*
* Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function transferFrom(
address sender,
address recipient,
uint256 amount
) external returns (bool);
/**
* @dev Emitted when `value` tokens are moved from one account (`from`) to
* another (`to`).
*
* Note that `value` may be zero.
*/
event Transfer(address indexed from, address indexed to, uint256 value);
/**
* @dev Emitted when the allowance of a `spender` for an `owner` is set by
* a call to {approve}. `value` is the new allowance.
*/
event Approval(address indexed owner, address indexed spender, uint256 value);
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.
// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.
// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
// solhint-disable
/**
* @dev Reverts if `condition` is false, with a revert reason containing `errorCode`. Only codes up to 999 are
* supported.
*/
function _require(bool condition, uint256 errorCode) pure {
if (!condition) _revert(errorCode);
}
/**
* @dev Reverts with a revert reason containing `errorCode`. Only codes up to 999 are supported.
*/
function _revert(uint256 errorCode) pure {
// We're going to dynamically create a revert string based on the error code, with the following format:
// 'BAL#{errorCode}'
// where the code is left-padded with zeroes to three digits (so they range from 000 to 999).
//
// We don't have revert strings embedded in the contract to save bytecode size: it takes much less space to store a
// number (8 to 16 bits) than the individual string characters.
//
// The dynamic string creation algorithm that follows could be implemented in Solidity, but assembly allows for a
// much denser implementation, again saving bytecode size. Given this function unconditionally reverts, this is a
// safe place to rely on it without worrying about how its usage might affect e.g. memory contents.
assembly {
// First, we need to compute the ASCII representation of the error code. We assume that it is in the 0-999
// range, so we only need to convert three digits. To convert the digits to ASCII, we add 0x30, the value for
// the '0' character.
let units := add(mod(errorCode, 10), 0x30)
errorCode := div(errorCode, 10)
let tenths := add(mod(errorCode, 10), 0x30)
errorCode := div(errorCode, 10)
let hundreds := add(mod(errorCode, 10), 0x30)
// With the individual characters, we can now construct the full string. The "BAL#" part is a known constant
// (0x42414c23): we simply shift this by 24 (to provide space for the 3 bytes of the error code), and add the
// characters to it, each shifted by a multiple of 8.
// The revert reason is then shifted left by 200 bits (256 minus the length of the string, 7 characters * 8 bits
// per character = 56) to locate it in the most significant part of the 256 slot (the beginning of a byte
// array).
let revertReason := shl(200, add(0x42414c23000000, add(add(units, shl(8, tenths)), shl(16, hundreds))))
// We can now encode the reason in memory, which can be safely overwritten as we're about to revert. The encoded
// message will have the following layout:
// [ revert reason identifier ] [ string location offset ] [ string length ] [ string contents ]
// The Solidity revert reason identifier is 0x08c739a0, the function selector of the Error(string) function. We
// also write zeroes to the next 28 bytes of memory, but those are about to be overwritten.
mstore(0x0, 0x08c379a000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000)
// Next is the offset to the location of the string, which will be placed immediately after (20 bytes away).
mstore(0x04, 0x0000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000020)
// The string length is fixed: 7 characters.
mstore(0x24, 7)
// Finally, the string itself is stored.
mstore(0x44, revertReason)
// Even if the string is only 7 bytes long, we need to return a full 32 byte slot containing it. The length of
// the encoded message is therefore 4 + 32 + 32 + 32 = 100.
revert(0, 100)
}
}
library Errors {
// Math
uint256 internal constant ADD_OVERFLOW = 0;
uint256 internal constant SUB_OVERFLOW = 1;
uint256 internal constant SUB_UNDERFLOW = 2;
uint256 internal constant MUL_OVERFLOW = 3;
uint256 internal constant ZERO_DIVISION = 4;
uint256 internal constant DIV_INTERNAL = 5;
uint256 internal constant X_OUT_OF_BOUNDS = 6;
uint256 internal constant Y_OUT_OF_BOUNDS = 7;
uint256 internal constant PRODUCT_OUT_OF_BOUNDS = 8;
uint256 internal constant INVALID_EXPONENT = 9;
// Input
uint256 internal constant OUT_OF_BOUNDS = 100;
uint256 internal constant UNSORTED_ARRAY = 101;
uint256 internal constant UNSORTED_TOKENS = 102;
uint256 internal constant INPUT_LENGTH_MISMATCH = 103;
uint256 internal constant ZERO_TOKEN = 104;
// Shared pools
uint256 internal constant MIN_TOKENS = 200;
uint256 internal constant MAX_TOKENS = 201;
uint256 internal constant MAX_SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE = 202;
uint256 internal constant MIN_SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE = 203;
uint256 internal constant MINIMUM_BPT = 204;
uint256 internal constant CALLER_NOT_VAULT = 205;
uint256 internal constant UNINITIALIZED = 206;
uint256 internal constant BPT_IN_MAX_AMOUNT = 207;
uint256 internal constant BPT_OUT_MIN_AMOUNT = 208;
uint256 internal constant EXPIRED_PERMIT = 209;
// Pools
uint256 internal constant MIN_AMP = 300;
uint256 internal constant MAX_AMP = 301;
uint256 internal constant MIN_WEIGHT = 302;
uint256 internal constant MAX_STABLE_TOKENS = 303;
uint256 internal constant MAX_IN_RATIO = 304;
uint256 internal constant MAX_OUT_RATIO = 305;
uint256 internal constant MIN_BPT_IN_FOR_TOKEN_OUT = 306;
uint256 internal constant MAX_OUT_BPT_FOR_TOKEN_IN = 307;
uint256 internal constant NORMALIZED_WEIGHT_INVARIANT = 308;
uint256 internal constant INVALID_TOKEN = 309;
uint256 internal constant UNHANDLED_JOIN_KIND = 310;
uint256 internal constant ZERO_INVARIANT = 311;
// Lib
uint256 internal constant REENTRANCY = 400;
uint256 internal constant SENDER_NOT_ALLOWED = 401;
uint256 internal constant PAUSED = 402;
uint256 internal constant PAUSE_WINDOW_EXPIRED = 403;
uint256 internal constant MAX_PAUSE_WINDOW_DURATION = 404;
uint256 internal constant MAX_BUFFER_PERIOD_DURATION = 405;
uint256 internal constant INSUFFICIENT_BALANCE = 406;
uint256 internal constant INSUFFICIENT_ALLOWANCE = 407;
uint256 internal constant ERC20_TRANSFER_FROM_ZERO_ADDRESS = 408;
uint256 internal constant ERC20_TRANSFER_TO_ZERO_ADDRESS = 409;
uint256 internal constant ERC20_MINT_TO_ZERO_ADDRESS = 410;
uint256 internal constant ERC20_BURN_FROM_ZERO_ADDRESS = 411;
uint256 internal constant ERC20_APPROVE_FROM_ZERO_ADDRESS = 412;
uint256 internal constant ERC20_APPROVE_TO_ZERO_ADDRESS = 413;
uint256 internal constant ERC20_TRANSFER_EXCEEDS_ALLOWANCE = 414;
uint256 internal constant ERC20_DECREASED_ALLOWANCE_BELOW_ZERO = 415;
uint256 internal constant ERC20_TRANSFER_EXCEEDS_BALANCE = 416;
uint256 internal constant ERC20_BURN_EXCEEDS_ALLOWANCE = 417;
uint256 internal constant SAFE_ERC20_CALL_FAILED = 418;
uint256 internal constant ADDRESS_INSUFFICIENT_BALANCE = 419;
uint256 internal constant ADDRESS_CANNOT_SEND_VALUE = 420;
uint256 internal constant SAFE_CAST_VALUE_CANT_FIT_INT256 = 421;
uint256 internal constant GRANT_SENDER_NOT_ADMIN = 422;
uint256 internal constant REVOKE_SENDER_NOT_ADMIN = 423;
uint256 internal constant RENOUNCE_SENDER_NOT_ALLOWED = 424;
uint256 internal constant BUFFER_PERIOD_EXPIRED = 425;
// Vault
uint256 internal constant INVALID_POOL_ID = 500;
uint256 internal constant CALLER_NOT_POOL = 501;
uint256 internal constant SENDER_NOT_ASSET_MANAGER = 502;
uint256 internal constant USER_DOESNT_ALLOW_RELAYER = 503;
uint256 internal constant INVALID_SIGNATURE = 504;
uint256 internal constant EXIT_BELOW_MIN = 505;
uint256 internal constant JOIN_ABOVE_MAX = 506;
uint256 internal constant SWAP_LIMIT = 507;
uint256 internal constant SWAP_DEADLINE = 508;
uint256 internal constant CANNOT_SWAP_SAME_TOKEN = 509;
uint256 internal constant UNKNOWN_AMOUNT_IN_FIRST_SWAP = 510;
uint256 internal constant MALCONSTRUCTED_MULTIHOP_SWAP = 511;
uint256 internal constant INTERNAL_BALANCE_OVERFLOW = 512;
uint256 internal constant INSUFFICIENT_INTERNAL_BALANCE = 513;
uint256 internal constant INVALID_ETH_INTERNAL_BALANCE = 514;
uint256 internal constant INVALID_POST_LOAN_BALANCE = 515;
uint256 internal constant INSUFFICIENT_ETH = 516;
uint256 internal constant UNALLOCATED_ETH = 517;
uint256 internal constant ETH_TRANSFER = 518;
uint256 internal constant CANNOT_USE_ETH_SENTINEL = 519;
uint256 internal constant TOKENS_MISMATCH = 520;
uint256 internal constant TOKEN_NOT_REGISTERED = 521;
uint256 internal constant TOKEN_ALREADY_REGISTERED = 522;
uint256 internal constant TOKENS_ALREADY_SET = 523;
uint256 internal constant TOKENS_LENGTH_MUST_BE_2 = 524;
uint256 internal constant NONZERO_TOKEN_BALANCE = 525;
uint256 internal constant BALANCE_TOTAL_OVERFLOW = 526;
uint256 internal constant POOL_NO_TOKENS = 527;
uint256 internal constant INSUFFICIENT_FLASH_LOAN_BALANCE = 528;
// Fees
uint256 internal constant SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE_TOO_HIGH = 600;
uint256 internal constant FLASH_LOAN_FEE_PERCENTAGE_TOO_HIGH = 601;
uint256 internal constant INSUFFICIENT_FLASH_LOAN_FEE_AMOUNT = 602;
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.
// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.
// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
import "./BalancerErrors.sol";
import "./IAuthentication.sol";
/**
* @dev Building block for performing access control on external functions.
*
* This contract is used via the `authenticate` modifier (or the `_authenticateCaller` function), which can be applied
* to external functions to only make them callable by authorized accounts.
*
* Derived contracts must implement the `_canPerform` function, which holds the actual access control logic.
*/
abstract contract Authentication is IAuthentication {
bytes32 private immutable _actionIdDisambiguator;
/**
* @dev The main purpose of the `actionIdDisambiguator` is to prevent accidental function selector collisions in
* multi contract systems.
*
* There are two main uses for it:
* - if the contract is a singleton, any unique identifier can be used to make the associated action identifiers
* unique. The contract's own address is a good option.
* - if the contract belongs to a family that shares action identifiers for the same functions, an identifier
* shared by the entire family (and no other contract) should be used instead.
*/
constructor(bytes32 actionIdDisambiguator) {
_actionIdDisambiguator = actionIdDisambiguator;
}
/**
* @dev Reverts unless the caller is allowed to call this function. Should only be applied to external functions.
*/
modifier authenticate() {
_authenticateCaller();
_;
}
/**
* @dev Reverts unless the caller is allowed to call the entry point function.
*/
function _authenticateCaller() internal view {
bytes32 actionId = getActionId(msg.sig);
_require(_canPerform(actionId, msg.sender), Errors.SENDER_NOT_ALLOWED);
}
function getActionId(bytes4 selector) public view override returns (bytes32) {
// Each external function is dynamically assigned an action identifier as the hash of the disambiguator and the
// function selector. Disambiguation is necessary to avoid potential collisions in the function selectors of
// multiple contracts.
return keccak256(abi.encodePacked(_actionIdDisambiguator, selector));
}
function _canPerform(bytes32 actionId, address user) internal view virtual returns (bool);
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.
// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.
// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
import "./BalancerErrors.sol";
import "./ITemporarilyPausable.sol";
/**
* @dev Allows for a contract to be paused during an initial period after deployment, disabling functionality. Can be
* used as an emergency switch in case a security vulnerability or threat is identified.
*
* The contract can only be paused during the Pause Window, a period that starts at deployment. It can also be
* unpaused and repaused any number of times during this period. This is intended to serve as a safety measure: it lets
* system managers react quickly to potentially dangerous situations, knowing that this action is reversible if careful
* analysis later determines there was a false alarm.
*
* If the contract is paused when the Pause Window finishes, it will remain in the paused state through an additional
* Buffer Period, after which it will be automatically unpaused forever. This is to ensure there is always enough time
* to react to an emergency, even if the threat is discovered shortly before the Pause Window expires.
*
* Note that since the contract can only be paused within the Pause Window, unpausing during the Buffer Period is
* irreversible.
*/
abstract contract TemporarilyPausable is ITemporarilyPausable {
// The Pause Window and Buffer Period are timestamp-based: they should not be relied upon for sub-minute accuracy.
// solhint-disable not-rely-on-time
uint256 private constant _MAX_PAUSE_WINDOW_DURATION = 90 days;
uint256 private constant _MAX_BUFFER_PERIOD_DURATION = 30 days;
uint256 private immutable _pauseWindowEndTime;
uint256 private immutable _bufferPeriodEndTime;
bool private _paused;
constructor(uint256 pauseWindowDuration, uint256 bufferPeriodDuration) {
_require(pauseWindowDuration <= _MAX_PAUSE_WINDOW_DURATION, Errors.MAX_PAUSE_WINDOW_DURATION);
_require(bufferPeriodDuration <= _MAX_BUFFER_PERIOD_DURATION, Errors.MAX_BUFFER_PERIOD_DURATION);
uint256 pauseWindowEndTime = block.timestamp + pauseWindowDuration;
_pauseWindowEndTime = pauseWindowEndTime;
_bufferPeriodEndTime = pauseWindowEndTime + bufferPeriodDuration;
}
/**
* @dev Reverts if the contract is paused.
*/
modifier whenNotPaused() {
_ensureNotPaused();
_;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the current contract pause status, as well as the end times of the Pause Window and Buffer
* Period.
*/
function getPausedState()
external
view
override
returns (
bool paused,
uint256 pauseWindowEndTime,
uint256 bufferPeriodEndTime
)
{
paused = !_isNotPaused();
pauseWindowEndTime = _getPauseWindowEndTime();
bufferPeriodEndTime = _getBufferPeriodEndTime();
}
/**
* @dev Sets the pause state to `paused`. The contract can only be paused until the end of the Pause Window, and
* unpaused until the end of the Buffer Period.
*
* Once the Buffer Period expires, this function reverts unconditionally.
*/
function _setPaused(bool paused) internal {
if (paused) {
_require(block.timestamp < _getPauseWindowEndTime(), Errors.PAUSE_WINDOW_EXPIRED);
} else {
_require(block.timestamp < _getBufferPeriodEndTime(), Errors.BUFFER_PERIOD_EXPIRED);
}
_paused = paused;
emit PausedStateChanged(paused);
}
/**
* @dev Reverts if the contract is paused.
*/
function _ensureNotPaused() internal view {
_require(_isNotPaused(), Errors.PAUSED);
}
/**
* @dev Returns true if the contract is unpaused.
*
* Once the Buffer Period expires, the gas cost of calling this function is reduced dramatically, as storage is no
* longer accessed.
*/
function _isNotPaused() internal view returns (bool) {
// After the Buffer Period, the (inexpensive) timestamp check short-circuits the storage access.
return block.timestamp > _getBufferPeriodEndTime() || !_paused;
}
// These getters lead to reduced bytecode size by inlining the immutable variables in a single place.
function _getPauseWindowEndTime() private view returns (uint256) {
return _pauseWindowEndTime;
}
function _getBufferPeriodEndTime() private view returns (uint256) {
return _bufferPeriodEndTime;
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.
// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.
// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
import "./BalancerErrors.sol";
import "./ISignaturesValidator.sol";
import "../openzeppelin/EIP712.sol";
/**
* @dev Utility for signing Solidity function calls.
*
* This contract relies on the fact that Solidity contracts can be called with extra calldata, and enables
* meta-transaction schemes by appending an EIP712 signature of the original calldata at the end.
*
* Derived contracts must implement the `_typeHash` function to map function selectors to EIP712 structs.
*/
abstract contract SignaturesValidator is ISignaturesValidator, EIP712 {
// The appended data consists of a deadline, plus the [v,r,s] signature. For simplicity, we use a full 256 bit slot
// for each of these values, even if 'v' is typically an 8 bit value.
uint256 internal constant _EXTRA_CALLDATA_LENGTH = 4 * 32;
// Replay attack prevention for each user.
mapping(address => uint256) internal _nextNonce;
constructor(string memory name) EIP712(name, "1") {
// solhint-disable-previous-line no-empty-blocks
}
function getDomainSeparator() external view override returns (bytes32) {
return _domainSeparatorV4();
}
function getNextNonce(address user) external view override returns (uint256) {
return _nextNonce[user];
}
/**
* @dev Reverts with `errorCode` unless a valid signature for `user` was appended to the calldata.
*/
function _validateSignature(address user, uint256 errorCode) internal {
uint256 nextNonce = _nextNonce[user]++;
_require(_isSignatureValid(user, nextNonce), errorCode);
}
function _isSignatureValid(address user, uint256 nonce) private view returns (bool) {
uint256 deadline = _deadline();
// The deadline is timestamp-based: it should not be relied upon for sub-minute accuracy.
// solhint-disable-next-line not-rely-on-time
if (deadline < block.timestamp) {
return false;
}
bytes32 typeHash = _typeHash();
if (typeHash == bytes32(0)) {
// Prevent accidental signature validation for functions that don't have an associated type hash.
return false;
}
// All type hashes have this format: (bytes calldata, address sender, uint256 nonce, uint256 deadline).
bytes32 structHash = keccak256(abi.encode(typeHash, keccak256(_calldata()), msg.sender, nonce, deadline));
bytes32 digest = _hashTypedDataV4(structHash);
(uint8 v, bytes32 r, bytes32 s) = _signature();
address recoveredAddress = ecrecover(digest, v, r, s);
// ecrecover returns the zero address on recover failure, so we need to handle that explicitly.
return recoveredAddress != address(0) && recoveredAddress == user;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the EIP712 type hash for the current entry point function, which can be identified by its function
* selector (available as `msg.sig`).
*
* The type hash must conform to the following format:
* <name>(bytes calldata, address sender, uint256 nonce, uint256 deadline)
*
* If 0x00, all signatures will be considered invalid.
*/
function _typeHash() internal view virtual returns (bytes32);
/**
* @dev Extracts the signature deadline from extra calldata.
*
* This function returns bogus data if no signature is included.
*/
function _deadline() internal pure returns (uint256) {
// The deadline is the first extra argument at the end of the original calldata.
return uint256(_decodeExtraCalldataWord(0));
}
/**
* @dev Extracts the signature parameters from extra calldata.
*
* This function returns bogus data if no signature is included. This is not a security risk, as that data would not
* be considered a valid signature in the first place.
*/
function _signature()
internal
pure
returns (
uint8 v,
bytes32 r,
bytes32 s
)
{
// v, r and s are appended after the signature deadline, in that order.
v = uint8(uint256(_decodeExtraCalldataWord(0x20)));
r = _decodeExtraCalldataWord(0x40);
s = _decodeExtraCalldataWord(0x60);
}
/**
* @dev Returns the original calldata, without the extra bytes containing the signature.
*
* This function returns bogus data if no signature is included.
*/
function _calldata() internal pure returns (bytes memory result) {
result = msg.data; // A calldata to memory assignment results in memory allocation and copy of contents.
if (result.length > _EXTRA_CALLDATA_LENGTH) {
// solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly
assembly {
// We simply overwrite the array length with the reduced one.
mstore(result, sub(calldatasize(), _EXTRA_CALLDATA_LENGTH))
}
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns a 256 bit word from 'extra' calldata, at some offset from the expected end of the original calldata.
*
* This function returns bogus data if no signature is included.
*/
function _decodeExtraCalldataWord(uint256 offset) private pure returns (bytes32 result) {
// solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly
assembly {
result := calldataload(add(sub(calldatasize(), _EXTRA_CALLDATA_LENGTH), offset))
}
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
import "../helpers/BalancerErrors.sol";
// Based on the ReentrancyGuard library from OpenZeppelin contracts, altered to reduce bytecode size.
// Modifier code is inlined by the compiler, which causes its code to appear multiple times in the codebase. By using
// private functions, we achieve the same end result with slightly higher runtime gas costs but reduced bytecode size.
/**
* @dev Contract module that helps prevent reentrant calls to a function.
*
* Inheriting from `ReentrancyGuard` will make the {nonReentrant} modifier
* available, which can be applied to functions to make sure there are no nested
* (reentrant) calls to them.
*
* Note that because there is a single `nonReentrant` guard, functions marked as
* `nonReentrant` may not call one another. This can be worked around by making
* those functions `private`, and then adding `external` `nonReentrant` entry
* points to them.
*
* TIP: If you would like to learn more about reentrancy and alternative ways
* to protect against it, check out our blog post
* https://blog.openzeppelin.com/reentrancy-after-istanbul/[Reentrancy After Istanbul].
*/
abstract contract ReentrancyGuard {
// Booleans are more expensive than uint256 or any type that takes up a full
// word because each write operation emits an extra SLOAD to first read the
// slot's contents, replace the bits taken up by the boolean, and then write
// back. This is the compiler's defense against contract upgrades and
// pointer aliasing, and it cannot be disabled.
// The values being non-zero value makes deployment a bit more expensive,
// but in exchange the refund on every call to nonReentrant will be lower in
// amount. Since refunds are capped to a percentage of the total
// transaction's gas, it is best to keep them low in cases like this one, to
// increase the likelihood of the full refund coming into effect.
uint256 private constant _NOT_ENTERED = 1;
uint256 private constant _ENTERED = 2;
uint256 private _status;
constructor() {
_status = _NOT_ENTERED;
}
/**
* @dev Prevents a contract from calling itself, directly or indirectly.
* Calling a `nonReentrant` function from another `nonReentrant`
* function is not supported. It is possible to prevent this from happening
* by making the `nonReentrant` function external, and make it call a
* `private` function that does the actual work.
*/
modifier nonReentrant() {
_enterNonReentrant();
_;
_exitNonReentrant();
}
function _enterNonReentrant() private {
// On the first call to nonReentrant, _status will be _NOT_ENTERED
_require(_status != _ENTERED, Errors.REENTRANCY);
// Any calls to nonReentrant after this point will fail
_status = _ENTERED;
}
function _exitNonReentrant() private {
// By storing the original value once again, a refund is triggered (see
// https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2200)
_status = _NOT_ENTERED;
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.
// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.
// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;
import "../../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol";
import "./IWETH.sol";
import "./IAsset.sol";
import "./IAuthorizer.sol";
import "./IFlashLoanRecipient.sol";
import "../ProtocolFeesCollector.sol";
import "../../lib/helpers/ISignaturesValidator.sol";
import "../../lib/helpers/ITemporarilyPausable.sol";
pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
/**
* @dev Full external interface for the Vault core contract - no external or public methods exist in the contract that
* don't override one of these declarations.
*/
interface IVault is ISignaturesValidator, ITemporarilyPausable {
// Generalities about the Vault:
//
// - Whenever documentation refers to 'tokens', it strictly refers to ERC20-compliant token contracts. Tokens are
// transferred out of the Vault by calling the `IERC20.transfer` function, and transferred in by calling
// `IERC20.transferFrom`. In these cases, the sender must have previously allowed the Vault to use their tokens by
// calling `IERC20.approve`. The only deviation from the ERC20 standard that is supported is functions not returning
// a boolean value: in these scenarios, a non-reverting call is assumed to be successful.
//
// - All non-view functions in the Vault are non-reentrant: calling them while another one is mid-execution (e.g.
// while execution control is transferred to a token contract during a swap) will result in a revert. View
// functions can be called in a re-reentrant way, but doing so might cause them to return inconsistent results.
// Contracts calling view functions in the Vault must make sure the Vault has not already been entered.
//
// - View functions revert if referring to either unregistered Pools, or unregistered tokens for registered Pools.
// Authorizer
//
// Some system actions are permissioned, like setting and collecting protocol fees. This permissioning system exists
// outside of the Vault in the Authorizer contract: the Vault simply calls the Authorizer to check if the caller
// can perform a given action.
/**
* @dev Returns the Vault's Authorizer.
*/
function getAuthorizer() external view returns (IAuthorizer);
/**
* @dev Sets a new Authorizer for the Vault. The caller must be allowed by the current Authorizer to do this.
*
* Emits an `AuthorizerChanged` event.
*/
function setAuthorizer(IAuthorizer newAuthorizer) external;
/**
* @dev Emitted when a new authorizer is set by `setAuthorizer`.
*/
event AuthorizerChanged(IAuthorizer indexed newAuthorizer);
// Relayers
//
// Additionally, it is possible for an account to perform certain actions on behalf of another one, using their
// Vault ERC20 allowance and Internal Balance. These accounts are said to be 'relayers' for these Vault functions,
// and are expected to be smart contracts with sound authentication mechanisms. For an account to be able to wield
// this power, two things must occur:
// - The Authorizer must grant the account the permission to be a relayer for the relevant Vault function. This
// means that Balancer governance must approve each individual contract to act as a relayer for the intended
// functions.
// - Each user must approve the relayer to act on their behalf.
// This double protection means users cannot be tricked into approving malicious relayers (because they will not
// have been allowed by the Authorizer via governance), nor can malicious relayers approved by a compromised
// Authorizer or governance drain user funds, since they would also need to be approved by each individual user.
/**
* @dev Returns true if `user` has approved `relayer` to act as a relayer for them.
*/
function hasApprovedRelayer(address user, address relayer) external view returns (bool);
/**
* @dev Allows `relayer` to act as a relayer for `sender` if `approved` is true, and disallows it otherwise.
*
* Emits a `RelayerApprovalChanged` event.
*/
function setRelayerApproval(
address sender,
address relayer,
bool approved
) external;
/**
* @dev Emitted every time a relayer is approved or disapproved by `setRelayerApproval`.
*/
event RelayerApprovalChanged(address indexed relayer, address indexed sender, bool approved);
// Internal Balance
//
// Users can deposit tokens into the Vault, where they are allocated to their Internal Balance, and later
// transferred or withdrawn. It can also be used as a source of tokens when joining Pools, as a destination
// when exiting them, and as either when performing swaps. This usage of Internal Balance results in greatly reduced
// gas costs when compared to relying on plain ERC20 transfers, leading to large savings for frequent users.
//
// Internal Balance management features batching, which means a single contract call can be used to perform multiple
// operations of different kinds, with different senders and recipients, at once.
/**
* @dev Returns `user`'s Internal Balance for a set of tokens.
*/
function getInternalBalance(address user, IERC20[] memory tokens) external view returns (uint256[] memory);
/**
* @dev Performs a set of user balance operations, which involve Internal Balance (deposit, withdraw or transfer)
* and plain ERC20 transfers using the Vault's allowance. This last feature is particularly useful for relayers, as
* it lets integrators reuse a user's Vault allowance.
*
* For each operation, if the caller is not `sender`, it must be an authorized relayer for them.
*/
function manageUserBalance(UserBalanceOp[] memory ops) external payable;
/**
* @dev Data for `manageUserBalance` operations, which include the possibility for ETH to be sent and received
without manual WETH wrapping or unwrapping.
*/
struct UserBalanceOp {
UserBalanceOpKind kind;
IAsset asset;
uint256 amount;
address sender;
address payable recipient;
}
// There are four possible operations in `manageUserBalance`:
//
// - DEPOSIT_INTERNAL
// Increases the Internal Balance of the `recipient` account by transferring tokens from the corresponding
// `sender`. The sender must have allowed the Vault to use their tokens via `IERC20.approve()`.
//
// ETH can be used by passing the ETH sentinel value as the asset and forwarding ETH in the call: it will be wrapped
// and deposited as WETH. Any ETH amount remaining will be sent back to the caller (not the sender, which is
// relevant for relayers).
//
// Emits an `InternalBalanceChanged` event.
//
//
// - WITHDRAW_INTERNAL
// Decreases the Internal Balance of the `sender` account by transferring tokens to the `recipient`.
//
// ETH can be used by passing the ETH sentinel value as the asset. This will deduct WETH instead, unwrap it and send
// it to the recipient as ETH.
//
// Emits an `InternalBalanceChanged` event.
//
//
// - TRANSFER_INTERNAL
// Transfers tokens from the Internal Balance of the `sender` account to the Internal Balance of `recipient`.
//
// Reverts if the ETH sentinel value is passed.
//
// Emits an `InternalBalanceChanged` event.
//
//
// - TRANSFER_EXTERNAL
// Transfers tokens from `sender` to `recipient`, using the Vault's ERC20 allowance. This is typically used by
// relayers, as it lets them reuse a user's Vault allowance.
//
// Reverts if the ETH sentinel value is passed.
//
// Emits an `ExternalBalanceTransfer` event.
enum UserBalanceOpKind { DEPOSIT_INTERNAL, WITHDRAW_INTERNAL, TRANSFER_INTERNAL, TRANSFER_EXTERNAL }
/**
* @dev Emitted when a user's Internal Balance changes, either from calls to `manageUserBalance`, or through
* interacting with Pools using Internal Balance.
*
* Because Internal Balance works exclusively with ERC20 tokens, ETH deposits and withdrawals will use the WETH
* address.
*/
event InternalBalanceChanged(address indexed user, IERC20 indexed token, int256 delta);
/**
* @dev Emitted when a user's Vault ERC20 allowance is used by the Vault to transfer tokens to an external account.
*/
event ExternalBalanceTransfer(IERC20 indexed token, address indexed sender, address recipient, uint256 amount);
// Pools
//
// There are three specialization settings for Pools, which allow for cheaper swaps at the cost of reduced
// functionality:
//
// - General: no specialization, suited for all Pools. IGeneralPool is used for swap request callbacks, passing the
// balance of all tokens in the Pool. These Pools have the largest swap costs (because of the extra storage reads),
// which increase with the number of registered tokens.
//
// - Minimal Swap Info: IMinimalSwapInfoPool is used instead of IGeneralPool, which saves gas by only passing the
// balance of the two tokens involved in the swap. This is suitable for some pricing algorithms, like the weighted
// constant product one popularized by Balancer V1. Swap costs are smaller compared to general Pools, and are
// independent of the number of registered tokens.
//
// - Two Token: only allows two tokens to be registered. This achieves the lowest possible swap gas cost. Like
// minimal swap info Pools, these are called via IMinimalSwapInfoPool.
enum PoolSpecialization { GENERAL, MINIMAL_SWAP_INFO, TWO_TOKEN }
/**
* @dev Registers the caller account as a Pool with a given specialization setting. Returns the Pool's ID, which
* is used in all Pool-related functions. Pools cannot be deregistered, nor can the Pool's specialization be
* changed.
*
* The caller is expected to be a smart contract that implements either `IGeneralPool` or `IMinimalSwapInfoPool`,
* depending on the chosen specialization setting. This contract is known as the Pool's contract.
*
* Note that the same contract may register itself as multiple Pools with unique Pool IDs, or in other words,
* multiple Pools may share the same contract.
*
* Emits a `PoolRegistered` event.
*/
function registerPool(PoolSpecialization specialization) external returns (bytes32);
/**
* @dev Emitted when a Pool is registered by calling `registerPool`.
*/
event PoolRegistered(bytes32 indexed poolId, address indexed poolAddress, PoolSpecialization specialization);
/**
* @dev Returns a Pool's contract address and specialization setting.
*/
function getPool(bytes32 poolId) external view returns (address, PoolSpecialization);
/**
* @dev Registers `tokens` for the `poolId` Pool. Must be called by the Pool's contract.
*
* Pools can only interact with tokens they have registered. Users join a Pool by transferring registered tokens,
* exit by receiving registered tokens, and can only swap registered tokens.
*
* Each token can only be registered once. For Pools with the Two Token specialization, `tokens` must have a length
* of two, that is, both tokens must be registered in the same `registerTokens` call, and they must be sorted in
* ascending order.
*
* The `tokens` and `assetManagers` arrays must have the same length, and each entry in these indicates the Asset
* Manager for the corresponding token. Asset Managers can manage a Pool's tokens via `managePoolBalance`,
* depositing and withdrawing them directly, and can even set their balance to arbitrary amounts. They are therefore
* expected to be highly secured smart contracts with sound design principles, and the decision to register an
* Asset Manager should not be made lightly.
*
* Pools can choose not to assign an Asset Manager to a given token by passing in the zero address. Once an Asset
* Manager is set, it cannot be changed except by deregistering the associated token and registering again with a
* different Asset Manager.
*
* Emits a `TokensRegistered` event.
*/
function registerTokens(
bytes32 poolId,
IERC20[] memory tokens,
address[] memory assetManagers
) external;
/**
* @dev Emitted when a Pool registers tokens by calling `registerTokens`.
*/
event TokensRegistered(bytes32 indexed poolId, IERC20[] tokens, address[] assetManagers);
/**
* @dev Deregisters `tokens` for the `poolId` Pool. Must be called by the Pool's contract.
*
* Only registered tokens (via `registerTokens`) can be deregistered. Additionally, they must have zero total
* balance. For Pools with the Two Token specialization, `tokens` must have a length of two, that is, both tokens
* must be deregistered in the same `deregisterTokens` call.
*
* A deregistered token can be re-registered later on, possibly with a different Asset Manager.
*
* Emits a `TokensDeregistered` event.
*/
function deregisterTokens(bytes32 poolId, IERC20[] memory tokens) external;
/**
* @dev Emitted when a Pool deregisters tokens by calling `deregisterTokens`.
*/
event TokensDeregistered(bytes32 indexed poolId, IERC20[] tokens);
/**
* @dev Returns detailed information for a Pool's registered token.
*
* `cash` is the number of tokens the Vault currently holds for the Pool. `managed` is the number of tokens
* withdrawn and held outside the Vault by the Pool's token Asset Manager. The Pool's total balance for `token`
* equals the sum of `cash` and `managed`.
*
* Internally, `cash` and `managed` are stored using 112 bits. No action can ever cause a Pool's token `cash`,
* `managed` or `total` balance to be greater than 2^112 - 1.
*
* `lastChangeBlock` is the number of the block in which `token`'s total balance was last modified (via either a
* join, exit, swap, or Asset Manager update). This value is useful to avoid so-called 'sandwich attacks', for
* example when developing price oracles. A change of zero (e.g. caused by a swap with amount zero) is considered a
* change for this purpose, and will update `lastChangeBlock`.
*
* `assetManager` is the Pool's token Asset Manager.
*/
function getPoolTokenInfo(bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token)
external
view
returns (
uint256 cash,
uint256 managed,
uint256 lastChangeBlock,
address assetManager
);
/**
* @dev Returns a Pool's registered tokens, the total balance for each, and the latest block when *any* of
* the tokens' `balances` changed.
*
* The order of the `tokens` array is the same order that will be used in `joinPool`, `exitPool`, as well as in all
* Pool hooks (where applicable). Calls to `registerTokens` and `deregisterTokens` may change this order.
*
* If a Pool only registers tokens once, and these are sorted in ascending order, they will be stored in the same
* order as passed to `registerTokens`.
*
* Total balances include both tokens held by the Vault and those withdrawn by the Pool's Asset Managers. These are
* the amounts used by joins, exits and swaps. For a detailed breakdown of token balances, use `getPoolTokenInfo`
* instead.
*/
function getPoolTokens(bytes32 poolId)
external
view
returns (
IERC20[] memory tokens,
uint256[] memory balances,
uint256 lastChangeBlock
);
/**
* @dev Called by users to join a Pool, which transfers tokens from `sender` into the Pool's balance. This will
* trigger custom Pool behavior, which will typically grant something in return to `recipient` - often tokenized
* Pool shares.
*
* If the caller is not `sender`, it must be an authorized relayer for them.
*
* The `assets` and `maxAmountsIn` arrays must have the same length, and each entry indicates the maximum amount
* to send for each asset. The amounts to send are decided by the Pool and not the Vault: it just enforces
* these maximums.
*
* If joining a Pool that holds WETH, it is possible to send ETH directly: the Vault will do the wrapping. To enable
* this mechanism, the IAsset sentinel value (the zero address) must be passed in the `assets` array instead of the
* WETH address. Note that it is not possible to combine ETH and WETH in the same join. Any excess ETH will be sent
* back to the caller (not the sender, which is important for relayers).
*
* `assets` must have the same length and order as the array returned by `getPoolTokens`. This prevents issues when
* interacting with Pools that register and deregister tokens frequently. If sending ETH however, the array must be
* sorted *before* replacing the WETH address with the ETH sentinel value (the zero address), which means the final
* `assets` array might not be sorted. Pools with no registered tokens cannot be joined.
*
* If `fromInternalBalance` is true, the caller's Internal Balance will be preferred: ERC20 transfers will only
* be made for the difference between the requested amount and Internal Balance (if any). Note that ETH cannot be
* withdrawn from Internal Balance: attempting to do so will trigger a revert.
*
* This causes the Vault to call the `IBasePool.onJoinPool` hook on the Pool's contract, where Pools implement
* their own custom logic. This typically requires additional information from the user (such as the expected number
* of Pool shares). This can be encoded in the `userData` argument, which is ignored by the Vault and passed
* directly to the Pool's contract, as is `recipient`.
*
* Emits a `PoolBalanceChanged` event.
*/
function joinPool(
bytes32 poolId,
address sender,
address recipient,
JoinPoolRequest memory request
) external payable;
struct JoinPoolRequest {
IAsset[] assets;
uint256[] maxAmountsIn;
bytes userData;
bool fromInternalBalance;
}
/**
* @dev Called by users to exit a Pool, which transfers tokens from the Pool's balance to `recipient`. This will
* trigger custom Pool behavior, which will typically ask for something in return from `sender` - often tokenized
* Pool shares. The amount of tokens that can be withdrawn is limited by the Pool's `cash` balance (see
* `getPoolTokenInfo`).
*
* If the caller is not `sender`, it must be an authorized relayer for them.
*
* The `tokens` and `minAmountsOut` arrays must have the same length, and each entry in these indicates the minimum
* token amount to receive for each token contract. The amounts to send are decided by the Pool and not the Vault:
* it just enforces these minimums.
*
* If exiting a Pool that holds WETH, it is possible to receive ETH directly: the Vault will do the unwrapping. To
* enable this mechanism, the IAsset sentinel value (the zero address) must be passed in the `assets` array instead
* of the WETH address. Note that it is not possible to combine ETH and WETH in the same exit.
*
* `assets` must have the same length and order as the array returned by `getPoolTokens`. This prevents issues when
* interacting with Pools that register and deregister tokens frequently. If receiving ETH however, the array must
* be sorted *before* replacing the WETH address with the ETH sentinel value (the zero address), which means the
* final `assets` array might not be sorted. Pools with no registered tokens cannot be exited.
*
* If `toInternalBalance` is true, the tokens will be deposited to `recipient`'s Internal Balance. Otherwise,
* an ERC20 transfer will be performed. Note that ETH cannot be deposited to Internal Balance: attempting to
* do so will trigger a revert.
*
* `minAmountsOut` is the minimum amount of tokens the user expects to get out of the Pool, for each token in the
* `tokens` array. This array must match the Pool's registered tokens.
*
* This causes the Vault to call the `IBasePool.onExitPool` hook on the Pool's contract, where Pools implement
* their own custom logic. This typically requires additional information from the user (such as the expected number
* of Pool shares to return). This can be encoded in the `userData` argument, which is ignored by the Vault and
* passed directly to the Pool's contract.
*
* Emits a `PoolBalanceChanged` event.
*/
function exitPool(
bytes32 poolId,
address sender,
address payable recipient,
ExitPoolRequest memory request
) external;
struct ExitPoolRequest {
IAsset[] assets;
uint256[] minAmountsOut;
bytes userData;
bool toInternalBalance;
}
/**
* @dev Emitted when a user joins or exits a Pool by calling `joinPool` or `exitPool`, respectively.
*/
event PoolBalanceChanged(
bytes32 indexed poolId,
address indexed liquidityProvider,
IERC20[] tokens,
int256[] deltas,
uint256[] protocolFeeAmounts
);
enum PoolBalanceChangeKind { JOIN, EXIT }
// Swaps
//
// Users can swap tokens with Pools by calling the `swap` and `batchSwap` functions. To do this,
// they need not trust Pool contracts in any way: all security checks are made by the Vault. They must however be
// aware of the Pools' pricing algorithms in order to estimate the prices Pools will quote.
//
// The `swap` function executes a single swap, while `batchSwap` can perform multiple swaps in sequence.
// In each individual swap, tokens of one kind are sent from the sender to the Pool (this is the 'token in'),
// and tokens of another kind are sent from the Pool to the recipient in exchange (this is the 'token out').
// More complex swaps, such as one token in to multiple tokens out can be achieved by batching together
// individual swaps.
//
// There are two swap kinds:
// - 'given in' swaps, where the amount of tokens in (sent to the Pool) is known, and the Pool determines (via the
// `onSwap` hook) the amount of tokens out (to send to the recipient).
// - 'given out' swaps, where the amount of tokens out (received from the Pool) is known, and the Pool determines
// (via the `onSwap` hook) the amount of tokens in (to receive from the sender).
//
// Additionally, it is possible to chain swaps using a placeholder input amount, which the Vault replaces with
// the calculated output of the previous swap. If the previous swap was 'given in', this will be the calculated
// tokenOut amount. If the previous swap was 'given out', it will use the calculated tokenIn amount. These extended
// swaps are known as 'multihop' swaps, since they 'hop' through a number of intermediate tokens before arriving at
// the final intended token.
//
// In all cases, tokens are only transferred in and out of the Vault (or withdrawn from and deposited into Internal
// Balance) after all individual swaps have been completed, and the net token balance change computed. This makes
// certain swap patterns, such as multihops, or swaps that interact with the same token pair in multiple Pools, cost
// much less gas than they would otherwise.
//
// It also means that under certain conditions it is possible to perform arbitrage by swapping with multiple
// Pools in a way that results in net token movement out of the Vault (profit), with no tokens being sent in (only
// updating the Pool's internal accounting).
//
// To protect users from front-running or the market changing rapidly, they supply a list of 'limits' for each token
// involved in the swap, where either the maximum number of tokens to send (by passing a positive value) or the
// minimum amount of tokens to receive (by passing a negative value) is specified.
//
// Additionally, a 'deadline' timestamp can also be provided, forcing the swap to fail if it occurs after
// this point in time (e.g. if the transaction failed to be included in a block promptly).
//
// If interacting with Pools that hold WETH, it is possible to both send and receive ETH directly: the Vault will do
// the wrapping and unwrapping. To enable this mechanism, the IAsset sentinel value (the zero address) must be
// passed in the `assets` array instead of the WETH address. Note that it is possible to combine ETH and WETH in the
// same swap. Any excess ETH will be sent back to the caller (not the sender, which is relevant for relayers).
//
// Finally, Internal Balance can be used when either sending or receiving tokens.
enum SwapKind { GIVEN_IN, GIVEN_OUT }
/**
* @dev Performs a swap with a single Pool.
*
* If the swap is 'given in' (the number of tokens to send to the Pool is known), it returns the amount of tokens
* taken from the Pool, which must be greater than or equal to `limit`.
*
* If the swap is 'given out' (the number of tokens to take from the Pool is known), it returns the amount of tokens
* sent to the Pool, which must be less than or equal to `limit`.
*
* Internal Balance usage and the recipient are determined by the `funds` struct.
*
* Emits a `Swap` event.
*/
function swap(
SingleSwap memory singleSwap,
FundManagement memory funds,
uint256 limit,
uint256 deadline
) external payable returns (uint256);
/**
* @dev Data for a single swap executed by `swap`. `amount` is either `amountIn` or `amountOut` depending on
* the `kind` value.
*
* `assetIn` and `assetOut` are either token addresses, or the IAsset sentinel value for ETH (the zero address).
* Note that Pools never interact with ETH directly: it will be wrapped to or unwrapped from WETH by the Vault.
*
* The `userData` field is ignored by the Vault, but forwarded to the Pool in the `onSwap` hook, and may be
* used to extend swap behavior.
*/
struct SingleSwap {
bytes32 poolId;
SwapKind kind;
IAsset assetIn;
IAsset assetOut;
uint256 amount;
bytes userData;
}
/**
* @dev Performs a series of swaps with one or multiple Pools. In each individual swap, the caller determines either
* the amount of tokens sent to or received from the Pool, depending on the `kind` value.
*
* Returns an array with the net Vault asset balance deltas. Positive amounts represent tokens (or ETH) sent to the
* Vault, and negative amounts represent tokens (or ETH) sent by the Vault. Each delta corresponds to the asset at
* the same index in the `assets` array.
*
* Swaps are executed sequentially, in the order specified by the `swaps` array. Each array element describes a
* Pool, the token to be sent to this Pool, the token to receive from it, and an amount that is either `amountIn` or
* `amountOut` depending on the swap kind.
*
* Multihop swaps can be executed by passing an `amount` value of zero for a swap. This will cause the amount in/out
* of the previous swap to be used as the amount in for the current one. In a 'given in' swap, 'tokenIn' must equal
* the previous swap's `tokenOut`. For a 'given out' swap, `tokenOut` must equal the previous swap's `tokenIn`.
*
* The `assets` array contains the addresses of all assets involved in the swaps. These are either token addresses,
* or the IAsset sentinel value for ETH (the zero address). Each entry in the `swaps` array specifies tokens in and
* out by referencing an index in `assets`. Note that Pools never interact with ETH directly: it will be wrapped to
* or unwrapped from WETH by the Vault.
*
* Internal Balance usage, sender, and recipient are determined by the `funds` struct. The `limits` array specifies
* the minimum or maximum amount of each token the vault is allowed to transfer.
*
* `batchSwap` can be used to make a single swap, like `swap` does, but doing so requires more gas than the
* equivalent `swap` call.
*
* Emits `Swap` events.
*/
function batchSwap(
SwapKind kind,
BatchSwapStep[] memory swaps,
IAsset[] memory assets,
FundManagement memory funds,
int256[] memory limits,
uint256 deadline
) external payable returns (int256[] memory);
/**
* @dev Data for each individual swap executed by `batchSwap`. The asset in and out fields are indexes into the
* `assets` array passed to that function, and ETH assets are converted to WETH.
*
* If `amount` is zero, the multihop mechanism is used to determine the actual amount based on the amount in/out
* from the previous swap, depending on the swap kind.
*
* The `userData` field is ignored by the Vault, but forwarded to the Pool in the `onSwap` hook, and may be
* used to extend swap behavior.
*/
struct BatchSwapStep {
bytes32 poolId;
uint256 assetInIndex;
uint256 assetOutIndex;
uint256 amount;
bytes userData;
}
/**
* @dev Emitted for each individual swap performed by `swap` or `batchSwap`.
*/
event Swap(
bytes32 indexed poolId,
IERC20 indexed tokenIn,
IERC20 indexed tokenOut,
uint256 amountIn,
uint256 amountOut
);
/**
* @dev All tokens in a swap are either sent from the `sender` account to the Vault, or from the Vault to the
* `recipient` account.
*
* If the caller is not `sender`, it must be an authorized relayer for them.
*
* If `fromInternalBalance` is true, the `sender`'s Internal Balance will be preferred, performing an ERC20
* transfer for the difference between the requested amount and the User's Internal Balance (if any). The `sender`
* must have allowed the Vault to use their tokens via `IERC20.approve()`. This matches the behavior of
* `joinPool`.
*
* If `toInternalBalance` is true, tokens will be deposited to `recipient`'s internal balance instead of
* transferred. This matches the behavior of `exitPool`.
*
* Note that ETH cannot be deposited to or withdrawn from Internal Balance: attempting to do so will trigger a
* revert.
*/
struct FundManagement {
address sender;
bool fromInternalBalance;
address payable recipient;
bool toInternalBalance;
}
/**
* @dev Simulates a call to `batchSwap`, returning an array of Vault asset deltas. Calls to `swap` cannot be
* simulated directly, but an equivalent `batchSwap` call can and will yield the exact same result.
*
* Each element in the array corresponds to the asset at the same index, and indicates the number of tokens (or ETH)
* the Vault would take from the sender (if positive) or send to the recipient (if negative). The arguments it
* receives are the same that an equivalent `batchSwap` call would receive.
*
* Unlike `batchSwap`, this function performs no checks on the sender or recipient field in the `funds` struct.
* This makes it suitable to be called by off-chain applications via eth_call without needing to hold tokens,
* approve them for the Vault, or even know a user's address.
*
* Note that this function is not 'view' (due to implementation details): the client code must explicitly execute
* eth_call instead of eth_sendTransaction.
*/
function queryBatchSwap(
SwapKind kind,
BatchSwapStep[] memory swaps,
IAsset[] memory assets,
FundManagement memory funds
) external returns (int256[] memory assetDeltas);
// Flash Loans
/**
* @dev Performs a 'flash loan', sending tokens to `recipient`, executing the `receiveFlashLoan` hook on it,
* and then reverting unless the tokens plus a proportional protocol fee have been returned.
*
* The `tokens` and `amounts` arrays must have the same length, and each entry in these indicates the loan amount
* for each token contract. `tokens` must be sorted in ascending order.
*
* The 'userData' field is ignored by the Vault, and forwarded as-is to `recipient` as part of the
* `receiveFlashLoan` call.
*
* Emits `FlashLoan` events.
*/
function flashLoan(
IFlashLoanRecipient recipient,
IERC20[] memory tokens,
uint256[] memory amounts,
bytes memory userData
) external;
/**
* @dev Emitted for each individual flash loan performed by `flashLoan`.
*/
event FlashLoan(IFlashLoanRecipient indexed recipient, IERC20 indexed token, uint256 amount, uint256 feeAmount);
// Asset Management
//
// Each token registered for a Pool can be assigned an Asset Manager, which is able to freely withdraw the Pool's
// tokens from the Vault, deposit them, or assign arbitrary values to its `managed` balance (see
// `getPoolTokenInfo`). This makes them extremely powerful and dangerous. Even if an Asset Manager only directly
// controls one of the tokens in a Pool, a malicious manager could set that token's balance to manipulate the
// prices of the other tokens, and then drain the Pool with swaps. The risk of using Asset Managers is therefore
// not constrained to the tokens they are managing, but extends to the entire Pool's holdings.
//
// However, a properly designed Asset Manager smart contract can be safely used for the Pool's benefit,
// for example by lending unused tokens out for interest, or using them to participate in voting protocols.
//
// This concept is unrelated to the IAsset interface.
/**
* @dev Performs a set of Pool balance operations, which may be either withdrawals, deposits or updates.
*
* Pool Balance management features batching, which means a single contract call can be used to perform multiple
* operations of different kinds, with different Pools and tokens, at once.
*
* For each operation, the caller must be registered as the Asset Manager for `token` in `poolId`.
*/
function managePoolBalance(PoolBalanceOp[] memory ops) external;
struct PoolBalanceOp {
PoolBalanceOpKind kind;
bytes32 poolId;
IERC20 token;
uint256 amount;
}
/**
* Withdrawals decrease the Pool's cash, but increase its managed balance, leaving the total balance unchanged.
*
* Deposits increase the Pool's cash, but decrease its managed balance, leaving the total balance unchanged.
*
* Updates don't affect the Pool's cash balance, but because the managed balance changes, it does alter the total.
* The external amount can be either increased or decreased by this call (i.e., reporting a gain or a loss).
*/
enum PoolBalanceOpKind { WITHDRAW, DEPOSIT, UPDATE }
/**
* @dev Emitted when a Pool's token Asset Manager alters its balance via `managePoolBalance`.
*/
event PoolBalanceManaged(
bytes32 indexed poolId,
address indexed assetManager,
IERC20 indexed token,
int256 cashDelta,
int256 managedDelta
);
// Protocol Fees
//
// Some operations cause the Vault to collect tokens in the form of protocol fees, which can then be withdrawn by
// permissioned accounts.
//
// There are two kinds of protocol fees:
//
// - flash loan fees: charged on all flash loans, as a percentage of the amounts lent.
//
// - swap fees: a percentage of the fees charged by Pools when performing swaps. For a number of reasons, including
// swap gas costs and interface simplicity, protocol swap fees are not charged on each individual swap. Rather,
// Pools are expected to keep track of how much they have charged in swap fees, and pay any outstanding debts to the
// Vault when they are joined or exited. This prevents users from joining a Pool with unpaid debt, as well as
// exiting a Pool in debt without first paying their share.
/**
* @dev Returns the current protocol fee module.
*/
function getProtocolFeesCollector() external view returns (ProtocolFeesCollector);
/**
* @dev Safety mechanism to pause most Vault operations in the event of an emergency - typically detection of an
* error in some part of the system.
*
* The Vault can only be paused during an initial time period, after which pausing is forever disabled.
*
* While the contract is paused, the following features are disabled:
* - depositing and transferring internal balance
* - transferring external balance (using the Vault's allowance)
* - swaps
* - joining Pools
* - Asset Manager interactions
*
* Internal Balance can still be withdrawn, and Pools exited.
*/
function setPaused(bool paused) external;
/**
* @dev Returns the Vault's WETH instance.
*/
function WETH() external view returns (IWETH);
// solhint-disable-previous-line func-name-mixedcase
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.
// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.
// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
interface IAuthentication {
/**
* @dev Returns the action identifier associated with the external function described by `selector`.
*/
function getActionId(bytes4 selector) external view returns (bytes32);
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.
// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.
// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
/**
* @dev Interface for the TemporarilyPausable helper.
*/
interface ITemporarilyPausable {
/**
* @dev Emitted every time the pause state changes by `_setPaused`.
*/
event PausedStateChanged(bool paused);
/**
* @dev Returns the current paused state.
*/
function getPausedState()
external
view
returns (
bool paused,
uint256 pauseWindowEndTime,
uint256 bufferPeriodEndTime
);
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.
// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.
// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
/**
* @dev Interface for the SignatureValidator helper, used to support meta-transactions.
*/
interface ISignaturesValidator {
/**
* @dev Returns the EIP712 domain separator.
*/
function getDomainSeparator() external view returns (bytes32);
/**
* @dev Returns the next nonce used by an address to sign messages.
*/
function getNextNonce(address user) external view returns (uint256);
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
/**
* @dev https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-712[EIP 712] is a standard for hashing and signing of typed structured data.
*
* The encoding specified in the EIP is very generic, and such a generic implementation in Solidity is not feasible,
* thus this contract does not implement the encoding itself. Protocols need to implement the type-specific encoding
* they need in their contracts using a combination of `abi.encode` and `keccak256`.
*
* This contract implements the EIP 712 domain separator ({_domainSeparatorV4}) that is used as part of the encoding
* scheme, and the final step of the encoding to obtain the message digest that is then signed via ECDSA
* ({_hashTypedDataV4}).
*
* The implementation of the domain separator was designed to be as efficient as possible while still properly updating
* the chain id to protect against replay attacks on an eventual fork of the chain.
*
* NOTE: This contract implements the version of the encoding known as "v4", as implemented by the JSON RPC method
* https://docs.metamask.io/guide/signing-data.html[`eth_signTypedDataV4` in MetaMask].
*
* _Available since v3.4._
*/
abstract contract EIP712 {
/* solhint-disable var-name-mixedcase */
bytes32 private immutable _HASHED_NAME;
bytes32 private immutable _HASHED_VERSION;
bytes32 private immutable _TYPE_HASH;
/* solhint-enable var-name-mixedcase */
/**
* @dev Initializes the domain separator and parameter caches.
*
* The meaning of `name` and `version` is specified in
* https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-712#definition-of-domainseparator[EIP 712]:
*
* - `name`: the user readable name of the signing domain, i.e. the name of the DApp or the protocol.
* - `version`: the current major version of the signing domain.
*
* NOTE: These parameters cannot be changed except through a xref:learn::upgrading-smart-contracts.adoc[smart
* contract upgrade].
*/
constructor(string memory name, string memory version) {
_HASHED_NAME = keccak256(bytes(name));
_HASHED_VERSION = keccak256(bytes(version));
_TYPE_HASH = keccak256("EIP712Domain(string name,string version,uint256 chainId,address verifyingContract)");
}
/**
* @dev Returns the domain separator for the current chain.
*/
function _domainSeparatorV4() internal view virtual returns (bytes32) {
return keccak256(abi.encode(_TYPE_HASH, _HASHED_NAME, _HASHED_VERSION, _getChainId(), address(this)));
}
/**
* @dev Given an already https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-712#definition-of-hashstruct[hashed struct], this
* function returns the hash of the fully encoded EIP712 message for this domain.
*
* This hash can be used together with {ECDSA-recover} to obtain the signer of a message. For example:
*
* ```solidity
* bytes32 digest = _hashTypedDataV4(keccak256(abi.encode(
* keccak256("Mail(address to,string contents)"),
* mailTo,
* keccak256(bytes(mailContents))
* )));
* address signer = ECDSA.recover(digest, signature);
* ```
*/
function _hashTypedDataV4(bytes32 structHash) internal view virtual returns (bytes32) {
return keccak256(abi.encodePacked("\\x19\\x01", _domainSeparatorV4(), structHash));
}
function _getChainId() private view returns (uint256 chainId) {
// Silence state mutability warning without generating bytecode.
// See https://github.com/ethereum/solidity/issues/10090#issuecomment-741789128 and
// https://github.com/ethereum/solidity/issues/2691
this;
// solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly
assembly {
chainId := chainid()
}
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.
// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.
// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
/**
* @dev This is an empty interface used to represent either ERC20-conforming token contracts or ETH (using the zero
* address sentinel value). We're just relying on the fact that `interface` can be used to declare new address-like
* types.
*
* This concept is unrelated to a Pool's Asset Managers.
*/
interface IAsset {
// solhint-disable-previous-line no-empty-blocks
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.
// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.
// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
// Inspired by Aave Protocol's IFlashLoanReceiver.
import "../../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol";
interface IFlashLoanRecipient {
/**
* @dev When `flashLoan` is called on the Vault, it invokes the `receiveFlashLoan` hook on the recipient.
*
* At the time of the call, the Vault will have transferred `amounts` for `tokens` to the recipient. Before this
* call returns, the recipient must have transferred `amounts` plus `feeAmounts` for each token back to the
* Vault, or else the entire flash loan will revert.
*
* `userData` is the same value passed in the `IVault.flashLoan` call.
*/
function receiveFlashLoan(
IERC20[] memory tokens,
uint256[] memory amounts,
uint256[] memory feeAmounts,
bytes memory userData
) external;
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.
// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.
// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;
import "../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol";
import "../lib/helpers/InputHelpers.sol";
import "../lib/helpers/Authentication.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/ReentrancyGuard.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/SafeERC20.sol";
import "./interfaces/IVault.sol";
import "./interfaces/IAuthorizer.sol";
/**
* @dev This an auxiliary contract to the Vault, deployed by it during construction. It offloads some of the tasks the
* Vault performs to reduce its overall bytecode size.
*
* The current values for all protocol fee percentages are stored here, and any tokens charged as protocol fees are
* sent to this contract, where they may be withdrawn by authorized entities. All authorization tasks are delegated
* to the Vault's own authorizer.
*/
contract ProtocolFeesCollector is Authentication, ReentrancyGuard {
using SafeERC20 for IERC20;
// Absolute maximum fee percentages (1e18 = 100%, 1e16 = 1%).
uint256 private constant _MAX_PROTOCOL_SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE = 50e16; // 50%
uint256 private constant _MAX_PROTOCOL_FLASH_LOAN_FEE_PERCENTAGE = 1e16; // 1%
IVault public immutable vault;
// All fee percentages are 18-decimal fixed point numbers.
// The swap fee is charged whenever a swap occurs, as a percentage of the fee charged by the Pool. These are not
// actually charged on each individual swap: the `Vault` relies on the Pools being honest and reporting fees due
// when users join and exit them.
uint256 private _swapFeePercentage;
// The flash loan fee is charged whenever a flash loan occurs, as a percentage of the tokens lent.
uint256 private _flashLoanFeePercentage;
event SwapFeePercentageChanged(uint256 newSwapFeePercentage);
event FlashLoanFeePercentageChanged(uint256 newFlashLoanFeePercentage);
constructor(IVault _vault)
// The ProtocolFeesCollector is a singleton, so it simply uses its own address to disambiguate action
// identifiers.
Authentication(bytes32(uint256(address(this))))
{
vault = _vault;
}
function withdrawCollectedFees(
IERC20[] calldata tokens,
uint256[] calldata amounts,
address recipient
) external nonReentrant authenticate {
InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(tokens.length, amounts.length);
for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) {
IERC20 token = tokens[i];
uint256 amount = amounts[i];
token.safeTransfer(recipient, amount);
}
}
function setSwapFeePercentage(uint256 newSwapFeePercentage) external authenticate {
_require(newSwapFeePercentage <= _MAX_PROTOCOL_SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE, Errors.SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE_TOO_HIGH);
_swapFeePercentage = newSwapFeePercentage;
emit SwapFeePercentageChanged(newSwapFeePercentage);
}
function setFlashLoanFeePercentage(uint256 newFlashLoanFeePercentage) external authenticate {
_require(
newFlashLoanFeePercentage <= _MAX_PROTOCOL_FLASH_LOAN_FEE_PERCENTAGE,
Errors.FLASH_LOAN_FEE_PERCENTAGE_TOO_HIGH
);
_flashLoanFeePercentage = newFlashLoanFeePercentage;
emit FlashLoanFeePercentageChanged(newFlashLoanFeePercentage);
}
function getSwapFeePercentage() external view returns (uint256) {
return _swapFeePercentage;
}
function getFlashLoanFeePercentage() external view returns (uint256) {
return _flashLoanFeePercentage;
}
function getCollectedFeeAmounts(IERC20[] memory tokens) external view returns (uint256[] memory feeAmounts) {
feeAmounts = new uint256[](tokens.length);
for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) {
feeAmounts[i] = tokens[i].balanceOf(address(this));
}
}
function getAuthorizer() external view returns (IAuthorizer) {
return _getAuthorizer();
}
function _canPerform(bytes32 actionId, address account) internal view override returns (bool) {
return _getAuthorizer().canPerform(actionId, account, address(this));
}
function _getAuthorizer() internal view returns (IAuthorizer) {
return vault.getAuthorizer();
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.
// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.
// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
import "../openzeppelin/IERC20.sol";
import "./BalancerErrors.sol";
import "../../vault/interfaces/IAsset.sol";
library InputHelpers {
function ensureInputLengthMatch(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure {
_require(a == b, Errors.INPUT_LENGTH_MISMATCH);
}
function ensureInputLengthMatch(
uint256 a,
uint256 b,
uint256 c
) internal pure {
_require(a == b && b == c, Errors.INPUT_LENGTH_MISMATCH);
}
function ensureArrayIsSorted(IAsset[] memory array) internal pure {
address[] memory addressArray;
// solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly
assembly {
addressArray := array
}
ensureArrayIsSorted(addressArray);
}
function ensureArrayIsSorted(IERC20[] memory array) internal pure {
address[] memory addressArray;
// solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly
assembly {
addressArray := array
}
ensureArrayIsSorted(addressArray);
}
function ensureArrayIsSorted(address[] memory array) internal pure {
if (array.length < 2) {
return;
}
address previous = array[0];
for (uint256 i = 1; i < array.length; ++i) {
address current = array[i];
_require(previous < current, Errors.UNSORTED_ARRAY);
previous = current;
}
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
import "../helpers/BalancerErrors.sol";
import "./IERC20.sol";
/**
* @title SafeERC20
* @dev Wrappers around ERC20 operations that throw on failure (when the token
* contract returns false). Tokens that return no value (and instead revert or
* throw on failure) are also supported, non-reverting calls are assumed to be
* successful.
* To use this library you can add a `using SafeERC20 for IERC20;` statement to your contract,
* which allows you to call the safe operations as `token.safeTransfer(...)`, etc.
*/
library SafeERC20 {
function safeTransfer(
IERC20 token,
address to,
uint256 value
) internal {
_callOptionalReturn(address(token), abi.encodeWithSelector(token.transfer.selector, to, value));
}
function safeTransferFrom(
IERC20 token,
address from,
address to,
uint256 value
) internal {
_callOptionalReturn(address(token), abi.encodeWithSelector(token.transferFrom.selector, from, to, value));
}
/**
* @dev Imitates a Solidity high-level call (i.e. a regular function call to a contract), relaxing the requirement
* on the return value: the return value is optional (but if data is returned, it must not be false).
*
* WARNING: `token` is assumed to be a contract: calls to EOAs will *not* revert.
*/
function _callOptionalReturn(address token, bytes memory data) private {
// We need to perform a low level call here, to bypass Solidity's return data size checking mechanism, since
// we're implementing it ourselves.
(bool success, bytes memory returndata) = token.call(data);
// If the low-level call didn't succeed we return whatever was returned from it.
assembly {
if eq(success, 0) {
returndatacopy(0, 0, returndatasize())
revert(0, returndatasize())
}
}
// Finally we check the returndata size is either zero or true - note that this check will always pass for EOAs
_require(returndata.length == 0 || abi.decode(returndata, (bool)), Errors.SAFE_ERC20_CALL_FAILED);
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.
// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.
// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;
import "../lib/math/FixedPoint.sol";
import "../lib/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/ReentrancyGuard.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/SafeERC20.sol";
import "./ProtocolFeesCollector.sol";
import "./VaultAuthorization.sol";
import "./interfaces/IVault.sol";
/**
* @dev To reduce the bytecode size of the Vault, most of the protocol fee logic is not here, but in the
* ProtocolFeesCollector contract.
*/
abstract contract Fees is IVault {
using SafeERC20 for IERC20;
ProtocolFeesCollector private immutable _protocolFeesCollector;
constructor() {
_protocolFeesCollector = new ProtocolFeesCollector(IVault(this));
}
function getProtocolFeesCollector() public view override returns (ProtocolFeesCollector) {
return _protocolFeesCollector;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the protocol swap fee percentage.
*/
function _getProtocolSwapFeePercentage() internal view returns (uint256) {
return getProtocolFeesCollector().getSwapFeePercentage();
}
/**
* @dev Returns the protocol fee amount to charge for a flash loan of `amount`.
*/
function _calculateFlashLoanFeeAmount(uint256 amount) internal view returns (uint256) {
// Fixed point multiplication introduces error: we round up, which means in certain scenarios the charged
// percentage can be slightly higher than intended.
uint256 percentage = getProtocolFeesCollector().getFlashLoanFeePercentage();
return FixedPoint.mulUp(amount, percentage);
}
function _payFeeAmount(IERC20 token, uint256 amount) internal {
if (amount > 0) {
token.safeTransfer(address(getProtocolFeesCollector()), amount);
}
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.
// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.
// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
import "./LogExpMath.sol";
import "../helpers/BalancerErrors.sol";
/* solhint-disable private-vars-leading-underscore */
library FixedPoint {
uint256 internal constant ONE = 1e18; // 18 decimal places
uint256 internal constant MAX_POW_RELATIVE_ERROR = 10000; // 10^(-14)
// Minimum base for the power function when the exponent is 'free' (larger than ONE).
uint256 internal constant MIN_POW_BASE_FREE_EXPONENT = 0.7e18;
function add(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
// Fixed Point addition is the same as regular checked addition
uint256 c = a + b;
_require(c >= a, Errors.ADD_OVERFLOW);
return c;
}
function sub(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
// Fixed Point addition is the same as regular checked addition
_require(b <= a, Errors.SUB_OVERFLOW);
uint256 c = a - b;
return c;
}
function mulDown(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
uint256 product = a * b;
_require(a == 0 || product / a == b, Errors.MUL_OVERFLOW);
return product / ONE;
}
function mulUp(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
uint256 product = a * b;
_require(a == 0 || product / a == b, Errors.MUL_OVERFLOW);
if (product == 0) {
return 0;
} else {
// The traditional divUp formula is:
// divUp(x, y) := (x + y - 1) / y
// To avoid intermediate overflow in the addition, we distribute the division and get:
// divUp(x, y) := (x - 1) / y + 1
// Note that this requires x != 0, which we already tested for.
return ((product - 1) / ONE) + 1;
}
}
function divDown(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
_require(b != 0, Errors.ZERO_DIVISION);
if (a == 0) {
return 0;
} else {
uint256 aInflated = a * ONE;
_require(aInflated / a == ONE, Errors.DIV_INTERNAL); // mul overflow
return aInflated / b;
}
}
function divUp(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
_require(b != 0, Errors.ZERO_DIVISION);
if (a == 0) {
return 0;
} else {
uint256 aInflated = a * ONE;
_require(aInflated / a == ONE, Errors.DIV_INTERNAL); // mul overflow
// The traditional divUp formula is:
// divUp(x, y) := (x + y - 1) / y
// To avoid intermediate overflow in the addition, we distribute the division and get:
// divUp(x, y) := (x - 1) / y + 1
// Note that this requires x != 0, which we already tested for.
return ((aInflated - 1) / b) + 1;
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns x^y, assuming both are fixed point numbers, rounding down. The result is guaranteed to not be above
* the true value (that is, the error function expected - actual is always positive).
*/
function powDown(uint256 x, uint256 y) internal pure returns (uint256) {
uint256 raw = LogExpMath.pow(x, y);
uint256 maxError = add(mulUp(raw, MAX_POW_RELATIVE_ERROR), 1);
if (raw < maxError) {
return 0;
} else {
return sub(raw, maxError);
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns x^y, assuming both are fixed point numbers, rounding up. The result is guaranteed to not be below
* the true value (that is, the error function expected - actual is always negative).
*/
function powUp(uint256 x, uint256 y) internal pure returns (uint256) {
uint256 raw = LogExpMath.pow(x, y);
uint256 maxError = add(mulUp(raw, MAX_POW_RELATIVE_ERROR), 1);
return add(raw, maxError);
}
/**
* @dev Returns the complement of a value (1 - x), capped to 0 if x is larger than 1.
*
* Useful when computing the complement for values with some level of relative error, as it strips this error and
* prevents intermediate negative values.
*/
function complement(uint256 x) internal pure returns (uint256) {
return (x < ONE) ? (ONE - x) : 0;
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.
// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
// GNU General internal License for more details.
// You should have received a copy of the GNU General internal License
// along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
import "../helpers/BalancerErrors.sol";
/* solhint-disable */
/**
* @dev Exponentiation and logarithm functions for 18 decimal fixed point numbers (both base and exponent/argument).
*
* Exponentiation and logarithm with arbitrary bases (x^y and log_x(y)) are implemented by conversion to natural
* exponentiation and logarithm (where the base is Euler's number).
*
* @author Fernando Martinelli - @fernandomartinelli
* @author Sergio Yuhjtman - @sergioyuhjtman
* @author Daniel Fernandez - @dmf7z
*/
library LogExpMath {
// All fixed point multiplications and divisions are inlined. This means we need to divide by ONE when multiplying
// two numbers, and multiply by ONE when dividing them.
// All arguments and return values are 18 decimal fixed point numbers.
int256 constant ONE_18 = 1e18;
// Internally, intermediate values are computed with higher precision as 20 decimal fixed point numbers, and in the
// case of ln36, 36 decimals.
int256 constant ONE_20 = 1e20;
int256 constant ONE_36 = 1e36;
// The domain of natural exponentiation is bound by the word size and number of decimals used.
//
// Because internally the result will be stored using 20 decimals, the largest possible result is
// (2^255 - 1) / 10^20, which makes the largest exponent ln((2^255 - 1) / 10^20) = 130.700829182905140221.
// The smallest possible result is 10^(-18), which makes largest negative argument
// ln(10^(-18)) = -41.446531673892822312.
// We use 130.0 and -41.0 to have some safety margin.
int256 constant MAX_NATURAL_EXPONENT = 130e18;
int256 constant MIN_NATURAL_EXPONENT = -41e18;
// Bounds for ln_36's argument. Both ln(0.9) and ln(1.1) can be represented with 36 decimal places in a fixed point
// 256 bit integer.
int256 constant LN_36_LOWER_BOUND = ONE_18 - 1e17;
int256 constant LN_36_UPPER_BOUND = ONE_18 + 1e17;
uint256 constant MILD_EXPONENT_BOUND = 2**254 / uint256(ONE_20);
// 18 decimal constants
int256 constant x0 = 128000000000000000000; // 2ˆ7
int256 constant a0 = 38877084059945950922200000000000000000000000000000000000; // eˆ(x0) (no decimals)
int256 constant x1 = 64000000000000000000; // 2ˆ6
int256 constant a1 = 6235149080811616882910000000; // eˆ(x1) (no decimals)
// 20 decimal constants
int256 constant x2 = 3200000000000000000000; // 2ˆ5
int256 constant a2 = 7896296018268069516100000000000000; // eˆ(x2)
int256 constant x3 = 1600000000000000000000; // 2ˆ4
int256 constant a3 = 888611052050787263676000000; // eˆ(x3)
int256 constant x4 = 800000000000000000000; // 2ˆ3
int256 constant a4 = 298095798704172827474000; // eˆ(x4)
int256 constant x5 = 400000000000000000000; // 2ˆ2
int256 constant a5 = 5459815003314423907810; // eˆ(x5)
int256 constant x6 = 200000000000000000000; // 2ˆ1
int256 constant a6 = 738905609893065022723; // eˆ(x6)
int256 constant x7 = 100000000000000000000; // 2ˆ0
int256 constant a7 = 271828182845904523536; // eˆ(x7)
int256 constant x8 = 50000000000000000000; // 2ˆ-1
int256 constant a8 = 164872127070012814685; // eˆ(x8)
int256 constant x9 = 25000000000000000000; // 2ˆ-2
int256 constant a9 = 128402541668774148407; // eˆ(x9)
int256 constant x10 = 12500000000000000000; // 2ˆ-3
int256 constant a10 = 113314845306682631683; // eˆ(x10)
int256 constant x11 = 6250000000000000000; // 2ˆ-4
int256 constant a11 = 106449445891785942956; // eˆ(x11)
/**
* @dev Exponentiation (x^y) with unsigned 18 decimal fixed point base and exponent.
*
* Reverts if ln(x) * y is smaller than `MIN_NATURAL_EXPONENT`, or larger than `MAX_NATURAL_EXPONENT`.
*/
function pow(uint256 x, uint256 y) internal pure returns (uint256) {
if (y == 0) {
// We solve the 0^0 indetermination by making it equal one.
return uint256(ONE_18);
}
if (x == 0) {
return 0;
}
// Instead of computing x^y directly, we instead rely on the properties of logarithms and exponentiation to
// arrive at that result. In particular, exp(ln(x)) = x, and ln(x^y) = y * ln(x). This means
// x^y = exp(y * ln(x)).
// The ln function takes a signed value, so we need to make sure x fits in the signed 256 bit range.
_require(x < 2**255, Errors.X_OUT_OF_BOUNDS);
int256 x_int256 = int256(x);
// We will compute y * ln(x) in a single step. Depending on the value of x, we can either use ln or ln_36. In
// both cases, we leave the division by ONE_18 (due to fixed point multiplication) to the end.
// This prevents y * ln(x) from overflowing, and at the same time guarantees y fits in the signed 256 bit range.
_require(y < MILD_EXPONENT_BOUND, Errors.Y_OUT_OF_BOUNDS);
int256 y_int256 = int256(y);
int256 logx_times_y;
if (LN_36_LOWER_BOUND < x_int256 && x_int256 < LN_36_UPPER_BOUND) {
int256 ln_36_x = ln_36(x_int256);
// ln_36_x has 36 decimal places, so multiplying by y_int256 isn't as straightforward, since we can't just
// bring y_int256 to 36 decimal places, as it might overflow. Instead, we perform two 18 decimal
// multiplications and add the results: one with the first 18 decimals of ln_36_x, and one with the
// (downscaled) last 18 decimals.
logx_times_y = ((ln_36_x / ONE_18) * y_int256 + ((ln_36_x % ONE_18) * y_int256) / ONE_18);
} else {
logx_times_y = ln(x_int256) * y_int256;
}
logx_times_y /= ONE_18;
// Finally, we compute exp(y * ln(x)) to arrive at x^y
_require(
MIN_NATURAL_EXPONENT <= logx_times_y && logx_times_y <= MAX_NATURAL_EXPONENT,
Errors.PRODUCT_OUT_OF_BOUNDS
);
return uint256(exp(logx_times_y));
}
/**
* @dev Natural exponentiation (e^x) with signed 18 decimal fixed point exponent.
*
* Reverts if `x` is smaller than MIN_NATURAL_EXPONENT, or larger than `MAX_NATURAL_EXPONENT`.
*/
function exp(int256 x) internal pure returns (int256) {
_require(x >= MIN_NATURAL_EXPONENT && x <= MAX_NATURAL_EXPONENT, Errors.INVALID_EXPONENT);
if (x < 0) {
// We only handle positive exponents: e^(-x) is computed as 1 / e^x. We can safely make x positive since it
// fits in the signed 256 bit range (as it is larger than MIN_NATURAL_EXPONENT).
// Fixed point division requires multiplying by ONE_18.
return ((ONE_18 * ONE_18) / exp(-x));
}
// First, we use the fact that e^(x+y) = e^x * e^y to decompose x into a sum of powers of two, which we call x_n,
// where x_n == 2^(7 - n), and e^x_n = a_n has been precomputed. We choose the first x_n, x0, to equal 2^7
// because all larger powers are larger than MAX_NATURAL_EXPONENT, and therefore not present in the
// decomposition.
// At the end of this process we will have the product of all e^x_n = a_n that apply, and the remainder of this
// decomposition, which will be lower than the smallest x_n.
// exp(x) = k_0 * a_0 * k_1 * a_1 * ... + k_n * a_n * exp(remainder), where each k_n equals either 0 or 1.
// We mutate x by subtracting x_n, making it the remainder of the decomposition.
// The first two a_n (e^(2^7) and e^(2^6)) are too large if stored as 18 decimal numbers, and could cause
// intermediate overflows. Instead we store them as plain integers, with 0 decimals.
// Additionally, x0 + x1 is larger than MAX_NATURAL_EXPONENT, which means they will not both be present in the
// decomposition.
// For each x_n, we test if that term is present in the decomposition (if x is larger than it), and if so deduct
// it and compute the accumulated product.
int256 firstAN;
if (x >= x0) {
x -= x0;
firstAN = a0;
} else if (x >= x1) {
x -= x1;
firstAN = a1;
} else {
firstAN = 1; // One with no decimal places
}
// We now transform x into a 20 decimal fixed point number, to have enhanced precision when computing the
// smaller terms.
x *= 100;
// `product` is the accumulated product of all a_n (except a0 and a1), which starts at 20 decimal fixed point
// one. Recall that fixed point multiplication requires dividing by ONE_20.
int256 product = ONE_20;
if (x >= x2) {
x -= x2;
product = (product * a2) / ONE_20;
}
if (x >= x3) {
x -= x3;
product = (product * a3) / ONE_20;
}
if (x >= x4) {
x -= x4;
product = (product * a4) / ONE_20;
}
if (x >= x5) {
x -= x5;
product = (product * a5) / ONE_20;
}
if (x >= x6) {
x -= x6;
product = (product * a6) / ONE_20;
}
if (x >= x7) {
x -= x7;
product = (product * a7) / ONE_20;
}
if (x >= x8) {
x -= x8;
product = (product * a8) / ONE_20;
}
if (x >= x9) {
x -= x9;
product = (product * a9) / ONE_20;
}
// x10 and x11 are unnecessary here since we have high enough precision already.
// Now we need to compute e^x, where x is small (in particular, it is smaller than x9). We use the Taylor series
// expansion for e^x: 1 + x + (x^2 / 2!) + (x^3 / 3!) + ... + (x^n / n!).
int256 seriesSum = ONE_20; // The initial one in the sum, with 20 decimal places.
int256 term; // Each term in the sum, where the nth term is (x^n / n!).
// The first term is simply x.
term = x;
seriesSum += term;
// Each term (x^n / n!) equals the previous one times x, divided by n. Since x is a fixed point number,
// multiplying by it requires dividing by ONE_20, but dividing by the non-fixed point n values does not.
term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 2;
seriesSum += term;
term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 3;
seriesSum += term;
term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 4;
seriesSum += term;
term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 5;
seriesSum += term;
term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 6;
seriesSum += term;
term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 7;
seriesSum += term;
term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 8;
seriesSum += term;
term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 9;
seriesSum += term;
term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 10;
seriesSum += term;
term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 11;
seriesSum += term;
term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 12;
seriesSum += term;
// 12 Taylor terms are sufficient for 18 decimal precision.
// We now have the first a_n (with no decimals), and the product of all other a_n present, and the Taylor
// approximation of the exponentiation of the remainder (both with 20 decimals). All that remains is to multiply
// all three (one 20 decimal fixed point multiplication, dividing by ONE_20, and one integer multiplication),
// and then drop two digits to return an 18 decimal value.
return (((product * seriesSum) / ONE_20) * firstAN) / 100;
}
/**
* @dev Natural logarithm (ln(a)) with signed 18 decimal fixed point argument.
*/
function ln(int256 a) internal pure returns (int256) {
// The real natural logarithm is not defined for negative numbers or zero.
_require(a > 0, Errors.OUT_OF_BOUNDS);
if (a < ONE_18) {
// Since ln(a^k) = k * ln(a), we can compute ln(a) as ln(a) = ln((1/a)^(-1)) = - ln((1/a)). If a is less
// than one, 1/a will be greater than one, and this if statement will not be entered in the recursive call.
// Fixed point division requires multiplying by ONE_18.
return (-ln((ONE_18 * ONE_18) / a));
}
// First, we use the fact that ln^(a * b) = ln(a) + ln(b) to decompose ln(a) into a sum of powers of two, which
// we call x_n, where x_n == 2^(7 - n), which are the natural logarithm of precomputed quantities a_n (that is,
// ln(a_n) = x_n). We choose the first x_n, x0, to equal 2^7 because the exponential of all larger powers cannot
// be represented as 18 fixed point decimal numbers in 256 bits, and are therefore larger than a.
// At the end of this process we will have the sum of all x_n = ln(a_n) that apply, and the remainder of this
// decomposition, which will be lower than the smallest a_n.
// ln(a) = k_0 * x_0 + k_1 * x_1 + ... + k_n * x_n + ln(remainder), where each k_n equals either 0 or 1.
// We mutate a by subtracting a_n, making it the remainder of the decomposition.
// For reasons related to how `exp` works, the first two a_n (e^(2^7) and e^(2^6)) are not stored as fixed point
// numbers with 18 decimals, but instead as plain integers with 0 decimals, so we need to multiply them by
// ONE_18 to convert them to fixed point.
// For each a_n, we test if that term is present in the decomposition (if a is larger than it), and if so divide
// by it and compute the accumulated sum.
int256 sum = 0;
if (a >= a0 * ONE_18) {
a /= a0; // Integer, not fixed point division
sum += x0;
}
if (a >= a1 * ONE_18) {
a /= a1; // Integer, not fixed point division
sum += x1;
}
// All other a_n and x_n are stored as 20 digit fixed point numbers, so we convert the sum and a to this format.
sum *= 100;
a *= 100;
// Because further a_n are 20 digit fixed point numbers, we multiply by ONE_20 when dividing by them.
if (a >= a2) {
a = (a * ONE_20) / a2;
sum += x2;
}
if (a >= a3) {
a = (a * ONE_20) / a3;
sum += x3;
}
if (a >= a4) {
a = (a * ONE_20) / a4;
sum += x4;
}
if (a >= a5) {
a = (a * ONE_20) / a5;
sum += x5;
}
if (a >= a6) {
a = (a * ONE_20) / a6;
sum += x6;
}
if (a >= a7) {
a = (a * ONE_20) / a7;
sum += x7;
}
if (a >= a8) {
a = (a * ONE_20) / a8;
sum += x8;
}
if (a >= a9) {
a = (a * ONE_20) / a9;
sum += x9;
}
if (a >= a10) {
a = (a * ONE_20) / a10;
sum += x10;
}
if (a >= a11) {
a = (a * ONE_20) / a11;
sum += x11;
}
// a is now a small number (smaller than a_11, which roughly equals 1.06). This means we can use a Taylor series
// that converges rapidly for values of `a` close to one - the same one used in ln_36.
// Let z = (a - 1) / (a + 1).
// ln(a) = 2 * (z + z^3 / 3 + z^5 / 5 + z^7 / 7 + ... + z^(2 * n + 1) / (2 * n + 1))
// Recall that 20 digit fixed point division requires multiplying by ONE_20, and multiplication requires
// division by ONE_20.
int256 z = ((a - ONE_20) * ONE_20) / (a + ONE_20);
int256 z_squared = (z * z) / ONE_20;
// num is the numerator of the series: the z^(2 * n + 1) term
int256 num = z;
// seriesSum holds the accumulated sum of each term in the series, starting with the initial z
int256 seriesSum = num;
// In each step, the numerator is multiplied by z^2
num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_20;
seriesSum += num / 3;
num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_20;
seriesSum += num / 5;
num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_20;
seriesSum += num / 7;
num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_20;
seriesSum += num / 9;
num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_20;
seriesSum += num / 11;
// 6 Taylor terms are sufficient for 36 decimal precision.
// Finally, we multiply by 2 (non fixed point) to compute ln(remainder)
seriesSum *= 2;
// We now have the sum of all x_n present, and the Taylor approximation of the logarithm of the remainder (both
// with 20 decimals). All that remains is to sum these two, and then drop two digits to return a 18 decimal
// value.
return (sum + seriesSum) / 100;
}
/**
* @dev Logarithm (log(arg, base), with signed 18 decimal fixed point base and argument argument.
*/
function log(int256 arg, int256 base) internal pure returns (int256) {
// This performs a simple base change: log(arg, base) = ln(arg) / ln(base).
// Both logBase and logArg are computed as 36 decimal fixed point numbers, either by using ln_36, or by
// upscaling.
int256 logBase;
if (LN_36_LOWER_BOUND < base && base < LN_36_UPPER_BOUND) {
logBase = ln_36(base);
} else {
logBase = ln(base) * ONE_18;
}
int256 logArg;
if (LN_36_LOWER_BOUND < arg && arg < LN_36_UPPER_BOUND) {
logArg = ln_36(arg);
} else {
logArg = ln(arg) * ONE_18;
}
// When dividing, we multiply by ONE_18 to arrive at a result with 18 decimal places
return (logArg * ONE_18) / logBase;
}
/**
* @dev High precision (36 decimal places) natural logarithm (ln(x)) with signed 18 decimal fixed point argument,
* for x close to one.
*
* Should only be used if x is between LN_36_LOWER_BOUND and LN_36_UPPER_BOUND.
*/
function ln_36(int256 x) private pure returns (int256) {
// Since ln(1) = 0, a value of x close to one will yield a very small result, which makes using 36 digits
// worthwhile.
// First, we transform x to a 36 digit fixed point value.
x *= ONE_18;
// We will use the following Taylor expansion, which converges very rapidly. Let z = (x - 1) / (x + 1).
// ln(x) = 2 * (z + z^3 / 3 + z^5 / 5 + z^7 / 7 + ... + z^(2 * n + 1) / (2 * n + 1))
// Recall that 36 digit fixed point division requires multiplying by ONE_36, and multiplication requires
// division by ONE_36.
int256 z = ((x - ONE_36) * ONE_36) / (x + ONE_36);
int256 z_squared = (z * z) / ONE_36;
// num is the numerator of the series: the z^(2 * n + 1) term
int256 num = z;
// seriesSum holds the accumulated sum of each term in the series, starting with the initial z
int256 seriesSum = num;
// In each step, the numerator is multiplied by z^2
num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_36;
seriesSum += num / 3;
num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_36;
seriesSum += num / 5;
num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_36;
seriesSum += num / 7;
num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_36;
seriesSum += num / 9;
num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_36;
seriesSum += num / 11;
num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_36;
seriesSum += num / 13;
num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_36;
seriesSum += num / 15;
// 8 Taylor terms are sufficient for 36 decimal precision.
// All that remains is multiplying by 2 (non fixed point).
return seriesSum * 2;
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
import "../helpers/BalancerErrors.sol";
/**
* @dev Wrappers over Solidity's arithmetic operations with added overflow checks.
* Adapted from OpenZeppelin's SafeMath library
*/
library Math {
/**
* @dev Returns the addition of two unsigned integers of 256 bits, reverting on overflow.
*/
function add(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
uint256 c = a + b;
_require(c >= a, Errors.ADD_OVERFLOW);
return c;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the addition of two signed integers, reverting on overflow.
*/
function add(int256 a, int256 b) internal pure returns (int256) {
int256 c = a + b;
_require((b >= 0 && c >= a) || (b < 0 && c < a), Errors.ADD_OVERFLOW);
return c;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the subtraction of two unsigned integers of 256 bits, reverting on overflow.
*/
function sub(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
_require(b <= a, Errors.SUB_OVERFLOW);
uint256 c = a - b;
return c;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the subtraction of two signed integers, reverting on overflow.
*/
function sub(int256 a, int256 b) internal pure returns (int256) {
int256 c = a - b;
_require((b >= 0 && c <= a) || (b < 0 && c > a), Errors.SUB_OVERFLOW);
return c;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the largest of two numbers of 256 bits.
*/
function max(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
return a >= b ? a : b;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the smallest of two numbers of 256 bits.
*/
function min(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
return a < b ? a : b;
}
function mul(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
uint256 c = a * b;
_require(a == 0 || c / a == b, Errors.MUL_OVERFLOW);
return c;
}
function divDown(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
_require(b != 0, Errors.ZERO_DIVISION);
return a / b;
}
function divUp(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
_require(b != 0, Errors.ZERO_DIVISION);
if (a == 0) {
return 0;
} else {
return 1 + (a - 1) / b;
}
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
// Based on the EnumerableMap library from OpenZeppelin contracts, altered to include the following:
// * a map from IERC20 to bytes32
// * entries are stored in mappings instead of arrays, reducing implicit storage reads for out-of-bounds checks
// * unchecked_at and unchecked_valueAt, which allow for more gas efficient data reads in some scenarios
// * unchecked_indexOf and unchecked_setAt, which allow for more gas efficient data writes in some scenarios
//
// Additionally, the base private functions that work on bytes32 were removed and replaced with a native implementation
// for IERC20 keys, to reduce bytecode size and runtime costs.
// We're using non-standard casing for the unchecked functions to differentiate them, so we need to turn off that rule
// solhint-disable func-name-mixedcase
import "./IERC20.sol";
import "../helpers/BalancerErrors.sol";
/**
* @dev Library for managing an enumerable variant of Solidity's
* https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/latest/types.html#mapping-types[`mapping`]
* type.
*
* Maps have the following properties:
*
* - Entries are added, removed, and checked for existence in constant time
* (O(1)).
* - Entries are enumerated in O(n). No guarantees are made on the ordering.
*
* ```
* contract Example {
* // Add the library methods
* using EnumerableMap for EnumerableMap.UintToAddressMap;
*
* // Declare a set state variable
* EnumerableMap.UintToAddressMap private myMap;
* }
* ```
*/
library EnumerableMap {
// The original OpenZeppelin implementation uses a generic Map type with bytes32 keys: this was replaced with
// IERC20ToBytes32Map, which uses IERC20 keys natively, resulting in more dense bytecode.
struct IERC20ToBytes32MapEntry {
IERC20 _key;
bytes32 _value;
}
struct IERC20ToBytes32Map {
// Number of entries in the map
uint256 _length;
// Storage of map keys and values
mapping(uint256 => IERC20ToBytes32MapEntry) _entries;
// Position of the entry defined by a key in the `entries` array, plus 1
// because index 0 means a key is not in the map.
mapping(IERC20 => uint256) _indexes;
}
/**
* @dev Adds a key-value pair to a map, or updates the value for an existing
* key. O(1).
*
* Returns true if the key was added to the map, that is if it was not
* already present.
*/
function set(
IERC20ToBytes32Map storage map,
IERC20 key,
bytes32 value
) internal returns (bool) {
// We read and store the key's index to prevent multiple reads from the same storage slot
uint256 keyIndex = map._indexes[key];
// Equivalent to !contains(map, key)
if (keyIndex == 0) {
uint256 previousLength = map._length;
map._entries[previousLength] = IERC20ToBytes32MapEntry({ _key: key, _value: value });
map._length = previousLength + 1;
// The entry is stored at previousLength, but we add 1 to all indexes
// and use 0 as a sentinel value
map._indexes[key] = previousLength + 1;
return true;
} else {
map._entries[keyIndex - 1]._value = value;
return false;
}
}
/**
* @dev Updates the value for an entry, given its key's index. The key index can be retrieved via
* {unchecked_indexOf}, and it should be noted that key indices may change when calling {set} or {remove}. O(1).
*
* This function performs one less storage read than {set}, but it should only be used when `index` is known to be
* within bounds.
*/
function unchecked_setAt(
IERC20ToBytes32Map storage map,
uint256 index,
bytes32 value
) internal {
map._entries[index]._value = value;
}
/**
* @dev Removes a key-value pair from a map. O(1).
*
* Returns true if the key was removed from the map, that is if it was present.
*/
function remove(IERC20ToBytes32Map storage map, IERC20 key) internal returns (bool) {
// We read and store the key's index to prevent multiple reads from the same storage slot
uint256 keyIndex = map._indexes[key];
// Equivalent to contains(map, key)
if (keyIndex != 0) {
// To delete a key-value pair from the _entries pseudo-array in O(1), we swap the entry to delete with the
// one at the highest index, and then remove this last entry (sometimes called as 'swap and pop').
// This modifies the order of the pseudo-array, as noted in {at}.
uint256 toDeleteIndex = keyIndex - 1;
uint256 lastIndex = map._length - 1;
// When the entry to delete is the last one, the swap operation is unnecessary. However, since this occurs
// so rarely, we still do the swap anyway to avoid the gas cost of adding an 'if' statement.
IERC20ToBytes32MapEntry storage lastEntry = map._entries[lastIndex];
// Move the last entry to the index where the entry to delete is
map._entries[toDeleteIndex] = lastEntry;
// Update the index for the moved entry
map._indexes[lastEntry._key] = toDeleteIndex + 1; // All indexes are 1-based
// Delete the slot where the moved entry was stored
delete map._entries[lastIndex];
map._length = lastIndex;
// Delete the index for the deleted slot
delete map._indexes[key];
return true;
} else {
return false;
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns true if the key is in the map. O(1).
*/
function contains(IERC20ToBytes32Map storage map, IERC20 key) internal view returns (bool) {
return map._indexes[key] != 0;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the number of key-value pairs in the map. O(1).
*/
function length(IERC20ToBytes32Map storage map) internal view returns (uint256) {
return map._length;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the key-value pair stored at position `index` in the map. O(1).
*
* Note that there are no guarantees on the ordering of entries inside the
* array, and it may change when more entries are added or removed.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `index` must be strictly less than {length}.
*/
function at(IERC20ToBytes32Map storage map, uint256 index) internal view returns (IERC20, bytes32) {
_require(map._length > index, Errors.OUT_OF_BOUNDS);
return unchecked_at(map, index);
}
/**
* @dev Same as {at}, except this doesn't revert if `index` it outside of the map (i.e. if it is equal or larger
* than {length}). O(1).
*
* This function performs one less storage read than {at}, but should only be used when `index` is known to be
* within bounds.
*/
function unchecked_at(IERC20ToBytes32Map storage map, uint256 index) internal view returns (IERC20, bytes32) {
IERC20ToBytes32MapEntry storage entry = map._entries[index];
return (entry._key, entry._value);
}
/**
* @dev Same as {unchecked_At}, except it only returns the value and not the key (performing one less storage
* read). O(1).
*/
function unchecked_valueAt(IERC20ToBytes32Map storage map, uint256 index) internal view returns (bytes32) {
return map._entries[index]._value;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the value associated with `key`. O(1).
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `key` must be in the map. Reverts with `errorCode` otherwise.
*/
function get(
IERC20ToBytes32Map storage map,
IERC20 key,
uint256 errorCode
) internal view returns (bytes32) {
uint256 index = map._indexes[key];
_require(index > 0, errorCode);
return unchecked_valueAt(map, index - 1);
}
/**
* @dev Returns the index for `key` **plus one**. Does not revert if the key is not in the map, and returns 0
* instead.
*/
function unchecked_indexOf(IERC20ToBytes32Map storage map, IERC20 key) internal view returns (uint256) {
return map._indexes[key];
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
import "../helpers/BalancerErrors.sol";
// Based on the EnumerableSet library from OpenZeppelin contracts, altered to remove the base private functions that
// work on bytes32, replacing them with a native implementation for address values, to reduce bytecode size and runtime
// costs.
// The `unchecked_at` function was also added, which allows for more gas efficient data reads in some scenarios.
/**
* @dev Library for managing
* https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Set_(abstract_data_type)[sets] of primitive
* types.
*
* Sets have the following properties:
*
* - Elements are added, removed, and checked for existence in constant time
* (O(1)).
* - Elements are enumerated in O(n). No guarantees are made on the ordering.
*
* ```
* contract Example {
* // Add the library methods
* using EnumerableSet for EnumerableSet.AddressSet;
*
* // Declare a set state variable
* EnumerableSet.AddressSet private mySet;
* }
* ```
*
* As of v3.3.0, sets of type `bytes32` (`Bytes32Set`), `address` (`AddressSet`)
* and `uint256` (`UintSet`) are supported.
*/
library EnumerableSet {
// The original OpenZeppelin implementation uses a generic Set type with bytes32 values: this was replaced with
// AddressSet, which uses address keys natively, resulting in more dense bytecode.
struct AddressSet {
// Storage of set values
address[] _values;
// Position of the value in the `values` array, plus 1 because index 0
// means a value is not in the set.
mapping(address => uint256) _indexes;
}
/**
* @dev Add a value to a set. O(1).
*
* Returns true if the value was added to the set, that is if it was not
* already present.
*/
function add(AddressSet storage set, address value) internal returns (bool) {
if (!contains(set, value)) {
set._values.push(value);
// The value is stored at length-1, but we add 1 to all indexes
// and use 0 as a sentinel value
set._indexes[value] = set._values.length;
return true;
} else {
return false;
}
}
/**
* @dev Removes a value from a set. O(1).
*
* Returns true if the value was removed from the set, that is if it was
* present.
*/
function remove(AddressSet storage set, address value) internal returns (bool) {
// We read and store the value's index to prevent multiple reads from the same storage slot
uint256 valueIndex = set._indexes[value];
if (valueIndex != 0) {
// Equivalent to contains(set, value)
// To delete an element from the _values array in O(1), we swap the element to delete with the last one in
// the array, and then remove the last element (sometimes called as 'swap and pop').
// This modifies the order of the array, as noted in {at}.
uint256 toDeleteIndex = valueIndex - 1;
uint256 lastIndex = set._values.length - 1;
// When the value to delete is the last one, the swap operation is unnecessary. However, since this occurs
// so rarely, we still do the swap anyway to avoid the gas cost of adding an 'if' statement.
address lastValue = set._values[lastIndex];
// Move the last value to the index where the value to delete is
set._values[toDeleteIndex] = lastValue;
// Update the index for the moved value
set._indexes[lastValue] = toDeleteIndex + 1; // All indexes are 1-based
// Delete the slot where the moved value was stored
set._values.pop();
// Delete the index for the deleted slot
delete set._indexes[value];
return true;
} else {
return false;
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns true if the value is in the set. O(1).
*/
function contains(AddressSet storage set, address value) internal view returns (bool) {
return set._indexes[value] != 0;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the number of values on the set. O(1).
*/
function length(AddressSet storage set) internal view returns (uint256) {
return set._values.length;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the value stored at position `index` in the set. O(1).
*
* Note that there are no guarantees on the ordering of values inside the
* array, and it may change when more values are added or removed.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `index` must be strictly less than {length}.
*/
function at(AddressSet storage set, uint256 index) internal view returns (address) {
_require(set._values.length > index, Errors.OUT_OF_BOUNDS);
return unchecked_at(set, index);
}
/**
* @dev Same as {at}, except this doesn't revert if `index` it outside of the set (i.e. if it is equal or larger
* than {length}). O(1).
*
* This function performs one less storage read than {at}, but should only be used when `index` is known to be
* within bounds.
*/
function unchecked_at(AddressSet storage set, uint256 index) internal view returns (address) {
return set._values[index];
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
import "../helpers/BalancerErrors.sol";
/**
* @dev Wrappers over Solidity's uintXX/intXX casting operators with added overflow
* checks.
*
* Downcasting from uint256/int256 in Solidity does not revert on overflow. This can
* easily result in undesired exploitation or bugs, since developers usually
* assume that overflows raise errors. `SafeCast` restores this intuition by
* reverting the transaction when such an operation overflows.
*
* Using this library instead of the unchecked operations eliminates an entire
* class of bugs, so it's recommended to use it always.
*
* Can be combined with {SafeMath} and {SignedSafeMath} to extend it to smaller types, by performing
* all math on `uint256` and `int256` and then downcasting.
*/
library SafeCast {
/**
* @dev Converts an unsigned uint256 into a signed int256.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - input must be less than or equal to maxInt256.
*/
function toInt256(uint256 value) internal pure returns (int256) {
_require(value < 2**255, Errors.SAFE_CAST_VALUE_CANT_FIT_INT256);
return int256(value);
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.
// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.
// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;
import "../lib/math/Math.sol";
import "../lib/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol";
import "../lib/helpers/InputHelpers.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/ReentrancyGuard.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/SafeERC20.sol";
import "./Fees.sol";
import "./PoolTokens.sol";
import "./UserBalance.sol";
import "./interfaces/IBasePool.sol";
/**
* @dev Stores the Asset Managers (by Pool and token), and implements the top level Asset Manager and Pool interfaces,
* such as registering and deregistering tokens, joining and exiting Pools, and informational functions like `getPool`
* and `getPoolTokens`, delegating to specialization-specific functions as needed.
*
* `managePoolBalance` handles all Asset Manager interactions.
*/
abstract contract PoolBalances is Fees, ReentrancyGuard, PoolTokens, UserBalance {
using Math for uint256;
using SafeERC20 for IERC20;
using BalanceAllocation for bytes32;
using BalanceAllocation for bytes32[];
function joinPool(
bytes32 poolId,
address sender,
address recipient,
JoinPoolRequest memory request
) external payable override whenNotPaused {
// This function doesn't have the nonReentrant modifier: it is applied to `_joinOrExit` instead.
// Note that `recipient` is not actually payable in the context of a join - we cast it because we handle both
// joins and exits at once.
_joinOrExit(PoolBalanceChangeKind.JOIN, poolId, sender, payable(recipient), _toPoolBalanceChange(request));
}
function exitPool(
bytes32 poolId,
address sender,
address payable recipient,
ExitPoolRequest memory request
) external override {
// This function doesn't have the nonReentrant modifier: it is applied to `_joinOrExit` instead.
_joinOrExit(PoolBalanceChangeKind.EXIT, poolId, sender, recipient, _toPoolBalanceChange(request));
}
// This has the exact same layout as JoinPoolRequest and ExitPoolRequest, except the `maxAmountsIn` and
// `minAmountsOut` are called `limits`. Internally we use this struct for both since these two functions are quite
// similar, but expose the others to callers for clarity.
struct PoolBalanceChange {
IAsset[] assets;
uint256[] limits;
bytes userData;
bool useInternalBalance;
}
/**
* @dev Converts a JoinPoolRequest into a PoolBalanceChange, with no runtime cost.
*/
function _toPoolBalanceChange(JoinPoolRequest memory request)
private
pure
returns (PoolBalanceChange memory change)
{
// solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly
assembly {
change := request
}
}
/**
* @dev Converts an ExitPoolRequest into a PoolBalanceChange, with no runtime cost.
*/
function _toPoolBalanceChange(ExitPoolRequest memory request)
private
pure
returns (PoolBalanceChange memory change)
{
// solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly
assembly {
change := request
}
}
/**
* @dev Implements both `joinPool` and `exitPool`, based on `kind`.
*/
function _joinOrExit(
PoolBalanceChangeKind kind,
bytes32 poolId,
address sender,
address payable recipient,
PoolBalanceChange memory change
) private nonReentrant withRegisteredPool(poolId) authenticateFor(sender) {
// This function uses a large number of stack variables (poolId, sender and recipient, balances, amounts, fees,
// etc.), which leads to 'stack too deep' issues. It relies on private functions with seemingly arbitrary
// interfaces to work around this limitation.
InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(change.assets.length, change.limits.length);
// We first check that the caller passed the Pool's registered tokens in the correct order, and retrieve the
// current balance for each.
IERC20[] memory tokens = _translateToIERC20(change.assets);
bytes32[] memory balances = _validateTokensAndGetBalances(poolId, tokens);
// The bulk of the work is done here: the corresponding Pool hook is called, its final balances are computed,
// assets are transferred, and fees are paid.
(
bytes32[] memory finalBalances,
uint256[] memory amountsInOrOut,
uint256[] memory paidProtocolSwapFeeAmounts
) = _callPoolBalanceChange(kind, poolId, sender, recipient, change, balances);
// All that remains is storing the new Pool balances.
PoolSpecialization specialization = _getPoolSpecialization(poolId);
if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.TWO_TOKEN) {
_setTwoTokenPoolCashBalances(poolId, tokens[0], finalBalances[0], tokens[1], finalBalances[1]);
} else if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.MINIMAL_SWAP_INFO) {
_setMinimalSwapInfoPoolBalances(poolId, tokens, finalBalances);
} else {
// PoolSpecialization.GENERAL
_setGeneralPoolBalances(poolId, finalBalances);
}
bool positive = kind == PoolBalanceChangeKind.JOIN; // Amounts in are positive, out are negative
emit PoolBalanceChanged(
poolId,
sender,
tokens,
// We can unsafely cast to int256 because balances are actually stored as uint112
_unsafeCastToInt256(amountsInOrOut, positive),
paidProtocolSwapFeeAmounts
);
}
/**
* @dev Calls the corresponding Pool hook to get the amounts in/out plus protocol fee amounts, and performs the
* associated token transfers and fee payments, returning the Pool's final balances.
*/
function _callPoolBalanceChange(
PoolBalanceChangeKind kind,
bytes32 poolId,
address sender,
address payable recipient,
PoolBalanceChange memory change,
bytes32[] memory balances
)
private
returns (
bytes32[] memory finalBalances,
uint256[] memory amountsInOrOut,
uint256[] memory dueProtocolFeeAmounts
)
{
(uint256[] memory totalBalances, uint256 lastChangeBlock) = balances.totalsAndLastChangeBlock();
IBasePool pool = IBasePool(_getPoolAddress(poolId));
(amountsInOrOut, dueProtocolFeeAmounts) = kind == PoolBalanceChangeKind.JOIN
? pool.onJoinPool(
poolId,
sender,
recipient,
totalBalances,
lastChangeBlock,
_getProtocolSwapFeePercentage(),
change.userData
)
: pool.onExitPool(
poolId,
sender,
recipient,
totalBalances,
lastChangeBlock,
_getProtocolSwapFeePercentage(),
change.userData
);
InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(balances.length, amountsInOrOut.length, dueProtocolFeeAmounts.length);
// The Vault ignores the `recipient` in joins and the `sender` in exits: it is up to the Pool to keep track of
// their participation.
finalBalances = kind == PoolBalanceChangeKind.JOIN
? _processJoinPoolTransfers(sender, change, balances, amountsInOrOut, dueProtocolFeeAmounts)
: _processExitPoolTransfers(recipient, change, balances, amountsInOrOut, dueProtocolFeeAmounts);
}
/**
* @dev Transfers `amountsIn` from `sender`, checking that they are within their accepted limits, and pays
* accumulated protocol swap fees.
*
* Returns the Pool's final balances, which are the current balances plus `amountsIn` minus accumulated protocol
* swap fees.
*/
function _processJoinPoolTransfers(
address sender,
PoolBalanceChange memory change,
bytes32[] memory balances,
uint256[] memory amountsIn,
uint256[] memory dueProtocolFeeAmounts
) private returns (bytes32[] memory finalBalances) {
// We need to track how much of the received ETH was used and wrapped into WETH to return any excess.
uint256 wrappedEth = 0;
finalBalances = new bytes32[](balances.length);
for (uint256 i = 0; i < change.assets.length; ++i) {
uint256 amountIn = amountsIn[i];
_require(amountIn <= change.limits[i], Errors.JOIN_ABOVE_MAX);
// Receive assets from the sender - possibly from Internal Balance.
IAsset asset = change.assets[i];
_receiveAsset(asset, amountIn, sender, change.useInternalBalance);
if (_isETH(asset)) {
wrappedEth = wrappedEth.add(amountIn);
}
uint256 feeAmount = dueProtocolFeeAmounts[i];
_payFeeAmount(_translateToIERC20(asset), feeAmount);
// Compute the new Pool balances. Note that the fee amount might be larger than `amountIn`,
// resulting in an overall decrease of the Pool's balance for a token.
finalBalances[i] = (amountIn >= feeAmount) // This lets us skip checked arithmetic
? balances[i].increaseCash(amountIn - feeAmount)
: balances[i].decreaseCash(feeAmount - amountIn);
}
// Handle any used and remaining ETH.
_handleRemainingEth(wrappedEth);
}
/**
* @dev Transfers `amountsOut` to `recipient`, checking that they are within their accepted limits, and pays
* accumulated protocol swap fees from the Pool.
*
* Returns the Pool's final balances, which are the current `balances` minus `amountsOut` and fees paid
* (`dueProtocolFeeAmounts`).
*/
function _processExitPoolTransfers(
address payable recipient,
PoolBalanceChange memory change,
bytes32[] memory balances,
uint256[] memory amountsOut,
uint256[] memory dueProtocolFeeAmounts
) private returns (bytes32[] memory finalBalances) {
finalBalances = new bytes32[](balances.length);
for (uint256 i = 0; i < change.assets.length; ++i) {
uint256 amountOut = amountsOut[i];
_require(amountOut >= change.limits[i], Errors.EXIT_BELOW_MIN);
// Send tokens to the recipient - possibly to Internal Balance
IAsset asset = change.assets[i];
_sendAsset(asset, amountOut, recipient, change.useInternalBalance);
uint256 feeAmount = dueProtocolFeeAmounts[i];
_payFeeAmount(_translateToIERC20(asset), feeAmount);
// Compute the new Pool balances. A Pool's token balance always decreases after an exit (potentially by 0).
finalBalances[i] = balances[i].decreaseCash(amountOut.add(feeAmount));
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns the total balance for `poolId`'s `expectedTokens`.
*
* `expectedTokens` must exactly equal the token array returned by `getPoolTokens`: both arrays must have the same
* length, elements and order. Additionally, the Pool must have at least one registered token.
*/
function _validateTokensAndGetBalances(bytes32 poolId, IERC20[] memory expectedTokens)
private
view
returns (bytes32[] memory)
{
(IERC20[] memory actualTokens, bytes32[] memory balances) = _getPoolTokens(poolId);
InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(actualTokens.length, expectedTokens.length);
_require(actualTokens.length > 0, Errors.POOL_NO_TOKENS);
for (uint256 i = 0; i < actualTokens.length; ++i) {
_require(actualTokens[i] == expectedTokens[i], Errors.TOKENS_MISMATCH);
}
return balances;
}
/**
* @dev Casts an array of uint256 to int256, setting the sign of the result according to the `positive` flag,
* without checking whether the values fit in the signed 256 bit range.
*/
function _unsafeCastToInt256(uint256[] memory values, bool positive)
private
pure
returns (int256[] memory signedValues)
{
signedValues = new int256[](values.length);
for (uint256 i = 0; i < values.length; i++) {
signedValues[i] = positive ? int256(values[i]) : -int256(values[i]);
}
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.
// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.
// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;
import "../../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol";
import "./IVault.sol";
interface IPoolSwapStructs {
// This is not really an interface - it just defines common structs used by other interfaces: IGeneralPool and
// IMinimalSwapInfoPool.
//
// This data structure represents a request for a token swap, where `kind` indicates the swap type ('given in' or
// 'given out') which indicates whether or not the amount sent by the pool is known.
//
// The pool receives `tokenIn` and sends `tokenOut`. `amount` is the number of `tokenIn` tokens the pool will take
// in, or the number of `tokenOut` tokens the Pool will send out, depending on the given swap `kind`.
//
// All other fields are not strictly necessary for most swaps, but are provided to support advanced scenarios in
// some Pools.
//
// `poolId` is the ID of the Pool involved in the swap - this is useful for Pool contracts that implement more than
// one Pool.
//
// The meaning of `lastChangeBlock` depends on the Pool specialization:
// - Two Token or Minimal Swap Info: the last block in which either `tokenIn` or `tokenOut` changed its total
// balance.
// - General: the last block in which *any* of the Pool's registered tokens changed its total balance.
//
// `from` is the origin address for the funds the Pool receives, and `to` is the destination address
// where the Pool sends the outgoing tokens.
//
// `userData` is extra data provided by the caller - typically a signature from a trusted party.
struct SwapRequest {
IVault.SwapKind kind;
IERC20 tokenIn;
IERC20 tokenOut;
uint256 amount;
// Misc data
bytes32 poolId;
uint256 lastChangeBlock;
address from;
address to;
bytes userData;
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.
// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.
// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;
import "./IBasePool.sol";
/**
* @dev IPools with the General specialization setting should implement this interface.
*
* This is called by the Vault when a user calls `IVault.swap` or `IVault.batchSwap` to swap with this Pool.
* Returns the number of tokens the Pool will grant to the user in a 'given in' swap, or that the user will
* grant to the pool in a 'given out' swap.
*
* This can often be implemented by a `view` function, since many pricing algorithms don't need to track state
* changes in swaps. However, contracts implementing this in non-view functions should check that the caller is
* indeed the Vault.
*/
interface IGeneralPool is IBasePool {
function onSwap(
SwapRequest memory swapRequest,
uint256[] memory balances,
uint256 indexIn,
uint256 indexOut
) external returns (uint256 amount);
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.
// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.
// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;
import "./IBasePool.sol";
/**
* @dev Pool contracts with the MinimalSwapInfo or TwoToken specialization settings should implement this interface.
*
* This is called by the Vault when a user calls `IVault.swap` or `IVault.batchSwap` to swap with this Pool.
* Returns the number of tokens the Pool will grant to the user in a 'given in' swap, or that the user will grant
* to the pool in a 'given out' swap.
*
* This can often be implemented by a `view` function, since many pricing algorithms don't need to track state
* changes in swaps. However, contracts implementing this in non-view functions should check that the caller is
* indeed the Vault.
*/
interface IMinimalSwapInfoPool is IBasePool {
function onSwap(
SwapRequest memory swapRequest,
uint256 currentBalanceTokenIn,
uint256 currentBalanceTokenOut
) external returns (uint256 amount);
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.
// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.
// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
import "../../lib/math/Math.sol";
// This library is used to create a data structure that represents a token's balance for a Pool. 'cash' is how many
// tokens the Pool has sitting inside of the Vault. 'managed' is how many tokens were withdrawn from the Vault by the
// Pool's Asset Manager. 'total' is the sum of these two, and represents the Pool's total token balance, including
// tokens that are *not* inside of the Vault.
//
// 'cash' is updated whenever tokens enter and exit the Vault, while 'managed' is only updated if the reason tokens are
// moving is due to an Asset Manager action. This is reflected in the different methods available: 'increaseCash'
// and 'decreaseCash' for swaps and add/remove liquidity events, and 'cashToManaged' and 'managedToCash' for events
// transferring funds to and from the Asset Manager.
//
// The Vault disallows the Pool's 'cash' from becoming negative. In other words, it can never use any tokens that are
// not inside the Vault.
//
// One of the goals of this library is to store the entire token balance in a single storage slot, which is why we use
// 112 bit unsigned integers for 'cash' and 'managed'. For consistency, we also disallow any combination of 'cash' and
// 'managed' that yields a 'total' that doesn't fit in 112 bits.
//
// The remaining 32 bits of the slot are used to store the most recent block when the total balance changed. This
// can be used to implement price oracles that are resilient to 'sandwich' attacks.
//
// We could use a Solidity struct to pack these three values together in a single storage slot, but unfortunately
// Solidity only allows for structs to live in either storage, calldata or memory. Because a memory struct still takes
// up a slot in the stack (to store its memory location), and because the entire balance fits in a single stack slot
// (two 112 bit values plus the 32 bit block), using memory is strictly less gas performant. Therefore, we do manual
// packing and unpacking.
//
// Since we cannot define new types, we rely on bytes32 to represent these values instead, as it doesn't have any
// associated arithmetic operations and therefore reduces the chance of misuse.
library BalanceAllocation {
using Math for uint256;
// The 'cash' portion of the balance is stored in the least significant 112 bits of a 256 bit word, while the
// 'managed' part uses the following 112 bits. The most significant 32 bits are used to store the block
/**
* @dev Returns the total amount of Pool tokens, including those that are not currently in the Vault ('managed').
*/
function total(bytes32 balance) internal pure returns (uint256) {
// Since 'cash' and 'managed' are 112 bit values, we don't need checked arithmetic. Additionally, `toBalance`
// ensures that 'total' always fits in 112 bits.
return cash(balance) + managed(balance);
}
/**
* @dev Returns the amount of Pool tokens currently in the Vault.
*/
function cash(bytes32 balance) internal pure returns (uint256) {
uint256 mask = 2**(112) - 1;
return uint256(balance) & mask;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the amount of Pool tokens that are being managed by an Asset Manager.
*/
function managed(bytes32 balance) internal pure returns (uint256) {
uint256 mask = 2**(112) - 1;
return uint256(balance >> 112) & mask;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the last block when the total balance changed.
*/
function lastChangeBlock(bytes32 balance) internal pure returns (uint256) {
uint256 mask = 2**(32) - 1;
return uint256(balance >> 224) & mask;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the difference in 'managed' between two balances.
*/
function managedDelta(bytes32 newBalance, bytes32 oldBalance) internal pure returns (int256) {
// Because `managed` is a 112 bit value, we can safely perform unchecked arithmetic in 256 bits.
return int256(managed(newBalance)) - int256(managed(oldBalance));
}
/**
* @dev Returns the total balance for each entry in `balances`, as well as the latest block when the total
* balance of *any* of them last changed.
*/
function totalsAndLastChangeBlock(bytes32[] memory balances)
internal
pure
returns (
uint256[] memory results,
uint256 lastChangeBlock_ // Avoid shadowing
)
{
results = new uint256[](balances.length);
lastChangeBlock_ = 0;
for (uint256 i = 0; i < results.length; i++) {
bytes32 balance = balances[i];
results[i] = total(balance);
lastChangeBlock_ = Math.max(lastChangeBlock_, lastChangeBlock(balance));
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns true if `balance`'s 'total' balance is zero. Costs less gas than computing 'total' and comparing
* with zero.
*/
function isZero(bytes32 balance) internal pure returns (bool) {
// We simply need to check the least significant 224 bytes of the word: the block does not affect this.
uint256 mask = 2**(224) - 1;
return (uint256(balance) & mask) == 0;
}
/**
* @dev Returns true if `balance`'s 'total' balance is not zero. Costs less gas than computing 'total' and comparing
* with zero.
*/
function isNotZero(bytes32 balance) internal pure returns (bool) {
return !isZero(balance);
}
/**
* @dev Packs together `cash` and `managed` amounts with a block to create a balance value.
*
* For consistency, this also checks that the sum of `cash` and `managed` (`total`) fits in 112 bits.
*/
function toBalance(
uint256 _cash,
uint256 _managed,
uint256 _blockNumber
) internal pure returns (bytes32) {
uint256 _total = _cash + _managed;
// Since both 'cash' and 'managed' are positive integers, by checking that their sum ('total') fits in 112 bits
// we are also indirectly checking that both 'cash' and 'managed' themselves fit in 112 bits.
_require(_total >= _cash && _total < 2**112, Errors.BALANCE_TOTAL_OVERFLOW);
// We assume the block fits in 32 bits - this is expected to hold for at least a few decades.
return _pack(_cash, _managed, _blockNumber);
}
/**
* @dev Increases a Pool's 'cash' (and therefore its 'total'). Called when Pool tokens are sent to the Vault (except
* for Asset Manager deposits).
*
* Updates the last total balance change block, even if `amount` is zero.
*/
function increaseCash(bytes32 balance, uint256 amount) internal view returns (bytes32) {
uint256 newCash = cash(balance).add(amount);
uint256 currentManaged = managed(balance);
uint256 newLastChangeBlock = block.number;
return toBalance(newCash, currentManaged, newLastChangeBlock);
}
/**
* @dev Decreases a Pool's 'cash' (and therefore its 'total'). Called when Pool tokens are sent from the Vault
* (except for Asset Manager withdrawals).
*
* Updates the last total balance change block, even if `amount` is zero.
*/
function decreaseCash(bytes32 balance, uint256 amount) internal view returns (bytes32) {
uint256 newCash = cash(balance).sub(amount);
uint256 currentManaged = managed(balance);
uint256 newLastChangeBlock = block.number;
return toBalance(newCash, currentManaged, newLastChangeBlock);
}
/**
* @dev Moves 'cash' into 'managed', leaving 'total' unchanged. Called when an Asset Manager withdraws Pool tokens
* from the Vault.
*/
function cashToManaged(bytes32 balance, uint256 amount) internal pure returns (bytes32) {
uint256 newCash = cash(balance).sub(amount);
uint256 newManaged = managed(balance).add(amount);
uint256 currentLastChangeBlock = lastChangeBlock(balance);
return toBalance(newCash, newManaged, currentLastChangeBlock);
}
/**
* @dev Moves 'managed' into 'cash', leaving 'total' unchanged. Called when an Asset Manager deposits Pool tokens
* into the Vault.
*/
function managedToCash(bytes32 balance, uint256 amount) internal pure returns (bytes32) {
uint256 newCash = cash(balance).add(amount);
uint256 newManaged = managed(balance).sub(amount);
uint256 currentLastChangeBlock = lastChangeBlock(balance);
return toBalance(newCash, newManaged, currentLastChangeBlock);
}
/**
* @dev Sets 'managed' balance to an arbitrary value, changing 'total'. Called when the Asset Manager reports
* profits or losses. It's the Manager's responsibility to provide a meaningful value.
*
* Updates the last total balance change block, even if `newManaged` is equal to the current 'managed' value.
*/
function setManaged(bytes32 balance, uint256 newManaged) internal view returns (bytes32) {
uint256 currentCash = cash(balance);
uint256 newLastChangeBlock = block.number;
return toBalance(currentCash, newManaged, newLastChangeBlock);
}
// Alternative mode for Pools with the Two Token specialization setting
// Instead of storing cash and external for each 'token in' a single storage slot, Two Token Pools store the cash
// for both tokens in the same slot, and the managed for both in another one. This reduces the gas cost for swaps,
// because the only slot that needs to be updated is the one with the cash. However, it also means that managing
// balances is more cumbersome, as both tokens need to be read/written at the same time.
//
// The field with both cash balances packed is called sharedCash, and the one with external amounts is called
// sharedManaged. These two are collectively called the 'shared' balance fields. In both of these, the portion
// that corresponds to token A is stored in the least significant 112 bits of a 256 bit word, while token B's part
// uses the next least significant 112 bits.
//
// Because only cash is written to during a swap, we store the last total balance change block with the
// packed cash fields. Typically Pools have a distinct block per token: in the case of Two Token Pools they
// are the same.
/**
* @dev Extracts the part of the balance that corresponds to token A. This function can be used to decode both
* shared cash and managed balances.
*/
function _decodeBalanceA(bytes32 sharedBalance) private pure returns (uint256) {
uint256 mask = 2**(112) - 1;
return uint256(sharedBalance) & mask;
}
/**
* @dev Extracts the part of the balance that corresponds to token B. This function can be used to decode both
* shared cash and managed balances.
*/
function _decodeBalanceB(bytes32 sharedBalance) private pure returns (uint256) {
uint256 mask = 2**(112) - 1;
return uint256(sharedBalance >> 112) & mask;
}
// To decode the last balance change block, we can simply use the `blockNumber` function.
/**
* @dev Unpacks the shared token A and token B cash and managed balances into the balance for token A.
*/
function fromSharedToBalanceA(bytes32 sharedCash, bytes32 sharedManaged) internal pure returns (bytes32) {
// Note that we extract the block from the sharedCash field, which is the one that is updated by swaps.
// Both token A and token B use the same block
return toBalance(_decodeBalanceA(sharedCash), _decodeBalanceA(sharedManaged), lastChangeBlock(sharedCash));
}
/**
* @dev Unpacks the shared token A and token B cash and managed balances into the balance for token B.
*/
function fromSharedToBalanceB(bytes32 sharedCash, bytes32 sharedManaged) internal pure returns (bytes32) {
// Note that we extract the block from the sharedCash field, which is the one that is updated by swaps.
// Both token A and token B use the same block
return toBalance(_decodeBalanceB(sharedCash), _decodeBalanceB(sharedManaged), lastChangeBlock(sharedCash));
}
/**
* @dev Returns the sharedCash shared field, given the current balances for token A and token B.
*/
function toSharedCash(bytes32 tokenABalance, bytes32 tokenBBalance) internal pure returns (bytes32) {
// Both balances are assigned the same block Since it is possible a single one of them has changed (for
// example, in an Asset Manager update), we keep the latest (largest) one.
uint32 newLastChangeBlock = uint32(Math.max(lastChangeBlock(tokenABalance), lastChangeBlock(tokenBBalance)));
return _pack(cash(tokenABalance), cash(tokenBBalance), newLastChangeBlock);
}
/**
* @dev Returns the sharedManaged shared field, given the current balances for token A and token B.
*/
function toSharedManaged(bytes32 tokenABalance, bytes32 tokenBBalance) internal pure returns (bytes32) {
// We don't bother storing a last change block, as it is read from the shared cash field.
return _pack(managed(tokenABalance), managed(tokenBBalance), 0);
}
// Shared functions
/**
* @dev Packs together two uint112 and one uint32 into a bytes32
*/
function _pack(
uint256 _leastSignificant,
uint256 _midSignificant,
uint256 _mostSignificant
) private pure returns (bytes32) {
return bytes32((_mostSignificant << 224) + (_midSignificant << 112) + _leastSignificant);
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.
// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.
// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;
import "../lib/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/ReentrancyGuard.sol";
import "./AssetManagers.sol";
import "./PoolRegistry.sol";
import "./balances/BalanceAllocation.sol";
abstract contract PoolTokens is ReentrancyGuard, PoolRegistry, AssetManagers {
using BalanceAllocation for bytes32;
using BalanceAllocation for bytes32[];
function registerTokens(
bytes32 poolId,
IERC20[] memory tokens,
address[] memory assetManagers
) external override nonReentrant whenNotPaused onlyPool(poolId) {
InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(tokens.length, assetManagers.length);
// Validates token addresses and assigns Asset Managers
for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) {
IERC20 token = tokens[i];
_require(token != IERC20(0), Errors.INVALID_TOKEN);
_poolAssetManagers[poolId][token] = assetManagers[i];
}
PoolSpecialization specialization = _getPoolSpecialization(poolId);
if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.TWO_TOKEN) {
_require(tokens.length == 2, Errors.TOKENS_LENGTH_MUST_BE_2);
_registerTwoTokenPoolTokens(poolId, tokens[0], tokens[1]);
} else if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.MINIMAL_SWAP_INFO) {
_registerMinimalSwapInfoPoolTokens(poolId, tokens);
} else {
// PoolSpecialization.GENERAL
_registerGeneralPoolTokens(poolId, tokens);
}
emit TokensRegistered(poolId, tokens, assetManagers);
}
function deregisterTokens(bytes32 poolId, IERC20[] memory tokens)
external
override
nonReentrant
whenNotPaused
onlyPool(poolId)
{
PoolSpecialization specialization = _getPoolSpecialization(poolId);
if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.TWO_TOKEN) {
_require(tokens.length == 2, Errors.TOKENS_LENGTH_MUST_BE_2);
_deregisterTwoTokenPoolTokens(poolId, tokens[0], tokens[1]);
} else if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.MINIMAL_SWAP_INFO) {
_deregisterMinimalSwapInfoPoolTokens(poolId, tokens);
} else {
// PoolSpecialization.GENERAL
_deregisterGeneralPoolTokens(poolId, tokens);
}
// The deregister calls above ensure the total token balance is zero. Therefore it is now safe to remove any
// associated Asset Managers, since they hold no Pool balance.
for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) {
delete _poolAssetManagers[poolId][tokens[i]];
}
emit TokensDeregistered(poolId, tokens);
}
function getPoolTokens(bytes32 poolId)
external
view
override
withRegisteredPool(poolId)
returns (
IERC20[] memory tokens,
uint256[] memory balances,
uint256 lastChangeBlock
)
{
bytes32[] memory rawBalances;
(tokens, rawBalances) = _getPoolTokens(poolId);
(balances, lastChangeBlock) = rawBalances.totalsAndLastChangeBlock();
}
function getPoolTokenInfo(bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token)
external
view
override
withRegisteredPool(poolId)
returns (
uint256 cash,
uint256 managed,
uint256 lastChangeBlock,
address assetManager
)
{
bytes32 balance;
PoolSpecialization specialization = _getPoolSpecialization(poolId);
if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.TWO_TOKEN) {
balance = _getTwoTokenPoolBalance(poolId, token);
} else if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.MINIMAL_SWAP_INFO) {
balance = _getMinimalSwapInfoPoolBalance(poolId, token);
} else {
// PoolSpecialization.GENERAL
balance = _getGeneralPoolBalance(poolId, token);
}
cash = balance.cash();
managed = balance.managed();
lastChangeBlock = balance.lastChangeBlock();
assetManager = _poolAssetManagers[poolId][token];
}
/**
* @dev Returns all of `poolId`'s registered tokens, along with their raw balances.
*/
function _getPoolTokens(bytes32 poolId) internal view returns (IERC20[] memory tokens, bytes32[] memory balances) {
PoolSpecialization specialization = _getPoolSpecialization(poolId);
if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.TWO_TOKEN) {
return _getTwoTokenPoolTokens(poolId);
} else if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.MINIMAL_SWAP_INFO) {
return _getMinimalSwapInfoPoolTokens(poolId);
} else {
// PoolSpecialization.GENERAL
return _getGeneralPoolTokens(poolId);
}
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.
// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.
// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;
import "../lib/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol";
import "../lib/math/Math.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/ReentrancyGuard.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/SafeCast.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/SafeERC20.sol";
import "./AssetTransfersHandler.sol";
import "./VaultAuthorization.sol";
/**
* Implement User Balance interactions, which combine Internal Balance and using the Vault's ERC20 allowance.
*
* Users can deposit tokens into the Vault, where they are allocated to their Internal Balance, and later
* transferred or withdrawn. It can also be used as a source of tokens when joining Pools, as a destination
* when exiting them, and as either when performing swaps. This usage of Internal Balance results in greatly reduced
* gas costs when compared to relying on plain ERC20 transfers, leading to large savings for frequent users.
*
* Internal Balance management features batching, which means a single contract call can be used to perform multiple
* operations of different kinds, with different senders and recipients, at once.
*/
abstract contract UserBalance is ReentrancyGuard, AssetTransfersHandler, VaultAuthorization {
using Math for uint256;
using SafeCast for uint256;
using SafeERC20 for IERC20;
// Internal Balance for each token, for each account.
mapping(address => mapping(IERC20 => uint256)) private _internalTokenBalance;
function getInternalBalance(address user, IERC20[] memory tokens)
external
view
override
returns (uint256[] memory balances)
{
balances = new uint256[](tokens.length);
for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; i++) {
balances[i] = _getInternalBalance(user, tokens[i]);
}
}
function manageUserBalance(UserBalanceOp[] memory ops) external payable override nonReentrant {
// We need to track how much of the received ETH was used and wrapped into WETH to return any excess.
uint256 ethWrapped = 0;
// Cache for these checks so we only perform them once (if at all).
bool checkedCallerIsRelayer = false;
bool checkedNotPaused = false;
for (uint256 i = 0; i < ops.length; i++) {
UserBalanceOpKind kind;
IAsset asset;
uint256 amount;
address sender;
address payable recipient;
// This destructuring by calling `_validateUserBalanceOp` seems odd, but results in reduced bytecode size.
(kind, asset, amount, sender, recipient, checkedCallerIsRelayer) = _validateUserBalanceOp(
ops[i],
checkedCallerIsRelayer
);
if (kind == UserBalanceOpKind.WITHDRAW_INTERNAL) {
// Internal Balance withdrawals can always be performed by an authorized account.
_withdrawFromInternalBalance(asset, sender, recipient, amount);
} else {
// All other operations are blocked if the contract is paused.
// We cache the result of the pause check and skip it for other operations in this same transaction
// (if any).
if (!checkedNotPaused) {
_ensureNotPaused();
checkedNotPaused = true;
}
if (kind == UserBalanceOpKind.DEPOSIT_INTERNAL) {
_depositToInternalBalance(asset, sender, recipient, amount);
// Keep track of all ETH wrapped into WETH as part of a deposit.
if (_isETH(asset)) {
ethWrapped = ethWrapped.add(amount);
}
} else {
// Transfers don't support ETH.
_require(!_isETH(asset), Errors.CANNOT_USE_ETH_SENTINEL);
IERC20 token = _asIERC20(asset);
if (kind == UserBalanceOpKind.TRANSFER_INTERNAL) {
_transferInternalBalance(token, sender, recipient, amount);
} else {
// TRANSFER_EXTERNAL
_transferToExternalBalance(token, sender, recipient, amount);
}
}
}
}
// Handle any remaining ETH.
_handleRemainingEth(ethWrapped);
}
function _depositToInternalBalance(
IAsset asset,
address sender,
address recipient,
uint256 amount
) private {
_increaseInternalBalance(recipient, _translateToIERC20(asset), amount);
_receiveAsset(asset, amount, sender, false);
}
function _withdrawFromInternalBalance(
IAsset asset,
address sender,
address payable recipient,
uint256 amount
) private {
// A partial decrease of Internal Balance is disallowed: `sender` must have the full `amount`.
_decreaseInternalBalance(sender, _translateToIERC20(asset), amount, false);
_sendAsset(asset, amount, recipient, false);
}
function _transferInternalBalance(
IERC20 token,
address sender,
address recipient,
uint256 amount
) private {
// A partial decrease of Internal Balance is disallowed: `sender` must have the full `amount`.
_decreaseInternalBalance(sender, token, amount, false);
_increaseInternalBalance(recipient, token, amount);
}
function _transferToExternalBalance(
IERC20 token,
address sender,
address recipient,
uint256 amount
) private {
if (amount > 0) {
token.safeTransferFrom(sender, recipient, amount);
emit ExternalBalanceTransfer(token, sender, recipient, amount);
}
}
/**
* @dev Increases `account`'s Internal Balance for `token` by `amount`.
*/
function _increaseInternalBalance(
address account,
IERC20 token,
uint256 amount
) internal override {
uint256 currentBalance = _getInternalBalance(account, token);
uint256 newBalance = currentBalance.add(amount);
_setInternalBalance(account, token, newBalance, amount.toInt256());
}
/**
* @dev Decreases `account`'s Internal Balance for `token` by `amount`. If `allowPartial` is true, this function
* doesn't revert if `account` doesn't have enough balance, and sets it to zero and returns the deducted amount
* instead.
*/
function _decreaseInternalBalance(
address account,
IERC20 token,
uint256 amount,
bool allowPartial
) internal override returns (uint256 deducted) {
uint256 currentBalance = _getInternalBalance(account, token);
_require(allowPartial || (currentBalance >= amount), Errors.INSUFFICIENT_INTERNAL_BALANCE);
deducted = Math.min(currentBalance, amount);
// By construction, `deducted` is lower or equal to `currentBalance`, so we don't need to use checked
// arithmetic.
uint256 newBalance = currentBalance - deducted;
_setInternalBalance(account, token, newBalance, -(deducted.toInt256()));
}
/**
* @dev Sets `account`'s Internal Balance for `token` to `newBalance`.
*
* Emits an `InternalBalanceChanged` event. This event includes `delta`, which is the amount the balance increased
* (if positive) or decreased (if negative). To avoid reading the current balance in order to compute the delta,
* this function relies on the caller providing it directly.
*/
function _setInternalBalance(
address account,
IERC20 token,
uint256 newBalance,
int256 delta
) private {
_internalTokenBalance[account][token] = newBalance;
emit InternalBalanceChanged(account, token, delta);
}
/**
* @dev Returns `account`'s Internal Balance for `token`.
*/
function _getInternalBalance(address account, IERC20 token) internal view returns (uint256) {
return _internalTokenBalance[account][token];
}
/**
* @dev Destructures a User Balance operation, validating that the contract caller is allowed to perform it.
*/
function _validateUserBalanceOp(UserBalanceOp memory op, bool checkedCallerIsRelayer)
private
view
returns (
UserBalanceOpKind,
IAsset,
uint256,
address,
address payable,
bool
)
{
// The only argument we need to validate is `sender`, which can only be either the contract caller, or a
// relayer approved by `sender`.
address sender = op.sender;
if (sender != msg.sender) {
// We need to check both that the contract caller is a relayer, and that `sender` approved them.
// Because the relayer check is global (i.e. independent of `sender`), we cache that result and skip it for
// other operations in this same transaction (if any).
if (!checkedCallerIsRelayer) {
_authenticateCaller();
checkedCallerIsRelayer = true;
}
_require(_hasApprovedRelayer(sender, msg.sender), Errors.USER_DOESNT_ALLOW_RELAYER);
}
return (op.kind, op.asset, op.amount, sender, op.recipient, checkedCallerIsRelayer);
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.
// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.
// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;
import "./IVault.sol";
import "./IPoolSwapStructs.sol";
/**
* @dev Interface for adding and removing liquidity that all Pool contracts should implement. Note that this is not
* the complete Pool contract interface, as it is missing the swap hooks. Pool contracts should also inherit from
* either IGeneralPool or IMinimalSwapInfoPool
*/
interface IBasePool is IPoolSwapStructs {
/**
* @dev Called by the Vault when a user calls `IVault.joinPool` to add liquidity to this Pool. Returns how many of
* each registered token the user should provide, as well as the amount of protocol fees the Pool owes to the Vault.
* The Vault will then take tokens from `sender` and add them to the Pool's balances, as well as collect
* the reported amount in protocol fees, which the pool should calculate based on `protocolSwapFeePercentage`.
*
* Protocol fees are reported and charged on join events so that the Pool is free of debt whenever new users join.
*
* `sender` is the account performing the join (from which tokens will be withdrawn), and `recipient` is the account
* designated to receive any benefits (typically pool shares). `currentBalances` contains the total balances
* for each token the Pool registered in the Vault, in the same order that `IVault.getPoolTokens` would return.
*
* `lastChangeBlock` is the last block in which *any* of the Pool's registered tokens last changed its total
* balance.
*
* `userData` contains any pool-specific instructions needed to perform the calculations, such as the type of
* join (e.g., proportional given an amount of pool shares, single-asset, multi-asset, etc.)
*
* Contracts implementing this function should check that the caller is indeed the Vault before performing any
* state-changing operations, such as minting pool shares.
*/
function onJoinPool(
bytes32 poolId,
address sender,
address recipient,
uint256[] memory balances,
uint256 lastChangeBlock,
uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage,
bytes memory userData
) external returns (uint256[] memory amountsIn, uint256[] memory dueProtocolFeeAmounts);
/**
* @dev Called by the Vault when a user calls `IVault.exitPool` to remove liquidity from this Pool. Returns how many
* tokens the Vault should deduct from the Pool's balances, as well as the amount of protocol fees the Pool owes
* to the Vault. The Vault will then take tokens from the Pool's balances and send them to `recipient`,
* as well as collect the reported amount in protocol fees, which the Pool should calculate based on
* `protocolSwapFeePercentage`.
*
* Protocol fees are charged on exit events to guarantee that users exiting the Pool have paid their share.
*
* `sender` is the account performing the exit (typically the pool shareholder), and `recipient` is the account
* to which the Vault will send the proceeds. `currentBalances` contains the total token balances for each token
* the Pool registered in the Vault, in the same order that `IVault.getPoolTokens` would return.
*
* `lastChangeBlock` is the last block in which *any* of the Pool's registered tokens last changed its total
* balance.
*
* `userData` contains any pool-specific instructions needed to perform the calculations, such as the type of
* exit (e.g., proportional given an amount of pool shares, single-asset, multi-asset, etc.)
*
* Contracts implementing this function should check that the caller is indeed the Vault before performing any
* state-changing operations, such as burning pool shares.
*/
function onExitPool(
bytes32 poolId,
address sender,
address recipient,
uint256[] memory balances,
uint256 lastChangeBlock,
uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage,
bytes memory userData
) external returns (uint256[] memory amountsOut, uint256[] memory dueProtocolFeeAmounts);
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.
// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.
// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;
import "../lib/math/Math.sol";
import "../lib/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol";
import "../lib/helpers/InputHelpers.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/SafeERC20.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/ReentrancyGuard.sol";
import "./UserBalance.sol";
import "./balances/BalanceAllocation.sol";
import "./balances/GeneralPoolsBalance.sol";
import "./balances/MinimalSwapInfoPoolsBalance.sol";
import "./balances/TwoTokenPoolsBalance.sol";
abstract contract AssetManagers is
ReentrancyGuard,
GeneralPoolsBalance,
MinimalSwapInfoPoolsBalance,
TwoTokenPoolsBalance
{
using Math for uint256;
using SafeERC20 for IERC20;
// Stores the Asset Manager for each token of each Pool.
mapping(bytes32 => mapping(IERC20 => address)) internal _poolAssetManagers;
function managePoolBalance(PoolBalanceOp[] memory ops) external override nonReentrant whenNotPaused {
// This variable could be declared inside the loop, but that causes the compiler to allocate memory on each
// loop iteration, increasing gas costs.
PoolBalanceOp memory op;
for (uint256 i = 0; i < ops.length; ++i) {
// By indexing the array only once, we don't spend extra gas in the same bounds check.
op = ops[i];
bytes32 poolId = op.poolId;
_ensureRegisteredPool(poolId);
IERC20 token = op.token;
_require(_isTokenRegistered(poolId, token), Errors.TOKEN_NOT_REGISTERED);
_require(_poolAssetManagers[poolId][token] == msg.sender, Errors.SENDER_NOT_ASSET_MANAGER);
PoolBalanceOpKind kind = op.kind;
uint256 amount = op.amount;
(int256 cashDelta, int256 managedDelta) = _performPoolManagementOperation(kind, poolId, token, amount);
emit PoolBalanceManaged(poolId, msg.sender, token, cashDelta, managedDelta);
}
}
/**
* @dev Performs the `kind` Asset Manager operation on a Pool.
*
* Withdrawals will transfer `amount` tokens to the caller, deposits will transfer `amount` tokens from the caller,
* and updates will set the managed balance to `amount`.
*
* Returns a tuple with the 'cash' and 'managed' balance deltas as a result of this call.
*/
function _performPoolManagementOperation(
PoolBalanceOpKind kind,
bytes32 poolId,
IERC20 token,
uint256 amount
) private returns (int256, int256) {
PoolSpecialization specialization = _getPoolSpecialization(poolId);
if (kind == PoolBalanceOpKind.WITHDRAW) {
return _withdrawPoolBalance(poolId, specialization, token, amount);
} else if (kind == PoolBalanceOpKind.DEPOSIT) {
return _depositPoolBalance(poolId, specialization, token, amount);
} else {
// PoolBalanceOpKind.UPDATE
return _updateManagedBalance(poolId, specialization, token, amount);
}
}
/**
* @dev Moves `amount` tokens from a Pool's 'cash' to 'managed' balance, and transfers them to the caller.
*
* Returns the 'cash' and 'managed' balance deltas as a result of this call, which will be complementary.
*/
function _withdrawPoolBalance(
bytes32 poolId,
PoolSpecialization specialization,
IERC20 token,
uint256 amount
) private returns (int256 cashDelta, int256 managedDelta) {
if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.TWO_TOKEN) {
_twoTokenPoolCashToManaged(poolId, token, amount);
} else if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.MINIMAL_SWAP_INFO) {
_minimalSwapInfoPoolCashToManaged(poolId, token, amount);
} else {
// PoolSpecialization.GENERAL
_generalPoolCashToManaged(poolId, token, amount);
}
if (amount > 0) {
token.safeTransfer(msg.sender, amount);
}
// Since 'cash' and 'managed' are stored as uint112, `amount` is guaranteed to also fit in 112 bits. It will
// therefore always fit in a 256 bit integer.
cashDelta = int256(-amount);
managedDelta = int256(amount);
}
/**
* @dev Moves `amount` tokens from a Pool's 'managed' to 'cash' balance, and transfers them from the caller.
*
* Returns the 'cash' and 'managed' balance deltas as a result of this call, which will be complementary.
*/
function _depositPoolBalance(
bytes32 poolId,
PoolSpecialization specialization,
IERC20 token,
uint256 amount
) private returns (int256 cashDelta, int256 managedDelta) {
if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.TWO_TOKEN) {
_twoTokenPoolManagedToCash(poolId, token, amount);
} else if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.MINIMAL_SWAP_INFO) {
_minimalSwapInfoPoolManagedToCash(poolId, token, amount);
} else {
// PoolSpecialization.GENERAL
_generalPoolManagedToCash(poolId, token, amount);
}
if (amount > 0) {
token.safeTransferFrom(msg.sender, address(this), amount);
}
// Since 'cash' and 'managed' are stored as uint112, `amount` is guaranteed to also fit in 112 bits. It will
// therefore always fit in a 256 bit integer.
cashDelta = int256(amount);
managedDelta = int256(-amount);
}
/**
* @dev Sets a Pool's 'managed' balance to `amount`.
*
* Returns the 'cash' and 'managed' balance deltas as a result of this call (the 'cash' delta will always be zero).
*/
function _updateManagedBalance(
bytes32 poolId,
PoolSpecialization specialization,
IERC20 token,
uint256 amount
) private returns (int256 cashDelta, int256 managedDelta) {
if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.TWO_TOKEN) {
managedDelta = _setTwoTokenPoolManagedBalance(poolId, token, amount);
} else if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.MINIMAL_SWAP_INFO) {
managedDelta = _setMinimalSwapInfoPoolManagedBalance(poolId, token, amount);
} else {
// PoolSpecialization.GENERAL
managedDelta = _setGeneralPoolManagedBalance(poolId, token, amount);
}
cashDelta = 0;
}
/**
* @dev Returns true if `token` is registered for `poolId`.
*/
function _isTokenRegistered(bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token) private view returns (bool) {
PoolSpecialization specialization = _getPoolSpecialization(poolId);
if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.TWO_TOKEN) {
return _isTwoTokenPoolTokenRegistered(poolId, token);
} else if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.MINIMAL_SWAP_INFO) {
return _isMinimalSwapInfoPoolTokenRegistered(poolId, token);
} else {
// PoolSpecialization.GENERAL
return _isGeneralPoolTokenRegistered(poolId, token);
}
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.
// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.
// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;
import "../lib/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/ReentrancyGuard.sol";
import "./VaultAuthorization.sol";
/**
* @dev Maintains the Pool ID data structure, implements Pool ID creation and registration, and defines useful modifiers
* and helper functions for ensuring correct behavior when working with Pools.
*/
abstract contract PoolRegistry is ReentrancyGuard, VaultAuthorization {
// Each pool is represented by their unique Pool ID. We use `bytes32` for them, for lack of a way to define new
// types.
mapping(bytes32 => bool) private _isPoolRegistered;
// We keep an increasing nonce to make Pool IDs unique. It is interpreted as a `uint80`, but storing it as a
// `uint256` results in reduced bytecode on reads and writes due to the lack of masking.
uint256 private _nextPoolNonce;
/**
* @dev Reverts unless `poolId` corresponds to a registered Pool.
*/
modifier withRegisteredPool(bytes32 poolId) {
_ensureRegisteredPool(poolId);
_;
}
/**
* @dev Reverts unless `poolId` corresponds to a registered Pool, and the caller is the Pool's contract.
*/
modifier onlyPool(bytes32 poolId) {
_ensurePoolIsSender(poolId);
_;
}
/**
* @dev Reverts unless `poolId` corresponds to a registered Pool.
*/
function _ensureRegisteredPool(bytes32 poolId) internal view {
_require(_isPoolRegistered[poolId], Errors.INVALID_POOL_ID);
}
/**
* @dev Reverts unless `poolId` corresponds to a registered Pool, and the caller is the Pool's contract.
*/
function _ensurePoolIsSender(bytes32 poolId) private view {
_ensureRegisteredPool(poolId);
_require(msg.sender == _getPoolAddress(poolId), Errors.CALLER_NOT_POOL);
}
function registerPool(PoolSpecialization specialization)
external
override
nonReentrant
whenNotPaused
returns (bytes32)
{
// Each Pool is assigned a unique ID based on an incrementing nonce. This assumes there will never be more than
// 2**80 Pools, and the nonce will not overflow.
bytes32 poolId = _toPoolId(msg.sender, specialization, uint80(_nextPoolNonce));
_require(!_isPoolRegistered[poolId], Errors.INVALID_POOL_ID); // Should never happen as Pool IDs are unique.
_isPoolRegistered[poolId] = true;
_nextPoolNonce += 1;
// Note that msg.sender is the pool's contract
emit PoolRegistered(poolId, msg.sender, specialization);
return poolId;
}
function getPool(bytes32 poolId)
external
view
override
withRegisteredPool(poolId)
returns (address, PoolSpecialization)
{
return (_getPoolAddress(poolId), _getPoolSpecialization(poolId));
}
/**
* @dev Creates a Pool ID.
*
* These are deterministically created by packing the Pool's contract address and its specialization setting into
* the ID. This saves gas by making this data easily retrievable from a Pool ID with no storage accesses.
*
* Since a single contract can register multiple Pools, a unique nonce must be provided to ensure Pool IDs are
* unique.
*
* Pool IDs have the following layout:
* | 20 bytes pool contract address | 2 bytes specialization setting | 10 bytes nonce |
* MSB LSB
*
* 2 bytes for the specialization setting is a bit overkill: there only three of them, which means two bits would
* suffice. However, there's nothing else of interest to store in this extra space.
*/
function _toPoolId(
address pool,
PoolSpecialization specialization,
uint80 nonce
) internal pure returns (bytes32) {
bytes32 serialized;
serialized |= bytes32(uint256(nonce));
serialized |= bytes32(uint256(specialization)) << (10 * 8);
serialized |= bytes32(uint256(pool)) << (12 * 8);
return serialized;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the address of a Pool's contract.
*
* Due to how Pool IDs are created, this is done with no storage accesses and costs little gas.
*/
function _getPoolAddress(bytes32 poolId) internal pure returns (address) {
// 12 byte logical shift left to remove the nonce and specialization setting. We don't need to mask,
// since the logical shift already sets the upper bits to zero.
return address(uint256(poolId) >> (12 * 8));
}
/**
* @dev Returns the specialization setting of a Pool.
*
* Due to how Pool IDs are created, this is done with no storage accesses and costs little gas.
*/
function _getPoolSpecialization(bytes32 poolId) internal pure returns (PoolSpecialization specialization) {
// 10 byte logical shift left to remove the nonce, followed by a 2 byte mask to remove the address.
uint256 value = uint256(poolId >> (10 * 8)) & (2**(2 * 8) - 1);
// Casting a value into an enum results in a runtime check that reverts unless the value is within the enum's
// range. Passing an invalid Pool ID to this function would then result in an obscure revert with no reason
// string: we instead perform the check ourselves to help in error diagnosis.
// There are three Pool specialization settings: general, minimal swap info and two tokens, which correspond to
// values 0, 1 and 2.
_require(value < 3, Errors.INVALID_POOL_ID);
// Because we have checked that `value` is within the enum range, we can use assembly to skip the runtime check.
// solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly
assembly {
specialization := value
}
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.
// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.
// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
import "../../lib/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol";
import "../../lib/openzeppelin/EnumerableMap.sol";
import "../../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol";
import "./BalanceAllocation.sol";
abstract contract GeneralPoolsBalance {
using BalanceAllocation for bytes32;
using EnumerableMap for EnumerableMap.IERC20ToBytes32Map;
// Data for Pools with the General specialization setting
//
// These Pools use the IGeneralPool interface, which means the Vault must query the balance for *all* of their
// tokens in every swap. If we kept a mapping of token to balance plus a set (array) of tokens, it'd be very gas
// intensive to read all token addresses just to then do a lookup on the balance mapping.
//
// Instead, we use our customized EnumerableMap, which lets us read the N balances in N+1 storage accesses (one for
// each token in the Pool), access the index of any 'token in' a single read (required for the IGeneralPool call),
// and update an entry's value given its index.
// Map of token -> balance pairs for each Pool with this specialization. Many functions rely on storage pointers to
// a Pool's EnumerableMap to save gas when computing storage slots.
mapping(bytes32 => EnumerableMap.IERC20ToBytes32Map) internal _generalPoolsBalances;
/**
* @dev Registers a list of tokens in a General Pool.
*
* This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the General specialization setting.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `tokens` must not be registered in the Pool
* - `tokens` must not contain duplicates
*/
function _registerGeneralPoolTokens(bytes32 poolId, IERC20[] memory tokens) internal {
EnumerableMap.IERC20ToBytes32Map storage poolBalances = _generalPoolsBalances[poolId];
for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) {
// EnumerableMaps require an explicit initial value when creating a key-value pair: we use zero, the same
// value that is found in uninitialized storage, which corresponds to an empty balance.
bool added = poolBalances.set(tokens[i], 0);
_require(added, Errors.TOKEN_ALREADY_REGISTERED);
}
}
/**
* @dev Deregisters a list of tokens in a General Pool.
*
* This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the General specialization setting.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `tokens` must be registered in the Pool
* - `tokens` must have zero balance in the Vault
* - `tokens` must not contain duplicates
*/
function _deregisterGeneralPoolTokens(bytes32 poolId, IERC20[] memory tokens) internal {
EnumerableMap.IERC20ToBytes32Map storage poolBalances = _generalPoolsBalances[poolId];
for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) {
IERC20 token = tokens[i];
bytes32 currentBalance = _getGeneralPoolBalance(poolBalances, token);
_require(currentBalance.isZero(), Errors.NONZERO_TOKEN_BALANCE);
// We don't need to check remove's return value, since _getGeneralPoolBalance already checks that the token
// was registered.
poolBalances.remove(token);
}
}
/**
* @dev Sets the balances of a General Pool's tokens to `balances`.
*
* WARNING: this assumes `balances` has the same length and order as the Pool's tokens.
*/
function _setGeneralPoolBalances(bytes32 poolId, bytes32[] memory balances) internal {
EnumerableMap.IERC20ToBytes32Map storage poolBalances = _generalPoolsBalances[poolId];
for (uint256 i = 0; i < balances.length; ++i) {
// Since we assume all balances are properly ordered, we can simply use `unchecked_setAt` to avoid one less
// storage read per token.
poolBalances.unchecked_setAt(i, balances[i]);
}
}
/**
* @dev Transforms `amount` of `token`'s balance in a General Pool from cash into managed.
*
* This function assumes `poolId` exists, corresponds to the General specialization setting, and that `token` is
* registered for that Pool.
*/
function _generalPoolCashToManaged(
bytes32 poolId,
IERC20 token,
uint256 amount
) internal {
_updateGeneralPoolBalance(poolId, token, BalanceAllocation.cashToManaged, amount);
}
/**
* @dev Transforms `amount` of `token`'s balance in a General Pool from managed into cash.
*
* This function assumes `poolId` exists, corresponds to the General specialization setting, and that `token` is
* registered for that Pool.
*/
function _generalPoolManagedToCash(
bytes32 poolId,
IERC20 token,
uint256 amount
) internal {
_updateGeneralPoolBalance(poolId, token, BalanceAllocation.managedToCash, amount);
}
/**
* @dev Sets `token`'s managed balance in a General Pool to `amount`.
*
* This function assumes `poolId` exists, corresponds to the General specialization setting, and that `token` is
* registered for that Pool.
*
* Returns the managed balance delta as a result of this call.
*/
function _setGeneralPoolManagedBalance(
bytes32 poolId,
IERC20 token,
uint256 amount
) internal returns (int256) {
return _updateGeneralPoolBalance(poolId, token, BalanceAllocation.setManaged, amount);
}
/**
* @dev Sets `token`'s balance in a General Pool to the result of the `mutation` function when called with the
* current balance and `amount`.
*
* This function assumes `poolId` exists, corresponds to the General specialization setting, and that `token` is
* registered for that Pool.
*
* Returns the managed balance delta as a result of this call.
*/
function _updateGeneralPoolBalance(
bytes32 poolId,
IERC20 token,
function(bytes32, uint256) returns (bytes32) mutation,
uint256 amount
) private returns (int256) {
EnumerableMap.IERC20ToBytes32Map storage poolBalances = _generalPoolsBalances[poolId];
bytes32 currentBalance = _getGeneralPoolBalance(poolBalances, token);
bytes32 newBalance = mutation(currentBalance, amount);
poolBalances.set(token, newBalance);
return newBalance.managedDelta(currentBalance);
}
/**
* @dev Returns an array with all the tokens and balances in a General Pool. The order may change when tokens are
* registered or deregistered.
*
* This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the General specialization setting.
*/
function _getGeneralPoolTokens(bytes32 poolId)
internal
view
returns (IERC20[] memory tokens, bytes32[] memory balances)
{
EnumerableMap.IERC20ToBytes32Map storage poolBalances = _generalPoolsBalances[poolId];
tokens = new IERC20[](poolBalances.length());
balances = new bytes32[](tokens.length);
for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) {
// Because the iteration is bounded by `tokens.length`, which matches the EnumerableMap's length, we can use
// `unchecked_at` as we know `i` is a valid token index, saving storage reads.
(tokens[i], balances[i]) = poolBalances.unchecked_at(i);
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns the balance of a token in a General Pool.
*
* This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the General specialization setting.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `token` must be registered in the Pool
*/
function _getGeneralPoolBalance(bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token) internal view returns (bytes32) {
EnumerableMap.IERC20ToBytes32Map storage poolBalances = _generalPoolsBalances[poolId];
return _getGeneralPoolBalance(poolBalances, token);
}
/**
* @dev Same as `_getGeneralPoolBalance` but using a Pool's storage pointer, which saves gas in repeated reads and
* writes.
*/
function _getGeneralPoolBalance(EnumerableMap.IERC20ToBytes32Map storage poolBalances, IERC20 token)
private
view
returns (bytes32)
{
return poolBalances.get(token, Errors.TOKEN_NOT_REGISTERED);
}
/**
* @dev Returns true if `token` is registered in a General Pool.
*
* This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the General specialization setting.
*/
function _isGeneralPoolTokenRegistered(bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token) internal view returns (bool) {
EnumerableMap.IERC20ToBytes32Map storage poolBalances = _generalPoolsBalances[poolId];
return poolBalances.contains(token);
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.
// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.
// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;
import "../../lib/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol";
import "../../lib/openzeppelin/EnumerableSet.sol";
import "../../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol";
import "./BalanceAllocation.sol";
import "../PoolRegistry.sol";
abstract contract MinimalSwapInfoPoolsBalance is PoolRegistry {
using BalanceAllocation for bytes32;
using EnumerableSet for EnumerableSet.AddressSet;
// Data for Pools with the Minimal Swap Info specialization setting
//
// These Pools use the IMinimalSwapInfoPool interface, and so the Vault must read the balance of the two tokens
// in the swap. The best solution is to use a mapping from token to balance, which lets us read or write any token's
// balance in a single storage access.
//
// We also keep a set of registered tokens. Because tokens with non-zero balance are by definition registered, in
// some balance getters we skip checking for token registration if a non-zero balance is found, saving gas by
// performing a single read instead of two.
mapping(bytes32 => mapping(IERC20 => bytes32)) internal _minimalSwapInfoPoolsBalances;
mapping(bytes32 => EnumerableSet.AddressSet) internal _minimalSwapInfoPoolsTokens;
/**
* @dev Registers a list of tokens in a Minimal Swap Info Pool.
*
* This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the Minimal Swap Info specialization setting.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `tokens` must not be registered in the Pool
* - `tokens` must not contain duplicates
*/
function _registerMinimalSwapInfoPoolTokens(bytes32 poolId, IERC20[] memory tokens) internal {
EnumerableSet.AddressSet storage poolTokens = _minimalSwapInfoPoolsTokens[poolId];
for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) {
bool added = poolTokens.add(address(tokens[i]));
_require(added, Errors.TOKEN_ALREADY_REGISTERED);
// Note that we don't initialize the balance mapping: the default value of zero corresponds to an empty
// balance.
}
}
/**
* @dev Deregisters a list of tokens in a Minimal Swap Info Pool.
*
* This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the Minimal Swap Info specialization setting.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `tokens` must be registered in the Pool
* - `tokens` must have zero balance in the Vault
* - `tokens` must not contain duplicates
*/
function _deregisterMinimalSwapInfoPoolTokens(bytes32 poolId, IERC20[] memory tokens) internal {
EnumerableSet.AddressSet storage poolTokens = _minimalSwapInfoPoolsTokens[poolId];
for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) {
IERC20 token = tokens[i];
_require(_minimalSwapInfoPoolsBalances[poolId][token].isZero(), Errors.NONZERO_TOKEN_BALANCE);
// For consistency with other Pool specialization settings, we explicitly reset the balance (which may have
// a non-zero last change block).
delete _minimalSwapInfoPoolsBalances[poolId][token];
bool removed = poolTokens.remove(address(token));
_require(removed, Errors.TOKEN_NOT_REGISTERED);
}
}
/**
* @dev Sets the balances of a Minimal Swap Info Pool's tokens to `balances`.
*
* WARNING: this assumes `balances` has the same length and order as the Pool's tokens.
*/
function _setMinimalSwapInfoPoolBalances(
bytes32 poolId,
IERC20[] memory tokens,
bytes32[] memory balances
) internal {
for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) {
_minimalSwapInfoPoolsBalances[poolId][tokens[i]] = balances[i];
}
}
/**
* @dev Transforms `amount` of `token`'s balance in a Minimal Swap Info Pool from cash into managed.
*
* This function assumes `poolId` exists, corresponds to the Minimal Swap Info specialization setting, and that
* `token` is registered for that Pool.
*/
function _minimalSwapInfoPoolCashToManaged(
bytes32 poolId,
IERC20 token,
uint256 amount
) internal {
_updateMinimalSwapInfoPoolBalance(poolId, token, BalanceAllocation.cashToManaged, amount);
}
/**
* @dev Transforms `amount` of `token`'s balance in a Minimal Swap Info Pool from managed into cash.
*
* This function assumes `poolId` exists, corresponds to the Minimal Swap Info specialization setting, and that
* `token` is registered for that Pool.
*/
function _minimalSwapInfoPoolManagedToCash(
bytes32 poolId,
IERC20 token,
uint256 amount
) internal {
_updateMinimalSwapInfoPoolBalance(poolId, token, BalanceAllocation.managedToCash, amount);
}
/**
* @dev Sets `token`'s managed balance in a Minimal Swap Info Pool to `amount`.
*
* This function assumes `poolId` exists, corresponds to the Minimal Swap Info specialization setting, and that
* `token` is registered for that Pool.
*
* Returns the managed balance delta as a result of this call.
*/
function _setMinimalSwapInfoPoolManagedBalance(
bytes32 poolId,
IERC20 token,
uint256 amount
) internal returns (int256) {
return _updateMinimalSwapInfoPoolBalance(poolId, token, BalanceAllocation.setManaged, amount);
}
/**
* @dev Sets `token`'s balance in a Minimal Swap Info Pool to the result of the `mutation` function when called with
* the current balance and `amount`.
*
* This function assumes `poolId` exists, corresponds to the Minimal Swap Info specialization setting, and that
* `token` is registered for that Pool.
*
* Returns the managed balance delta as a result of this call.
*/
function _updateMinimalSwapInfoPoolBalance(
bytes32 poolId,
IERC20 token,
function(bytes32, uint256) returns (bytes32) mutation,
uint256 amount
) internal returns (int256) {
bytes32 currentBalance = _getMinimalSwapInfoPoolBalance(poolId, token);
bytes32 newBalance = mutation(currentBalance, amount);
_minimalSwapInfoPoolsBalances[poolId][token] = newBalance;
return newBalance.managedDelta(currentBalance);
}
/**
* @dev Returns an array with all the tokens and balances in a Minimal Swap Info Pool. The order may change when
* tokens are registered or deregistered.
*
* This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the Minimal Swap Info specialization setting.
*/
function _getMinimalSwapInfoPoolTokens(bytes32 poolId)
internal
view
returns (IERC20[] memory tokens, bytes32[] memory balances)
{
EnumerableSet.AddressSet storage poolTokens = _minimalSwapInfoPoolsTokens[poolId];
tokens = new IERC20[](poolTokens.length());
balances = new bytes32[](tokens.length);
for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) {
// Because the iteration is bounded by `tokens.length`, which matches the EnumerableSet's length, we can use
// `unchecked_at` as we know `i` is a valid token index, saving storage reads.
IERC20 token = IERC20(poolTokens.unchecked_at(i));
tokens[i] = token;
balances[i] = _minimalSwapInfoPoolsBalances[poolId][token];
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns the balance of a token in a Minimal Swap Info Pool.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `poolId` must be a Minimal Swap Info Pool
* - `token` must be registered in the Pool
*/
function _getMinimalSwapInfoPoolBalance(bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token) internal view returns (bytes32) {
bytes32 balance = _minimalSwapInfoPoolsBalances[poolId][token];
// A non-zero balance guarantees that the token is registered. If zero, we manually check if the token is
// registered in the Pool. Token registration implies that the Pool is registered as well, which lets us save
// gas by not performing the check.
bool tokenRegistered = balance.isNotZero() || _minimalSwapInfoPoolsTokens[poolId].contains(address(token));
if (!tokenRegistered) {
// The token might not be registered because the Pool itself is not registered. We check this to provide a
// more accurate revert reason.
_ensureRegisteredPool(poolId);
_revert(Errors.TOKEN_NOT_REGISTERED);
}
return balance;
}
/**
* @dev Returns true if `token` is registered in a Minimal Swap Info Pool.
*
* This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the Minimal Swap Info specialization setting.
*/
function _isMinimalSwapInfoPoolTokenRegistered(bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token) internal view returns (bool) {
EnumerableSet.AddressSet storage poolTokens = _minimalSwapInfoPoolsTokens[poolId];
return poolTokens.contains(address(token));
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.
// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.
// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;
import "../../lib/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol";
import "../../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol";
import "./BalanceAllocation.sol";
import "../PoolRegistry.sol";
abstract contract TwoTokenPoolsBalance is PoolRegistry {
using BalanceAllocation for bytes32;
// Data for Pools with the Two Token specialization setting
//
// These are similar to the Minimal Swap Info Pool case (because the Pool only has two tokens, and therefore there
// are only two balances to read), but there's a key difference in how data is stored. Keeping a set makes little
// sense, as it will only ever hold two tokens, so we can just store those two directly.
//
// The gas savings associated with using these Pools come from how token balances are stored: cash amounts for token
// A and token B are packed together, as are managed amounts. Because only cash changes in a swap, there's no need
// to write to this second storage slot. A single last change block number for both tokens is stored with the packed
// cash fields.
struct TwoTokenPoolBalances {
bytes32 sharedCash;
bytes32 sharedManaged;
}
// We could just keep a mapping from Pool ID to TwoTokenSharedBalances, but there's an issue: we wouldn't know to
// which tokens those balances correspond. This would mean having to also check which are registered with the Pool.
//
// What we do instead to save those storage reads is keep a nested mapping from the token pair hash to the balances
// struct. The Pool only has two tokens, so only a single entry of this mapping is set (the one that corresponds to
// that pair's hash).
//
// This has the trade-off of making Vault code that interacts with these Pools cumbersome: both balances must be
// accessed at the same time by using both token addresses, and some logic is needed to determine how the pair hash
// is computed. We do this by sorting the tokens, calling the token with the lowest numerical address value token A,
// and the other one token B. In functions where the token arguments could be either A or B, we use X and Y instead.
//
// If users query a token pair containing an unregistered token, the Pool will generate a hash for a mapping entry
// that was not set, and return zero balances. Non-zero balances are only possible if both tokens in the pair
// are registered with the Pool, which means we don't have to check the TwoTokenPoolTokens struct, and can save
// storage reads.
struct TwoTokenPoolTokens {
IERC20 tokenA;
IERC20 tokenB;
mapping(bytes32 => TwoTokenPoolBalances) balances;
}
mapping(bytes32 => TwoTokenPoolTokens) private _twoTokenPoolTokens;
/**
* @dev Registers tokens in a Two Token Pool.
*
* This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the Two Token specialization setting.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `tokenX` and `tokenY` must not be the same
* - The tokens must be ordered: tokenX < tokenY
*/
function _registerTwoTokenPoolTokens(
bytes32 poolId,
IERC20 tokenX,
IERC20 tokenY
) internal {
// Not technically true since we didn't register yet, but this is consistent with the error messages of other
// specialization settings.
_require(tokenX != tokenY, Errors.TOKEN_ALREADY_REGISTERED);
_require(tokenX < tokenY, Errors.UNSORTED_TOKENS);
// A Two Token Pool with no registered tokens is identified by having zero addresses for tokens A and B.
TwoTokenPoolTokens storage poolTokens = _twoTokenPoolTokens[poolId];
_require(poolTokens.tokenA == IERC20(0) && poolTokens.tokenB == IERC20(0), Errors.TOKENS_ALREADY_SET);
// Since tokenX < tokenY, tokenX is A and tokenY is B
poolTokens.tokenA = tokenX;
poolTokens.tokenB = tokenY;
// Note that we don't initialize the balance mapping: the default value of zero corresponds to an empty
// balance.
}
/**
* @dev Deregisters tokens in a Two Token Pool.
*
* This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the Two Token specialization setting.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `tokenX` and `tokenY` must be registered in the Pool
* - both tokens must have zero balance in the Vault
*/
function _deregisterTwoTokenPoolTokens(
bytes32 poolId,
IERC20 tokenX,
IERC20 tokenY
) internal {
(
bytes32 balanceA,
bytes32 balanceB,
TwoTokenPoolBalances storage poolBalances
) = _getTwoTokenPoolSharedBalances(poolId, tokenX, tokenY);
_require(balanceA.isZero() && balanceB.isZero(), Errors.NONZERO_TOKEN_BALANCE);
delete _twoTokenPoolTokens[poolId];
// For consistency with other Pool specialization settings, we explicitly reset the packed cash field (which may
// have a non-zero last change block).
delete poolBalances.sharedCash;
}
/**
* @dev Sets the cash balances of a Two Token Pool's tokens.
*
* WARNING: this assumes `tokenA` and `tokenB` are the Pool's two registered tokens, and are in the correct order.
*/
function _setTwoTokenPoolCashBalances(
bytes32 poolId,
IERC20 tokenA,
bytes32 balanceA,
IERC20 tokenB,
bytes32 balanceB
) internal {
bytes32 pairHash = _getTwoTokenPairHash(tokenA, tokenB);
TwoTokenPoolBalances storage poolBalances = _twoTokenPoolTokens[poolId].balances[pairHash];
poolBalances.sharedCash = BalanceAllocation.toSharedCash(balanceA, balanceB);
}
/**
* @dev Transforms `amount` of `token`'s balance in a Two Token Pool from cash into managed.
*
* This function assumes `poolId` exists, corresponds to the Two Token specialization setting, and that `token` is
* registered for that Pool.
*/
function _twoTokenPoolCashToManaged(
bytes32 poolId,
IERC20 token,
uint256 amount
) internal {
_updateTwoTokenPoolSharedBalance(poolId, token, BalanceAllocation.cashToManaged, amount);
}
/**
* @dev Transforms `amount` of `token`'s balance in a Two Token Pool from managed into cash.
*
* This function assumes `poolId` exists, corresponds to the Two Token specialization setting, and that `token` is
* registered for that Pool.
*/
function _twoTokenPoolManagedToCash(
bytes32 poolId,
IERC20 token,
uint256 amount
) internal {
_updateTwoTokenPoolSharedBalance(poolId, token, BalanceAllocation.managedToCash, amount);
}
/**
* @dev Sets `token`'s managed balance in a Two Token Pool to `amount`.
*
* This function assumes `poolId` exists, corresponds to the Two Token specialization setting, and that `token` is
* registered for that Pool.
*
* Returns the managed balance delta as a result of this call.
*/
function _setTwoTokenPoolManagedBalance(
bytes32 poolId,
IERC20 token,
uint256 amount
) internal returns (int256) {
return _updateTwoTokenPoolSharedBalance(poolId, token, BalanceAllocation.setManaged, amount);
}
/**
* @dev Sets `token`'s balance in a Two Token Pool to the result of the `mutation` function when called with
* the current balance and `amount`.
*
* This function assumes `poolId` exists, corresponds to the Two Token specialization setting, and that `token` is
* registered for that Pool.
*
* Returns the managed balance delta as a result of this call.
*/
function _updateTwoTokenPoolSharedBalance(
bytes32 poolId,
IERC20 token,
function(bytes32, uint256) returns (bytes32) mutation,
uint256 amount
) private returns (int256) {
(
TwoTokenPoolBalances storage balances,
IERC20 tokenA,
bytes32 balanceA,
,
bytes32 balanceB
) = _getTwoTokenPoolBalances(poolId);
int256 delta;
if (token == tokenA) {
bytes32 newBalance = mutation(balanceA, amount);
delta = newBalance.managedDelta(balanceA);
balanceA = newBalance;
} else {
// token == tokenB
bytes32 newBalance = mutation(balanceB, amount);
delta = newBalance.managedDelta(balanceB);
balanceB = newBalance;
}
balances.sharedCash = BalanceAllocation.toSharedCash(balanceA, balanceB);
balances.sharedManaged = BalanceAllocation.toSharedManaged(balanceA, balanceB);
return delta;
}
/*
* @dev Returns an array with all the tokens and balances in a Two Token Pool. The order may change when
* tokens are registered or deregistered.
*
* This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the Two Token specialization setting.
*/
function _getTwoTokenPoolTokens(bytes32 poolId)
internal
view
returns (IERC20[] memory tokens, bytes32[] memory balances)
{
(, IERC20 tokenA, bytes32 balanceA, IERC20 tokenB, bytes32 balanceB) = _getTwoTokenPoolBalances(poolId);
// Both tokens will either be zero (if unregistered) or non-zero (if registered), but we keep the full check for
// clarity.
if (tokenA == IERC20(0) || tokenB == IERC20(0)) {
return (new IERC20[](0), new bytes32[](0));
}
// Note that functions relying on this getter expect tokens to be properly ordered, so we use the (A, B)
// ordering.
tokens = new IERC20[](2);
tokens[0] = tokenA;
tokens[1] = tokenB;
balances = new bytes32[](2);
balances[0] = balanceA;
balances[1] = balanceB;
}
/**
* @dev Same as `_getTwoTokenPoolTokens`, except it returns the two tokens and balances directly instead of using
* an array, as well as a storage pointer to the `TwoTokenPoolBalances` struct, which can be used to update it
* without having to recompute the pair hash and storage slot.
*/
function _getTwoTokenPoolBalances(bytes32 poolId)
private
view
returns (
TwoTokenPoolBalances storage poolBalances,
IERC20 tokenA,
bytes32 balanceA,
IERC20 tokenB,
bytes32 balanceB
)
{
TwoTokenPoolTokens storage poolTokens = _twoTokenPoolTokens[poolId];
tokenA = poolTokens.tokenA;
tokenB = poolTokens.tokenB;
bytes32 pairHash = _getTwoTokenPairHash(tokenA, tokenB);
poolBalances = poolTokens.balances[pairHash];
bytes32 sharedCash = poolBalances.sharedCash;
bytes32 sharedManaged = poolBalances.sharedManaged;
balanceA = BalanceAllocation.fromSharedToBalanceA(sharedCash, sharedManaged);
balanceB = BalanceAllocation.fromSharedToBalanceB(sharedCash, sharedManaged);
}
/**
* @dev Returns the balance of a token in a Two Token Pool.
*
* This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the General specialization setting.
*
* This function is convenient but not particularly gas efficient, and should be avoided during gas-sensitive
* operations, such as swaps. For those, _getTwoTokenPoolSharedBalances provides a more flexible interface.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `token` must be registered in the Pool
*/
function _getTwoTokenPoolBalance(bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token) internal view returns (bytes32) {
// We can't just read the balance of token, because we need to know the full pair in order to compute the pair
// hash and access the balance mapping. We therefore rely on `_getTwoTokenPoolBalances`.
(, IERC20 tokenA, bytes32 balanceA, IERC20 tokenB, bytes32 balanceB) = _getTwoTokenPoolBalances(poolId);
if (token == tokenA) {
return balanceA;
} else if (token == tokenB) {
return balanceB;
} else {
_revert(Errors.TOKEN_NOT_REGISTERED);
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns the balance of the two tokens in a Two Token Pool.
*
* The returned balances are those of token A and token B, where token A is the lowest of token X and token Y, and
* token B the other.
*
* This function also returns a storage pointer to the TwoTokenPoolBalances struct associated with the token pair,
* which can be used to update it without having to recompute the pair hash and storage slot.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `poolId` must be a Minimal Swap Info Pool
* - `tokenX` and `tokenY` must be registered in the Pool
*/
function _getTwoTokenPoolSharedBalances(
bytes32 poolId,
IERC20 tokenX,
IERC20 tokenY
)
internal
view
returns (
bytes32 balanceA,
bytes32 balanceB,
TwoTokenPoolBalances storage poolBalances
)
{
(IERC20 tokenA, IERC20 tokenB) = _sortTwoTokens(tokenX, tokenY);
bytes32 pairHash = _getTwoTokenPairHash(tokenA, tokenB);
poolBalances = _twoTokenPoolTokens[poolId].balances[pairHash];
// Because we're reading balances using the pair hash, if either token X or token Y is not registered then
// *both* balance entries will be zero.
bytes32 sharedCash = poolBalances.sharedCash;
bytes32 sharedManaged = poolBalances.sharedManaged;
// A non-zero balance guarantees that both tokens are registered. If zero, we manually check whether each
// token is registered in the Pool. Token registration implies that the Pool is registered as well, which
// lets us save gas by not performing the check.
bool tokensRegistered = sharedCash.isNotZero() ||
sharedManaged.isNotZero() ||
(_isTwoTokenPoolTokenRegistered(poolId, tokenA) && _isTwoTokenPoolTokenRegistered(poolId, tokenB));
if (!tokensRegistered) {
// The tokens might not be registered because the Pool itself is not registered. We check this to provide a
// more accurate revert reason.
_ensureRegisteredPool(poolId);
_revert(Errors.TOKEN_NOT_REGISTERED);
}
balanceA = BalanceAllocation.fromSharedToBalanceA(sharedCash, sharedManaged);
balanceB = BalanceAllocation.fromSharedToBalanceB(sharedCash, sharedManaged);
}
/**
* @dev Returns true if `token` is registered in a Two Token Pool.
*
* This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the Two Token specialization setting.
*/
function _isTwoTokenPoolTokenRegistered(bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token) internal view returns (bool) {
TwoTokenPoolTokens storage poolTokens = _twoTokenPoolTokens[poolId];
// The zero address can never be a registered token.
return (token == poolTokens.tokenA || token == poolTokens.tokenB) && token != IERC20(0);
}
/**
* @dev Returns the hash associated with a given token pair.
*/
function _getTwoTokenPairHash(IERC20 tokenA, IERC20 tokenB) private pure returns (bytes32) {
return keccak256(abi.encodePacked(tokenA, tokenB));
}
/**
* @dev Sorts two tokens in ascending order, returning them as a (tokenA, tokenB) tuple.
*/
function _sortTwoTokens(IERC20 tokenX, IERC20 tokenY) private pure returns (IERC20, IERC20) {
return tokenX < tokenY ? (tokenX, tokenY) : (tokenY, tokenX);
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.
// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.
// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;
import "../lib/math/Math.sol";
import "../lib/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol";
import "../lib/helpers/AssetHelpers.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/SafeERC20.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/Address.sol";
import "./interfaces/IWETH.sol";
import "./interfaces/IAsset.sol";
import "./interfaces/IVault.sol";
abstract contract AssetTransfersHandler is AssetHelpers {
using SafeERC20 for IERC20;
using Address for address payable;
/**
* @dev Receives `amount` of `asset` from `sender`. If `fromInternalBalance` is true, it first withdraws as much
* as possible from Internal Balance, then transfers any remaining amount.
*
* If `asset` is ETH, `fromInternalBalance` must be false (as ETH cannot be held as internal balance), and the funds
* will be wrapped into WETH.
*
* WARNING: this function does not check that the contract caller has actually supplied any ETH - it is up to the
* caller of this function to check that this is true to prevent the Vault from using its own ETH (though the Vault
* typically doesn't hold any).
*/
function _receiveAsset(
IAsset asset,
uint256 amount,
address sender,
bool fromInternalBalance
) internal {
if (amount == 0) {
return;
}
if (_isETH(asset)) {
_require(!fromInternalBalance, Errors.INVALID_ETH_INTERNAL_BALANCE);
// The ETH amount to receive is deposited into the WETH contract, which will in turn mint WETH for
// the Vault at a 1:1 ratio.
// A check for this condition is also introduced by the compiler, but this one provides a revert reason.
// Note we're checking for the Vault's total balance, *not* ETH sent in this transaction.
_require(address(this).balance >= amount, Errors.INSUFFICIENT_ETH);
_WETH().deposit{ value: amount }();
} else {
IERC20 token = _asIERC20(asset);
if (fromInternalBalance) {
// We take as many tokens from Internal Balance as possible: any remaining amounts will be transferred.
uint256 deductedBalance = _decreaseInternalBalance(sender, token, amount, true);
// Because `deductedBalance` will be always the lesser of the current internal balance
// and the amount to decrease, it is safe to perform unchecked arithmetic.
amount -= deductedBalance;
}
if (amount > 0) {
token.safeTransferFrom(sender, address(this), amount);
}
}
}
/**
* @dev Sends `amount` of `asset` to `recipient`. If `toInternalBalance` is true, the asset is deposited as Internal
* Balance instead of being transferred.
*
* If `asset` is ETH, `toInternalBalance` must be false (as ETH cannot be held as internal balance), and the funds
* are instead sent directly after unwrapping WETH.
*/
function _sendAsset(
IAsset asset,
uint256 amount,
address payable recipient,
bool toInternalBalance
) internal {
if (amount == 0) {
return;
}
if (_isETH(asset)) {
// Sending ETH is not as involved as receiving it: the only special behavior is it cannot be
// deposited to Internal Balance.
_require(!toInternalBalance, Errors.INVALID_ETH_INTERNAL_BALANCE);
// First, the Vault withdraws deposited ETH from the WETH contract, by burning the same amount of WETH
// from the Vault. This receipt will be handled by the Vault's `receive`.
_WETH().withdraw(amount);
// Then, the withdrawn ETH is sent to the recipient.
recipient.sendValue(amount);
} else {
IERC20 token = _asIERC20(asset);
if (toInternalBalance) {
_increaseInternalBalance(recipient, token, amount);
} else {
token.safeTransfer(recipient, amount);
}
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns excess ETH back to the contract caller, assuming `amountUsed` has been spent. Reverts
* if the caller sent less ETH than `amountUsed`.
*
* Because the caller might not know exactly how much ETH a Vault action will require, they may send extra.
* Note that this excess value is returned *to the contract caller* (msg.sender). If caller and e.g. swap sender are
* not the same (because the caller is a relayer for the sender), then it is up to the caller to manage this
* returned ETH.
*/
function _handleRemainingEth(uint256 amountUsed) internal {
_require(msg.value >= amountUsed, Errors.INSUFFICIENT_ETH);
uint256 excess = msg.value - amountUsed;
if (excess > 0) {
msg.sender.sendValue(excess);
}
}
/**
* @dev Enables the Vault to receive ETH. This is required for it to be able to unwrap WETH, which sends ETH to the
* caller.
*
* Any ETH sent to the Vault outside of the WETH unwrapping mechanism would be forever locked inside the Vault, so
* we prevent that from happening. Other mechanisms used to send ETH to the Vault (such as being the recipient of an
* ETH swap, Pool exit or withdrawal, contract self-destruction, or receiving the block mining reward) will result
* in locked funds, but are not otherwise a security or soundness issue. This check only exists as an attempt to
* prevent user error.
*/
receive() external payable {
_require(msg.sender == address(_WETH()), Errors.ETH_TRANSFER);
}
// This contract uses virtual internal functions instead of inheriting from the modules that implement them (in
// this case UserBalance) in order to decouple it from the rest of the system and enable standalone testing by
// implementing these with mocks.
function _increaseInternalBalance(
address account,
IERC20 token,
uint256 amount
) internal virtual;
function _decreaseInternalBalance(
address account,
IERC20 token,
uint256 amount,
bool capped
) internal virtual returns (uint256);
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.
// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.
// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
import "../openzeppelin/IERC20.sol";
import "../../vault/interfaces/IAsset.sol";
import "../../vault/interfaces/IWETH.sol";
abstract contract AssetHelpers {
// solhint-disable-next-line var-name-mixedcase
IWETH private immutable _weth;
// Sentinel value used to indicate WETH with wrapping/unwrapping semantics. The zero address is a good choice for
// multiple reasons: it is cheap to pass as a calldata argument, it is a known invalid token and non-contract, and
// it is an address Pools cannot register as a token.
address private constant _ETH = address(0);
constructor(IWETH weth) {
_weth = weth;
}
// solhint-disable-next-line func-name-mixedcase
function _WETH() internal view returns (IWETH) {
return _weth;
}
/**
* @dev Returns true if `asset` is the sentinel value that represents ETH.
*/
function _isETH(IAsset asset) internal pure returns (bool) {
return address(asset) == _ETH;
}
/**
* @dev Translates `asset` into an equivalent IERC20 token address. If `asset` represents ETH, it will be translated
* to the WETH contract.
*/
function _translateToIERC20(IAsset asset) internal view returns (IERC20) {
return _isETH(asset) ? _WETH() : _asIERC20(asset);
}
/**
* @dev Same as `_translateToIERC20(IAsset)`, but for an entire array.
*/
function _translateToIERC20(IAsset[] memory assets) internal view returns (IERC20[] memory) {
IERC20[] memory tokens = new IERC20[](assets.length);
for (uint256 i = 0; i < assets.length; ++i) {
tokens[i] = _translateToIERC20(assets[i]);
}
return tokens;
}
/**
* @dev Interprets `asset` as an IERC20 token. This function should only be called on `asset` if `_isETH` previously
* returned false for it, that is, if `asset` is guaranteed not to be the ETH sentinel value.
*/
function _asIERC20(IAsset asset) internal pure returns (IERC20) {
return IERC20(address(asset));
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
import "../helpers/BalancerErrors.sol";
/**
* @dev Collection of functions related to the address type
*/
library Address {
/**
* @dev Returns true if `account` is a contract.
*
* [IMPORTANT]
* ====
* It is unsafe to assume that an address for which this function returns
* false is an externally-owned account (EOA) and not a contract.
*
* Among others, `isContract` will return false for the following
* types of addresses:
*
* - an externally-owned account
* - a contract in construction
* - an address where a contract will be created
* - an address where a contract lived, but was destroyed
* ====
*/
function isContract(address account) internal view returns (bool) {
// This method relies on extcodesize, which returns 0 for contracts in
// construction, since the code is only stored at the end of the
// constructor execution.
uint256 size;
// solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly
assembly {
size := extcodesize(account)
}
return size > 0;
}
/**
* @dev Replacement for Solidity's `transfer`: sends `amount` wei to
* `recipient`, forwarding all available gas and reverting on errors.
*
* https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-1884[EIP1884] increases the gas cost
* of certain opcodes, possibly making contracts go over the 2300 gas limit
* imposed by `transfer`, making them unable to receive funds via
* `transfer`. {sendValue} removes this limitation.
*
* https://diligence.consensys.net/posts/2019/09/stop-using-soliditys-transfer-now/[Learn more].
*
* IMPORTANT: because control is transferred to `recipient`, care must be
* taken to not create reentrancy vulnerabilities. Consider using
* {ReentrancyGuard} or the
* https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/v0.5.11/security-considerations.html#use-the-checks-effects-interactions-pattern[checks-effects-interactions pattern].
*/
function sendValue(address payable recipient, uint256 amount) internal {
_require(address(this).balance >= amount, Errors.ADDRESS_INSUFFICIENT_BALANCE);
// solhint-disable-next-line avoid-low-level-calls, avoid-call-value
(bool success, ) = recipient.call{ value: amount }("");
_require(success, Errors.ADDRESS_CANNOT_SEND_VALUE);
}
}
File 4 of 8: WETH9
// Copyright (C) 2015, 2016, 2017 Dapphub
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.
// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.
// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
pragma solidity ^0.4.18;
contract WETH9 {
string public name = "Wrapped Ether";
string public symbol = "WETH";
uint8 public decimals = 18;
event Approval(address indexed src, address indexed guy, uint wad);
event Transfer(address indexed src, address indexed dst, uint wad);
event Deposit(address indexed dst, uint wad);
event Withdrawal(address indexed src, uint wad);
mapping (address => uint) public balanceOf;
mapping (address => mapping (address => uint)) public allowance;
function() public payable {
deposit();
}
function deposit() public payable {
balanceOf[msg.sender] += msg.value;
Deposit(msg.sender, msg.value);
}
function withdraw(uint wad) public {
require(balanceOf[msg.sender] >= wad);
balanceOf[msg.sender] -= wad;
msg.sender.transfer(wad);
Withdrawal(msg.sender, wad);
}
function totalSupply() public view returns (uint) {
return this.balance;
}
function approve(address guy, uint wad) public returns (bool) {
allowance[msg.sender][guy] = wad;
Approval(msg.sender, guy, wad);
return true;
}
function transfer(address dst, uint wad) public returns (bool) {
return transferFrom(msg.sender, dst, wad);
}
function transferFrom(address src, address dst, uint wad)
public
returns (bool)
{
require(balanceOf[src] >= wad);
if (src != msg.sender && allowance[src][msg.sender] != uint(-1)) {
require(allowance[src][msg.sender] >= wad);
allowance[src][msg.sender] -= wad;
}
balanceOf[src] -= wad;
balanceOf[dst] += wad;
Transfer(src, dst, wad);
return true;
}
}
/*
GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
Version 3, 29 June 2007
Copyright (C) 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc. <http://fsf.org/>
Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies
of this license document, but changing it is not allowed.
Preamble
The GNU General Public License is a free, copyleft license for
software and other kinds of works.
The licenses for most software and other practical works are designed
to take away your freedom to share and change the works. By contrast,
the GNU General Public License is intended to guarantee your freedom to
share and change all versions of a program--to make sure it remains free
software for all its users. We, the Free Software Foundation, use the
GNU General Public License for most of our software; it applies also to
any other work released this way by its authors. You can apply it to
your programs, too.
When we speak of free software, we are referring to freedom, not
price. Our General Public Licenses are designed to make sure that you
have the freedom to distribute copies of free software (and charge for
them if you wish), that you receive source code or can get it if you
want it, that you can change the software or use pieces of it in new
free programs, and that you know you can do these things.
To protect your rights, we need to prevent others from denying you
these rights or asking you to surrender the rights. Therefore, you have
certain responsibilities if you distribute copies of the software, or if
you modify it: responsibilities to respect the freedom of others.
For example, if you distribute copies of such a program, whether
gratis or for a fee, you must pass on to the recipients the same
freedoms that you received. You must make sure that they, too, receive
or can get the source code. And you must show them these terms so they
know their rights.
Developers that use the GNU GPL protect your rights with two steps:
(1) assert copyright on the software, and (2) offer you this License
giving you legal permission to copy, distribute and/or modify it.
For the developers' and authors' protection, the GPL clearly explains
that there is no warranty for this free software. For both users' and
authors' sake, the GPL requires that modified versions be marked as
changed, so that their problems will not be attributed erroneously to
authors of previous versions.
Some devices are designed to deny users access to install or run
modified versions of the software inside them, although the manufacturer
can do so. This is fundamentally incompatible with the aim of
protecting users' freedom to change the software. The systematic
pattern of such abuse occurs in the area of products for individuals to
use, which is precisely where it is most unacceptable. Therefore, we
have designed this version of the GPL to prohibit the practice for those
products. If such problems arise substantially in other domains, we
stand ready to extend this provision to those domains in future versions
of the GPL, as needed to protect the freedom of users.
Finally, every program is threatened constantly by software patents.
States should not allow patents to restrict development and use of
software on general-purpose computers, but in those that do, we wish to
avoid the special danger that patents applied to a free program could
make it effectively proprietary. To prevent this, the GPL assures that
patents cannot be used to render the program non-free.
The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution and
modification follow.
TERMS AND CONDITIONS
0. Definitions.
"This License" refers to version 3 of the GNU General Public License.
"Copyright" also means copyright-like laws that apply to other kinds of
works, such as semiconductor masks.
"The Program" refers to any copyrightable work licensed under this
License. Each licensee is addressed as "you". "Licensees" and
"recipients" may be individuals or organizations.
To "modify" a work means to copy from or adapt all or part of the work
in a fashion requiring copyright permission, other than the making of an
exact copy. The resulting work is called a "modified version" of the
earlier work or a work "based on" the earlier work.
A "covered work" means either the unmodified Program or a work based
on the Program.
To "propagate" a work means to do anything with it that, without
permission, would make you directly or secondarily liable for
infringement under applicable copyright law, except executing it on a
computer or modifying a private copy. Propagation includes copying,
distribution (with or without modification), making available to the
public, and in some countries other activities as well.
To "convey" a work means any kind of propagation that enables other
parties to make or receive copies. Mere interaction with a user through
a computer network, with no transfer of a copy, is not conveying.
An interactive user interface displays "Appropriate Legal Notices"
to the extent that it includes a convenient and prominently visible
feature that (1) displays an appropriate copyright notice, and (2)
tells the user that there is no warranty for the work (except to the
extent that warranties are provided), that licensees may convey the
work under this License, and how to view a copy of this License. If
the interface presents a list of user commands or options, such as a
menu, a prominent item in the list meets this criterion.
1. Source Code.
The "source code" for a work means the preferred form of the work
for making modifications to it. "Object code" means any non-source
form of a work.
A "Standard Interface" means an interface that either is an official
standard defined by a recognized standards body, or, in the case of
interfaces specified for a particular programming language, one that
is widely used among developers working in that language.
The "System Libraries" of an executable work include anything, other
than the work as a whole, that (a) is included in the normal form of
packaging a Major Component, but which is not part of that Major
Component, and (b) serves only to enable use of the work with that
Major Component, or to implement a Standard Interface for which an
implementation is available to the public in source code form. A
"Major Component", in this context, means a major essential component
(kernel, window system, and so on) of the specific operating system
(if any) on which the executable work runs, or a compiler used to
produce the work, or an object code interpreter used to run it.
The "Corresponding Source" for a work in object code form means all
the source code needed to generate, install, and (for an executable
work) run the object code and to modify the work, including scripts to
control those activities. However, it does not include the work's
System Libraries, or general-purpose tools or generally available free
programs which are used unmodified in performing those activities but
which are not part of the work. For example, Corresponding Source
includes interface definition files associated with source files for
the work, and the source code for shared libraries and dynamically
linked subprograms that the work is specifically designed to require,
such as by intimate data communication or control flow between those
subprograms and other parts of the work.
The Corresponding Source need not include anything that users
can regenerate automatically from other parts of the Corresponding
Source.
The Corresponding Source for a work in source code form is that
same work.
2. Basic Permissions.
All rights granted under this License are granted for the term of
copyright on the Program, and are irrevocable provided the stated
conditions are met. This License explicitly affirms your unlimited
permission to run the unmodified Program. The output from running a
covered work is covered by this License only if the output, given its
content, constitutes a covered work. This License acknowledges your
rights of fair use or other equivalent, as provided by copyright law.
You may make, run and propagate covered works that you do not
convey, without conditions so long as your license otherwise remains
in force. You may convey covered works to others for the sole purpose
of having them make modifications exclusively for you, or provide you
with facilities for running those works, provided that you comply with
the terms of this License in conveying all material for which you do
not control copyright. Those thus making or running the covered works
for you must do so exclusively on your behalf, under your direction
and control, on terms that prohibit them from making any copies of
your copyrighted material outside their relationship with you.
Conveying under any other circumstances is permitted solely under
the conditions stated below. Sublicensing is not allowed; section 10
makes it unnecessary.
3. Protecting Users' Legal Rights From Anti-Circumvention Law.
No covered work shall be deemed part of an effective technological
measure under any applicable law fulfilling obligations under article
11 of the WIPO copyright treaty adopted on 20 December 1996, or
similar laws prohibiting or restricting circumvention of such
measures.
When you convey a covered work, you waive any legal power to forbid
circumvention of technological measures to the extent such circumvention
is effected by exercising rights under this License with respect to
the covered work, and you disclaim any intention to limit operation or
modification of the work as a means of enforcing, against the work's
users, your or third parties' legal rights to forbid circumvention of
technological measures.
4. Conveying Verbatim Copies.
You may convey verbatim copies of the Program's source code as you
receive it, in any medium, provided that you conspicuously and
appropriately publish on each copy an appropriate copyright notice;
keep intact all notices stating that this License and any
non-permissive terms added in accord with section 7 apply to the code;
keep intact all notices of the absence of any warranty; and give all
recipients a copy of this License along with the Program.
You may charge any price or no price for each copy that you convey,
and you may offer support or warranty protection for a fee.
5. Conveying Modified Source Versions.
You may convey a work based on the Program, or the modifications to
produce it from the Program, in the form of source code under the
terms of section 4, provided that you also meet all of these conditions:
a) The work must carry prominent notices stating that you modified
it, and giving a relevant date.
b) The work must carry prominent notices stating that it is
released under this License and any conditions added under section
7. This requirement modifies the requirement in section 4 to
"keep intact all notices".
c) You must license the entire work, as a whole, under this
License to anyone who comes into possession of a copy. This
License will therefore apply, along with any applicable section 7
additional terms, to the whole of the work, and all its parts,
regardless of how they are packaged. This License gives no
permission to license the work in any other way, but it does not
invalidate such permission if you have separately received it.
d) If the work has interactive user interfaces, each must display
Appropriate Legal Notices; however, if the Program has interactive
interfaces that do not display Appropriate Legal Notices, your
work need not make them do so.
A compilation of a covered work with other separate and independent
works, which are not by their nature extensions of the covered work,
and which are not combined with it such as to form a larger program,
in or on a volume of a storage or distribution medium, is called an
"aggregate" if the compilation and its resulting copyright are not
used to limit the access or legal rights of the compilation's users
beyond what the individual works permit. Inclusion of a covered work
in an aggregate does not cause this License to apply to the other
parts of the aggregate.
6. Conveying Non-Source Forms.
You may convey a covered work in object code form under the terms
of sections 4 and 5, provided that you also convey the
machine-readable Corresponding Source under the terms of this License,
in one of these ways:
a) Convey the object code in, or embodied in, a physical product
(including a physical distribution medium), accompanied by the
Corresponding Source fixed on a durable physical medium
customarily used for software interchange.
b) Convey the object code in, or embodied in, a physical product
(including a physical distribution medium), accompanied by a
written offer, valid for at least three years and valid for as
long as you offer spare parts or customer support for that product
model, to give anyone who possesses the object code either (1) a
copy of the Corresponding Source for all the software in the
product that is covered by this License, on a durable physical
medium customarily used for software interchange, for a price no
more than your reasonable cost of physically performing this
conveying of source, or (2) access to copy the
Corresponding Source from a network server at no charge.
c) Convey individual copies of the object code with a copy of the
written offer to provide the Corresponding Source. This
alternative is allowed only occasionally and noncommercially, and
only if you received the object code with such an offer, in accord
with subsection 6b.
d) Convey the object code by offering access from a designated
place (gratis or for a charge), and offer equivalent access to the
Corresponding Source in the same way through the same place at no
further charge. You need not require recipients to copy the
Corresponding Source along with the object code. If the place to
copy the object code is a network server, the Corresponding Source
may be on a different server (operated by you or a third party)
that supports equivalent copying facilities, provided you maintain
clear directions next to the object code saying where to find the
Corresponding Source. Regardless of what server hosts the
Corresponding Source, you remain obligated to ensure that it is
available for as long as needed to satisfy these requirements.
e) Convey the object code using peer-to-peer transmission, provided
you inform other peers where the object code and Corresponding
Source of the work are being offered to the general public at no
charge under subsection 6d.
A separable portion of the object code, whose source code is excluded
from the Corresponding Source as a System Library, need not be
included in conveying the object code work.
A "User Product" is either (1) a "consumer product", which means any
tangible personal property which is normally used for personal, family,
or household purposes, or (2) anything designed or sold for incorporation
into a dwelling. In determining whether a product is a consumer product,
doubtful cases shall be resolved in favor of coverage. For a particular
product received by a particular user, "normally used" refers to a
typical or common use of that class of product, regardless of the status
of the particular user or of the way in which the particular user
actually uses, or expects or is expected to use, the product. A product
is a consumer product regardless of whether the product has substantial
commercial, industrial or non-consumer uses, unless such uses represent
the only significant mode of use of the product.
"Installation Information" for a User Product means any methods,
procedures, authorization keys, or other information required to install
and execute modified versions of a covered work in that User Product from
a modified version of its Corresponding Source. The information must
suffice to ensure that the continued functioning of the modified object
code is in no case prevented or interfered with solely because
modification has been made.
If you convey an object code work under this section in, or with, or
specifically for use in, a User Product, and the conveying occurs as
part of a transaction in which the right of possession and use of the
User Product is transferred to the recipient in perpetuity or for a
fixed term (regardless of how the transaction is characterized), the
Corresponding Source conveyed under this section must be accompanied
by the Installation Information. But this requirement does not apply
if neither you nor any third party retains the ability to install
modified object code on the User Product (for example, the work has
been installed in ROM).
The requirement to provide Installation Information does not include a
requirement to continue to provide support service, warranty, or updates
for a work that has been modified or installed by the recipient, or for
the User Product in which it has been modified or installed. Access to a
network may be denied when the modification itself materially and
adversely affects the operation of the network or violates the rules and
protocols for communication across the network.
Corresponding Source conveyed, and Installation Information provided,
in accord with this section must be in a format that is publicly
documented (and with an implementation available to the public in
source code form), and must require no special password or key for
unpacking, reading or copying.
7. Additional Terms.
"Additional permissions" are terms that supplement the terms of this
License by making exceptions from one or more of its conditions.
Additional permissions that are applicable to the entire Program shall
be treated as though they were included in this License, to the extent
that they are valid under applicable law. If additional permissions
apply only to part of the Program, that part may be used separately
under those permissions, but the entire Program remains governed by
this License without regard to the additional permissions.
When you convey a copy of a covered work, you may at your option
remove any additional permissions from that copy, or from any part of
it. (Additional permissions may be written to require their own
removal in certain cases when you modify the work.) You may place
additional permissions on material, added by you to a covered work,
for which you have or can give appropriate copyright permission.
Notwithstanding any other provision of this License, for material you
add to a covered work, you may (if authorized by the copyright holders of
that material) supplement the terms of this License with terms:
a) Disclaiming warranty or limiting liability differently from the
terms of sections 15 and 16 of this License; or
b) Requiring preservation of specified reasonable legal notices or
author attributions in that material or in the Appropriate Legal
Notices displayed by works containing it; or
c) Prohibiting misrepresentation of the origin of that material, or
requiring that modified versions of such material be marked in
reasonable ways as different from the original version; or
d) Limiting the use for publicity purposes of names of licensors or
authors of the material; or
e) Declining to grant rights under trademark law for use of some
trade names, trademarks, or service marks; or
f) Requiring indemnification of licensors and authors of that
material by anyone who conveys the material (or modified versions of
it) with contractual assumptions of liability to the recipient, for
any liability that these contractual assumptions directly impose on
those licensors and authors.
All other non-permissive additional terms are considered "further
restrictions" within the meaning of section 10. If the Program as you
received it, or any part of it, contains a notice stating that it is
governed by this License along with a term that is a further
restriction, you may remove that term. If a license document contains
a further restriction but permits relicensing or conveying under this
License, you may add to a covered work material governed by the terms
of that license document, provided that the further restriction does
not survive such relicensing or conveying.
If you add terms to a covered work in accord with this section, you
must place, in the relevant source files, a statement of the
additional terms that apply to those files, or a notice indicating
where to find the applicable terms.
Additional terms, permissive or non-permissive, may be stated in the
form of a separately written license, or stated as exceptions;
the above requirements apply either way.
8. Termination.
You may not propagate or modify a covered work except as expressly
provided under this License. Any attempt otherwise to propagate or
modify it is void, and will automatically terminate your rights under
this License (including any patent licenses granted under the third
paragraph of section 11).
However, if you cease all violation of this License, then your
license from a particular copyright holder is reinstated (a)
provisionally, unless and until the copyright holder explicitly and
finally terminates your license, and (b) permanently, if the copyright
holder fails to notify you of the violation by some reasonable means
prior to 60 days after the cessation.
Moreover, your license from a particular copyright holder is
reinstated permanently if the copyright holder notifies you of the
violation by some reasonable means, this is the first time you have
received notice of violation of this License (for any work) from that
copyright holder, and you cure the violation prior to 30 days after
your receipt of the notice.
Termination of your rights under this section does not terminate the
licenses of parties who have received copies or rights from you under
this License. If your rights have been terminated and not permanently
reinstated, you do not qualify to receive new licenses for the same
material under section 10.
9. Acceptance Not Required for Having Copies.
You are not required to accept this License in order to receive or
run a copy of the Program. Ancillary propagation of a covered work
occurring solely as a consequence of using peer-to-peer transmission
to receive a copy likewise does not require acceptance. However,
nothing other than this License grants you permission to propagate or
modify any covered work. These actions infringe copyright if you do
not accept this License. Therefore, by modifying or propagating a
covered work, you indicate your acceptance of this License to do so.
10. Automatic Licensing of Downstream Recipients.
Each time you convey a covered work, the recipient automatically
receives a license from the original licensors, to run, modify and
propagate that work, subject to this License. You are not responsible
for enforcing compliance by third parties with this License.
An "entity transaction" is a transaction transferring control of an
organization, or substantially all assets of one, or subdividing an
organization, or merging organizations. If propagation of a covered
work results from an entity transaction, each party to that
transaction who receives a copy of the work also receives whatever
licenses to the work the party's predecessor in interest had or could
give under the previous paragraph, plus a right to possession of the
Corresponding Source of the work from the predecessor in interest, if
the predecessor has it or can get it with reasonable efforts.
You may not impose any further restrictions on the exercise of the
rights granted or affirmed under this License. For example, you may
not impose a license fee, royalty, or other charge for exercise of
rights granted under this License, and you may not initiate litigation
(including a cross-claim or counterclaim in a lawsuit) alleging that
any patent claim is infringed by making, using, selling, offering for
sale, or importing the Program or any portion of it.
11. Patents.
A "contributor" is a copyright holder who authorizes use under this
License of the Program or a work on which the Program is based. The
work thus licensed is called the contributor's "contributor version".
A contributor's "essential patent claims" are all patent claims
owned or controlled by the contributor, whether already acquired or
hereafter acquired, that would be infringed by some manner, permitted
by this License, of making, using, or selling its contributor version,
but do not include claims that would be infringed only as a
consequence of further modification of the contributor version. For
purposes of this definition, "control" includes the right to grant
patent sublicenses in a manner consistent with the requirements of
this License.
Each contributor grants you a non-exclusive, worldwide, royalty-free
patent license under the contributor's essential patent claims, to
make, use, sell, offer for sale, import and otherwise run, modify and
propagate the contents of its contributor version.
In the following three paragraphs, a "patent license" is any express
agreement or commitment, however denominated, not to enforce a patent
(such as an express permission to practice a patent or covenant not to
sue for patent infringement). To "grant" such a patent license to a
party means to make such an agreement or commitment not to enforce a
patent against the party.
If you convey a covered work, knowingly relying on a patent license,
and the Corresponding Source of the work is not available for anyone
to copy, free of charge and under the terms of this License, through a
publicly available network server or other readily accessible means,
then you must either (1) cause the Corresponding Source to be so
available, or (2) arrange to deprive yourself of the benefit of the
patent license for this particular work, or (3) arrange, in a manner
consistent with the requirements of this License, to extend the patent
license to downstream recipients. "Knowingly relying" means you have
actual knowledge that, but for the patent license, your conveying the
covered work in a country, or your recipient's use of the covered work
in a country, would infringe one or more identifiable patents in that
country that you have reason to believe are valid.
If, pursuant to or in connection with a single transaction or
arrangement, you convey, or propagate by procuring conveyance of, a
covered work, and grant a patent license to some of the parties
receiving the covered work authorizing them to use, propagate, modify
or convey a specific copy of the covered work, then the patent license
you grant is automatically extended to all recipients of the covered
work and works based on it.
A patent license is "discriminatory" if it does not include within
the scope of its coverage, prohibits the exercise of, or is
conditioned on the non-exercise of one or more of the rights that are
specifically granted under this License. You may not convey a covered
work if you are a party to an arrangement with a third party that is
in the business of distributing software, under which you make payment
to the third party based on the extent of your activity of conveying
the work, and under which the third party grants, to any of the
parties who would receive the covered work from you, a discriminatory
patent license (a) in connection with copies of the covered work
conveyed by you (or copies made from those copies), or (b) primarily
for and in connection with specific products or compilations that
contain the covered work, unless you entered into that arrangement,
or that patent license was granted, prior to 28 March 2007.
Nothing in this License shall be construed as excluding or limiting
any implied license or other defenses to infringement that may
otherwise be available to you under applicable patent law.
12. No Surrender of Others' Freedom.
If conditions are imposed on you (whether by court order, agreement or
otherwise) that contradict the conditions of this License, they do not
excuse you from the conditions of this License. If you cannot convey a
covered work so as to satisfy simultaneously your obligations under this
License and any other pertinent obligations, then as a consequence you may
not convey it at all. For example, if you agree to terms that obligate you
to collect a royalty for further conveying from those to whom you convey
the Program, the only way you could satisfy both those terms and this
License would be to refrain entirely from conveying the Program.
13. Use with the GNU Affero General Public License.
Notwithstanding any other provision of this License, you have
permission to link or combine any covered work with a work licensed
under version 3 of the GNU Affero General Public License into a single
combined work, and to convey the resulting work. The terms of this
License will continue to apply to the part which is the covered work,
but the special requirements of the GNU Affero General Public License,
section 13, concerning interaction through a network will apply to the
combination as such.
14. Revised Versions of this License.
The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/or new versions of
the GNU General Public License from time to time. Such new versions will
be similar in spirit to the present version, but may differ in detail to
address new problems or concerns.
Each version is given a distinguishing version number. If the
Program specifies that a certain numbered version of the GNU General
Public License "or any later version" applies to it, you have the
option of following the terms and conditions either of that numbered
version or of any later version published by the Free Software
Foundation. If the Program does not specify a version number of the
GNU General Public License, you may choose any version ever published
by the Free Software Foundation.
If the Program specifies that a proxy can decide which future
versions of the GNU General Public License can be used, that proxy's
public statement of acceptance of a version permanently authorizes you
to choose that version for the Program.
Later license versions may give you additional or different
permissions. However, no additional obligations are imposed on any
author or copyright holder as a result of your choosing to follow a
later version.
15. Disclaimer of Warranty.
THERE IS NO WARRANTY FOR THE PROGRAM, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY
APPLICABLE LAW. EXCEPT WHEN OTHERWISE STATED IN WRITING THE COPYRIGHT
HOLDERS AND/OR OTHER PARTIES PROVIDE THE PROGRAM "AS IS" WITHOUT WARRANTY
OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO,
THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE RISK AS TO THE QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF THE PROGRAM
IS WITH YOU. SHOULD THE PROGRAM PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME THE COST OF
ALL NECESSARY SERVICING, REPAIR OR CORRECTION.
16. Limitation of Liability.
IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE LAW OR AGREED TO IN WRITING
WILL ANY COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER PARTY WHO MODIFIES AND/OR CONVEYS
THE PROGRAM AS PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR DAMAGES, INCLUDING ANY
GENERAL, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES ARISING OUT OF THE
USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE PROGRAM (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO LOSS OF
DATA OR DATA BEING RENDERED INACCURATE OR LOSSES SUSTAINED BY YOU OR THIRD
PARTIES OR A FAILURE OF THE PROGRAM TO OPERATE WITH ANY OTHER PROGRAMS),
EVEN IF SUCH HOLDER OR OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
SUCH DAMAGES.
17. Interpretation of Sections 15 and 16.
If the disclaimer of warranty and limitation of liability provided
above cannot be given local legal effect according to their terms,
reviewing courts shall apply local law that most closely approximates
an absolute waiver of all civil liability in connection with the
Program, unless a warranty or assumption of liability accompanies a
copy of the Program in return for a fee.
END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS
How to Apply These Terms to Your New Programs
If you develop a new program, and you want it to be of the greatest
possible use to the public, the best way to achieve this is to make it
free software which everyone can redistribute and change under these terms.
To do so, attach the following notices to the program. It is safest
to attach them to the start of each source file to most effectively
state the exclusion of warranty; and each file should have at least
the "copyright" line and a pointer to where the full notice is found.
<one line to give the program's name and a brief idea of what it does.>
Copyright (C) <year> <name of author>
This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
(at your option) any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
Also add information on how to contact you by electronic and paper mail.
If the program does terminal interaction, make it output a short
notice like this when it starts in an interactive mode:
<program> Copyright (C) <year> <name of author>
This program comes with ABSOLUTELY NO WARRANTY; for details type `show w'.
This is free software, and you are welcome to redistribute it
under certain conditions; type `show c' for details.
The hypothetical commands `show w' and `show c' should show the appropriate
parts of the General Public License. Of course, your program's commands
might be different; for a GUI interface, you would use an "about box".
You should also get your employer (if you work as a programmer) or school,
if any, to sign a "copyright disclaimer" for the program, if necessary.
For more information on this, and how to apply and follow the GNU GPL, see
<http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
The GNU General Public License does not permit incorporating your program
into proprietary programs. If your program is a subroutine library, you
may consider it more useful to permit linking proprietary applications with
the library. If this is what you want to do, use the GNU Lesser General
Public License instead of this License. But first, please read
<http://www.gnu.org/philosophy/why-not-lgpl.html>.
*/File 5 of 8: FiatTokenV2_1
// File: @openzeppelin/contracts/math/SafeMath.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.6.0;
/**
* @dev Wrappers over Solidity's arithmetic operations with added overflow
* checks.
*
* Arithmetic operations in Solidity wrap on overflow. This can easily result
* in bugs, because programmers usually assume that an overflow raises an
* error, which is the standard behavior in high level programming languages.
* `SafeMath` restores this intuition by reverting the transaction when an
* operation overflows.
*
* Using this library instead of the unchecked operations eliminates an entire
* class of bugs, so it's recommended to use it always.
*/
library SafeMath {
/**
* @dev Returns the addition of two unsigned integers, reverting on
* overflow.
*
* Counterpart to Solidity's `+` operator.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - Addition cannot overflow.
*/
function add(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
uint256 c = a + b;
require(c >= a, "SafeMath: addition overflow");
return c;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the subtraction of two unsigned integers, reverting on
* overflow (when the result is negative).
*
* Counterpart to Solidity's `-` operator.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - Subtraction cannot overflow.
*/
function sub(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
return sub(a, b, "SafeMath: subtraction overflow");
}
/**
* @dev Returns the subtraction of two unsigned integers, reverting with custom message on
* overflow (when the result is negative).
*
* Counterpart to Solidity's `-` operator.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - Subtraction cannot overflow.
*/
function sub(
uint256 a,
uint256 b,
string memory errorMessage
) internal pure returns (uint256) {
require(b <= a, errorMessage);
uint256 c = a - b;
return c;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the multiplication of two unsigned integers, reverting on
* overflow.
*
* Counterpart to Solidity's `*` operator.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - Multiplication cannot overflow.
*/
function mul(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
// Gas optimization: this is cheaper than requiring 'a' not being zero, but the
// benefit is lost if 'b' is also tested.
// See: https://github.com/OpenZeppelin/openzeppelin-contracts/pull/522
if (a == 0) {
return 0;
}
uint256 c = a * b;
require(c / a == b, "SafeMath: multiplication overflow");
return c;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the integer division of two unsigned integers. Reverts on
* division by zero. The result is rounded towards zero.
*
* Counterpart to Solidity's `/` operator. Note: this function uses a
* `revert` opcode (which leaves remaining gas untouched) while Solidity
* uses an invalid opcode to revert (consuming all remaining gas).
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The divisor cannot be zero.
*/
function div(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
return div(a, b, "SafeMath: division by zero");
}
/**
* @dev Returns the integer division of two unsigned integers. Reverts with custom message on
* division by zero. The result is rounded towards zero.
*
* Counterpart to Solidity's `/` operator. Note: this function uses a
* `revert` opcode (which leaves remaining gas untouched) while Solidity
* uses an invalid opcode to revert (consuming all remaining gas).
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The divisor cannot be zero.
*/
function div(
uint256 a,
uint256 b,
string memory errorMessage
) internal pure returns (uint256) {
require(b > 0, errorMessage);
uint256 c = a / b;
// assert(a == b * c + a % b); // There is no case in which this doesn't hold
return c;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the remainder of dividing two unsigned integers. (unsigned integer modulo),
* Reverts when dividing by zero.
*
* Counterpart to Solidity's `%` operator. This function uses a `revert`
* opcode (which leaves remaining gas untouched) while Solidity uses an
* invalid opcode to revert (consuming all remaining gas).
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The divisor cannot be zero.
*/
function mod(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
return mod(a, b, "SafeMath: modulo by zero");
}
/**
* @dev Returns the remainder of dividing two unsigned integers. (unsigned integer modulo),
* Reverts with custom message when dividing by zero.
*
* Counterpart to Solidity's `%` operator. This function uses a `revert`
* opcode (which leaves remaining gas untouched) while Solidity uses an
* invalid opcode to revert (consuming all remaining gas).
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The divisor cannot be zero.
*/
function mod(
uint256 a,
uint256 b,
string memory errorMessage
) internal pure returns (uint256) {
require(b != 0, errorMessage);
return a % b;
}
}
// File: @openzeppelin/contracts/token/ERC20/IERC20.sol
pragma solidity ^0.6.0;
/**
* @dev Interface of the ERC20 standard as defined in the EIP.
*/
interface IERC20 {
/**
* @dev Returns the amount of tokens in existence.
*/
function totalSupply() external view returns (uint256);
/**
* @dev Returns the amount of tokens owned by `account`.
*/
function balanceOf(address account) external view returns (uint256);
/**
* @dev Moves `amount` tokens from the caller's account to `recipient`.
*
* Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function transfer(address recipient, uint256 amount)
external
returns (bool);
/**
* @dev Returns the remaining number of tokens that `spender` will be
* allowed to spend on behalf of `owner` through {transferFrom}. This is
* zero by default.
*
* This value changes when {approve} or {transferFrom} are called.
*/
function allowance(address owner, address spender)
external
view
returns (uint256);
/**
* @dev Sets `amount` as the allowance of `spender` over the caller's tokens.
*
* Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded.
*
* IMPORTANT: Beware that changing an allowance with this method brings the risk
* that someone may use both the old and the new allowance by unfortunate
* transaction ordering. One possible solution to mitigate this race
* condition is to first reduce the spender's allowance to 0 and set the
* desired value afterwards:
* https://github.com/ethereum/EIPs/issues/20#issuecomment-263524729
*
* Emits an {Approval} event.
*/
function approve(address spender, uint256 amount) external returns (bool);
/**
* @dev Moves `amount` tokens from `sender` to `recipient` using the
* allowance mechanism. `amount` is then deducted from the caller's
* allowance.
*
* Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function transferFrom(
address sender,
address recipient,
uint256 amount
) external returns (bool);
/**
* @dev Emitted when `value` tokens are moved from one account (`from`) to
* another (`to`).
*
* Note that `value` may be zero.
*/
event Transfer(address indexed from, address indexed to, uint256 value);
/**
* @dev Emitted when the allowance of a `spender` for an `owner` is set by
* a call to {approve}. `value` is the new allowance.
*/
event Approval(
address indexed owner,
address indexed spender,
uint256 value
);
}
// File: contracts/v1/AbstractFiatTokenV1.sol
/**
* Copyright (c) 2018-2020 CENTRE SECZ
*
* Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy
* of this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal
* in the Software without restriction, including without limitation the rights
* to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell
* copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is
* furnished to do so, subject to the following conditions:
*
* The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in
* copies or substantial portions of the Software.
*
* THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR
* IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY,
* FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
* AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER
* LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM,
* OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE
* SOFTWARE.
*/
pragma solidity 0.6.12;
abstract contract AbstractFiatTokenV1 is IERC20 {
function _approve(
address owner,
address spender,
uint256 value
) internal virtual;
function _transfer(
address from,
address to,
uint256 value
) internal virtual;
}
// File: contracts/v1/Ownable.sol
/**
* Copyright (c) 2018 zOS Global Limited.
* Copyright (c) 2018-2020 CENTRE SECZ
*
* Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy
* of this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal
* in the Software without restriction, including without limitation the rights
* to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell
* copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is
* furnished to do so, subject to the following conditions:
*
* The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in
* copies or substantial portions of the Software.
*
* THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR
* IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY,
* FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
* AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER
* LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM,
* OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE
* SOFTWARE.
*/
pragma solidity 0.6.12;
/**
* @notice The Ownable contract has an owner address, and provides basic
* authorization control functions
* @dev Forked from https://github.com/OpenZeppelin/openzeppelin-labs/blob/3887ab77b8adafba4a26ace002f3a684c1a3388b/upgradeability_ownership/contracts/ownership/Ownable.sol
* Modifications:
* 1. Consolidate OwnableStorage into this contract (7/13/18)
* 2. Reformat, conform to Solidity 0.6 syntax, and add error messages (5/13/20)
* 3. Make public functions external (5/27/20)
*/
contract Ownable {
// Owner of the contract
address private _owner;
/**
* @dev Event to show ownership has been transferred
* @param previousOwner representing the address of the previous owner
* @param newOwner representing the address of the new owner
*/
event OwnershipTransferred(address previousOwner, address newOwner);
/**
* @dev The constructor sets the original owner of the contract to the sender account.
*/
constructor() public {
setOwner(msg.sender);
}
/**
* @dev Tells the address of the owner
* @return the address of the owner
*/
function owner() external view returns (address) {
return _owner;
}
/**
* @dev Sets a new owner address
*/
function setOwner(address newOwner) internal {
_owner = newOwner;
}
/**
* @dev Throws if called by any account other than the owner.
*/
modifier onlyOwner() {
require(msg.sender == _owner, "Ownable: caller is not the owner");
_;
}
/**
* @dev Allows the current owner to transfer control of the contract to a newOwner.
* @param newOwner The address to transfer ownership to.
*/
function transferOwnership(address newOwner) external onlyOwner {
require(
newOwner != address(0),
"Ownable: new owner is the zero address"
);
emit OwnershipTransferred(_owner, newOwner);
setOwner(newOwner);
}
}
// File: contracts/v1/Pausable.sol
/**
* Copyright (c) 2016 Smart Contract Solutions, Inc.
* Copyright (c) 2018-2020 CENTRE SECZ0
*
* Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy
* of this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal
* in the Software without restriction, including without limitation the rights
* to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell
* copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is
* furnished to do so, subject to the following conditions:
*
* The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in
* copies or substantial portions of the Software.
*
* THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR
* IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY,
* FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
* AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER
* LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM,
* OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE
* SOFTWARE.
*/
pragma solidity 0.6.12;
/**
* @notice Base contract which allows children to implement an emergency stop
* mechanism
* @dev Forked from https://github.com/OpenZeppelin/openzeppelin-contracts/blob/feb665136c0dae9912e08397c1a21c4af3651ef3/contracts/lifecycle/Pausable.sol
* Modifications:
* 1. Added pauser role, switched pause/unpause to be onlyPauser (6/14/2018)
* 2. Removed whenNotPause/whenPaused from pause/unpause (6/14/2018)
* 3. Removed whenPaused (6/14/2018)
* 4. Switches ownable library to use ZeppelinOS (7/12/18)
* 5. Remove constructor (7/13/18)
* 6. Reformat, conform to Solidity 0.6 syntax and add error messages (5/13/20)
* 7. Make public functions external (5/27/20)
*/
contract Pausable is Ownable {
event Pause();
event Unpause();
event PauserChanged(address indexed newAddress);
address public pauser;
bool public paused = false;
/**
* @dev Modifier to make a function callable only when the contract is not paused.
*/
modifier whenNotPaused() {
require(!paused, "Pausable: paused");
_;
}
/**
* @dev throws if called by any account other than the pauser
*/
modifier onlyPauser() {
require(msg.sender == pauser, "Pausable: caller is not the pauser");
_;
}
/**
* @dev called by the owner to pause, triggers stopped state
*/
function pause() external onlyPauser {
paused = true;
emit Pause();
}
/**
* @dev called by the owner to unpause, returns to normal state
*/
function unpause() external onlyPauser {
paused = false;
emit Unpause();
}
/**
* @dev update the pauser role
*/
function updatePauser(address _newPauser) external onlyOwner {
require(
_newPauser != address(0),
"Pausable: new pauser is the zero address"
);
pauser = _newPauser;
emit PauserChanged(pauser);
}
}
// File: contracts/v1/Blacklistable.sol
/**
* Copyright (c) 2018-2020 CENTRE SECZ
*
* Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy
* of this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal
* in the Software without restriction, including without limitation the rights
* to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell
* copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is
* furnished to do so, subject to the following conditions:
*
* The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in
* copies or substantial portions of the Software.
*
* THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR
* IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY,
* FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
* AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER
* LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM,
* OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE
* SOFTWARE.
*/
pragma solidity 0.6.12;
/**
* @title Blacklistable Token
* @dev Allows accounts to be blacklisted by a "blacklister" role
*/
contract Blacklistable is Ownable {
address public blacklister;
mapping(address => bool) internal blacklisted;
event Blacklisted(address indexed _account);
event UnBlacklisted(address indexed _account);
event BlacklisterChanged(address indexed newBlacklister);
/**
* @dev Throws if called by any account other than the blacklister
*/
modifier onlyBlacklister() {
require(
msg.sender == blacklister,
"Blacklistable: caller is not the blacklister"
);
_;
}
/**
* @dev Throws if argument account is blacklisted
* @param _account The address to check
*/
modifier notBlacklisted(address _account) {
require(
!blacklisted[_account],
"Blacklistable: account is blacklisted"
);
_;
}
/**
* @dev Checks if account is blacklisted
* @param _account The address to check
*/
function isBlacklisted(address _account) external view returns (bool) {
return blacklisted[_account];
}
/**
* @dev Adds account to blacklist
* @param _account The address to blacklist
*/
function blacklist(address _account) external onlyBlacklister {
blacklisted[_account] = true;
emit Blacklisted(_account);
}
/**
* @dev Removes account from blacklist
* @param _account The address to remove from the blacklist
*/
function unBlacklist(address _account) external onlyBlacklister {
blacklisted[_account] = false;
emit UnBlacklisted(_account);
}
function updateBlacklister(address _newBlacklister) external onlyOwner {
require(
_newBlacklister != address(0),
"Blacklistable: new blacklister is the zero address"
);
blacklister = _newBlacklister;
emit BlacklisterChanged(blacklister);
}
}
// File: contracts/v1/FiatTokenV1.sol
/**
*
* Copyright (c) 2018-2020 CENTRE SECZ
*
* Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy
* of this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal
* in the Software without restriction, including without limitation the rights
* to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell
* copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is
* furnished to do so, subject to the following conditions:
*
* The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in
* copies or substantial portions of the Software.
*
* THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR
* IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY,
* FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
* AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER
* LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM,
* OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE
* SOFTWARE.
*/
pragma solidity 0.6.12;
/**
* @title FiatToken
* @dev ERC20 Token backed by fiat reserves
*/
contract FiatTokenV1 is AbstractFiatTokenV1, Ownable, Pausable, Blacklistable {
using SafeMath for uint256;
string public name;
string public symbol;
uint8 public decimals;
string public currency;
address public masterMinter;
bool internal initialized;
mapping(address => uint256) internal balances;
mapping(address => mapping(address => uint256)) internal allowed;
uint256 internal totalSupply_ = 0;
mapping(address => bool) internal minters;
mapping(address => uint256) internal minterAllowed;
event Mint(address indexed minter, address indexed to, uint256 amount);
event Burn(address indexed burner, uint256 amount);
event MinterConfigured(address indexed minter, uint256 minterAllowedAmount);
event MinterRemoved(address indexed oldMinter);
event MasterMinterChanged(address indexed newMasterMinter);
function initialize(
string memory tokenName,
string memory tokenSymbol,
string memory tokenCurrency,
uint8 tokenDecimals,
address newMasterMinter,
address newPauser,
address newBlacklister,
address newOwner
) public {
require(!initialized, "FiatToken: contract is already initialized");
require(
newMasterMinter != address(0),
"FiatToken: new masterMinter is the zero address"
);
require(
newPauser != address(0),
"FiatToken: new pauser is the zero address"
);
require(
newBlacklister != address(0),
"FiatToken: new blacklister is the zero address"
);
require(
newOwner != address(0),
"FiatToken: new owner is the zero address"
);
name = tokenName;
symbol = tokenSymbol;
currency = tokenCurrency;
decimals = tokenDecimals;
masterMinter = newMasterMinter;
pauser = newPauser;
blacklister = newBlacklister;
setOwner(newOwner);
initialized = true;
}
/**
* @dev Throws if called by any account other than a minter
*/
modifier onlyMinters() {
require(minters[msg.sender], "FiatToken: caller is not a minter");
_;
}
/**
* @dev Function to mint tokens
* @param _to The address that will receive the minted tokens.
* @param _amount The amount of tokens to mint. Must be less than or equal
* to the minterAllowance of the caller.
* @return A boolean that indicates if the operation was successful.
*/
function mint(address _to, uint256 _amount)
external
whenNotPaused
onlyMinters
notBlacklisted(msg.sender)
notBlacklisted(_to)
returns (bool)
{
require(_to != address(0), "FiatToken: mint to the zero address");
require(_amount > 0, "FiatToken: mint amount not greater than 0");
uint256 mintingAllowedAmount = minterAllowed[msg.sender];
require(
_amount <= mintingAllowedAmount,
"FiatToken: mint amount exceeds minterAllowance"
);
totalSupply_ = totalSupply_.add(_amount);
balances[_to] = balances[_to].add(_amount);
minterAllowed[msg.sender] = mintingAllowedAmount.sub(_amount);
emit Mint(msg.sender, _to, _amount);
emit Transfer(address(0), _to, _amount);
return true;
}
/**
* @dev Throws if called by any account other than the masterMinter
*/
modifier onlyMasterMinter() {
require(
msg.sender == masterMinter,
"FiatToken: caller is not the masterMinter"
);
_;
}
/**
* @dev Get minter allowance for an account
* @param minter The address of the minter
*/
function minterAllowance(address minter) external view returns (uint256) {
return minterAllowed[minter];
}
/**
* @dev Checks if account is a minter
* @param account The address to check
*/
function isMinter(address account) external view returns (bool) {
return minters[account];
}
/**
* @notice Amount of remaining tokens spender is allowed to transfer on
* behalf of the token owner
* @param owner Token owner's address
* @param spender Spender's address
* @return Allowance amount
*/
function allowance(address owner, address spender)
external
override
view
returns (uint256)
{
return allowed[owner][spender];
}
/**
* @dev Get totalSupply of token
*/
function totalSupply() external override view returns (uint256) {
return totalSupply_;
}
/**
* @dev Get token balance of an account
* @param account address The account
*/
function balanceOf(address account)
external
override
view
returns (uint256)
{
return balances[account];
}
/**
* @notice Set spender's allowance over the caller's tokens to be a given
* value.
* @param spender Spender's address
* @param value Allowance amount
* @return True if successful
*/
function approve(address spender, uint256 value)
external
override
whenNotPaused
notBlacklisted(msg.sender)
notBlacklisted(spender)
returns (bool)
{
_approve(msg.sender, spender, value);
return true;
}
/**
* @dev Internal function to set allowance
* @param owner Token owner's address
* @param spender Spender's address
* @param value Allowance amount
*/
function _approve(
address owner,
address spender,
uint256 value
) internal override {
require(owner != address(0), "ERC20: approve from the zero address");
require(spender != address(0), "ERC20: approve to the zero address");
allowed[owner][spender] = value;
emit Approval(owner, spender, value);
}
/**
* @notice Transfer tokens by spending allowance
* @param from Payer's address
* @param to Payee's address
* @param value Transfer amount
* @return True if successful
*/
function transferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 value
)
external
override
whenNotPaused
notBlacklisted(msg.sender)
notBlacklisted(from)
notBlacklisted(to)
returns (bool)
{
require(
value <= allowed[from][msg.sender],
"ERC20: transfer amount exceeds allowance"
);
_transfer(from, to, value);
allowed[from][msg.sender] = allowed[from][msg.sender].sub(value);
return true;
}
/**
* @notice Transfer tokens from the caller
* @param to Payee's address
* @param value Transfer amount
* @return True if successful
*/
function transfer(address to, uint256 value)
external
override
whenNotPaused
notBlacklisted(msg.sender)
notBlacklisted(to)
returns (bool)
{
_transfer(msg.sender, to, value);
return true;
}
/**
* @notice Internal function to process transfers
* @param from Payer's address
* @param to Payee's address
* @param value Transfer amount
*/
function _transfer(
address from,
address to,
uint256 value
) internal override {
require(from != address(0), "ERC20: transfer from the zero address");
require(to != address(0), "ERC20: transfer to the zero address");
require(
value <= balances[from],
"ERC20: transfer amount exceeds balance"
);
balances[from] = balances[from].sub(value);
balances[to] = balances[to].add(value);
emit Transfer(from, to, value);
}
/**
* @dev Function to add/update a new minter
* @param minter The address of the minter
* @param minterAllowedAmount The minting amount allowed for the minter
* @return True if the operation was successful.
*/
function configureMinter(address minter, uint256 minterAllowedAmount)
external
whenNotPaused
onlyMasterMinter
returns (bool)
{
minters[minter] = true;
minterAllowed[minter] = minterAllowedAmount;
emit MinterConfigured(minter, minterAllowedAmount);
return true;
}
/**
* @dev Function to remove a minter
* @param minter The address of the minter to remove
* @return True if the operation was successful.
*/
function removeMinter(address minter)
external
onlyMasterMinter
returns (bool)
{
minters[minter] = false;
minterAllowed[minter] = 0;
emit MinterRemoved(minter);
return true;
}
/**
* @dev allows a minter to burn some of its own tokens
* Validates that caller is a minter and that sender is not blacklisted
* amount is less than or equal to the minter's account balance
* @param _amount uint256 the amount of tokens to be burned
*/
function burn(uint256 _amount)
external
whenNotPaused
onlyMinters
notBlacklisted(msg.sender)
{
uint256 balance = balances[msg.sender];
require(_amount > 0, "FiatToken: burn amount not greater than 0");
require(balance >= _amount, "FiatToken: burn amount exceeds balance");
totalSupply_ = totalSupply_.sub(_amount);
balances[msg.sender] = balance.sub(_amount);
emit Burn(msg.sender, _amount);
emit Transfer(msg.sender, address(0), _amount);
}
function updateMasterMinter(address _newMasterMinter) external onlyOwner {
require(
_newMasterMinter != address(0),
"FiatToken: new masterMinter is the zero address"
);
masterMinter = _newMasterMinter;
emit MasterMinterChanged(masterMinter);
}
}
// File: @openzeppelin/contracts/utils/Address.sol
pragma solidity ^0.6.2;
/**
* @dev Collection of functions related to the address type
*/
library Address {
/**
* @dev Returns true if `account` is a contract.
*
* [IMPORTANT]
* ====
* It is unsafe to assume that an address for which this function returns
* false is an externally-owned account (EOA) and not a contract.
*
* Among others, `isContract` will return false for the following
* types of addresses:
*
* - an externally-owned account
* - a contract in construction
* - an address where a contract will be created
* - an address where a contract lived, but was destroyed
* ====
*/
function isContract(address account) internal view returns (bool) {
// According to EIP-1052, 0x0 is the value returned for not-yet created accounts
// and 0xc5d2460186f7233c927e7db2dcc703c0e500b653ca82273b7bfad8045d85a470 is returned
// for accounts without code, i.e. `keccak256('')`
bytes32 codehash;
bytes32 accountHash
= 0xc5d2460186f7233c927e7db2dcc703c0e500b653ca82273b7bfad8045d85a470;
// solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly
assembly {
codehash := extcodehash(account)
}
return (codehash != accountHash && codehash != 0x0);
}
/**
* @dev Replacement for Solidity's `transfer`: sends `amount` wei to
* `recipient`, forwarding all available gas and reverting on errors.
*
* https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-1884[EIP1884] increases the gas cost
* of certain opcodes, possibly making contracts go over the 2300 gas limit
* imposed by `transfer`, making them unable to receive funds via
* `transfer`. {sendValue} removes this limitation.
*
* https://diligence.consensys.net/posts/2019/09/stop-using-soliditys-transfer-now/[Learn more].
*
* IMPORTANT: because control is transferred to `recipient`, care must be
* taken to not create reentrancy vulnerabilities. Consider using
* {ReentrancyGuard} or the
* https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/v0.5.11/security-considerations.html#use-the-checks-effects-interactions-pattern[checks-effects-interactions pattern].
*/
function sendValue(address payable recipient, uint256 amount) internal {
require(
address(this).balance >= amount,
"Address: insufficient balance"
);
// solhint-disable-next-line avoid-low-level-calls, avoid-call-value
(bool success, ) = recipient.call{ value: amount }("");
require(
success,
"Address: unable to send value, recipient may have reverted"
);
}
/**
* @dev Performs a Solidity function call using a low level `call`. A
* plain`call` is an unsafe replacement for a function call: use this
* function instead.
*
* If `target` reverts with a revert reason, it is bubbled up by this
* function (like regular Solidity function calls).
*
* Returns the raw returned data. To convert to the expected return value,
* use https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/latest/units-and-global-variables.html?highlight=abi.decode#abi-encoding-and-decoding-functions[`abi.decode`].
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `target` must be a contract.
* - calling `target` with `data` must not revert.
*
* _Available since v3.1._
*/
function functionCall(address target, bytes memory data)
internal
returns (bytes memory)
{
return functionCall(target, data, "Address: low-level call failed");
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`], but with
* `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts.
*
* _Available since v3.1._
*/
function functionCall(
address target,
bytes memory data,
string memory errorMessage
) internal returns (bytes memory) {
return _functionCallWithValue(target, data, 0, errorMessage);
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
* but also transferring `value` wei to `target`.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - the calling contract must have an ETH balance of at least `value`.
* - the called Solidity function must be `payable`.
*
* _Available since v3.1._
*/
function functionCallWithValue(
address target,
bytes memory data,
uint256 value
) internal returns (bytes memory) {
return
functionCallWithValue(
target,
data,
value,
"Address: low-level call with value failed"
);
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCallWithValue-address-bytes-uint256-}[`functionCallWithValue`], but
* with `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts.
*
* _Available since v3.1._
*/
function functionCallWithValue(
address target,
bytes memory data,
uint256 value,
string memory errorMessage
) internal returns (bytes memory) {
require(
address(this).balance >= value,
"Address: insufficient balance for call"
);
return _functionCallWithValue(target, data, value, errorMessage);
}
function _functionCallWithValue(
address target,
bytes memory data,
uint256 weiValue,
string memory errorMessage
) private returns (bytes memory) {
require(isContract(target), "Address: call to non-contract");
// solhint-disable-next-line avoid-low-level-calls
(bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.call{
value: weiValue
}(data);
if (success) {
return returndata;
} else {
// Look for revert reason and bubble it up if present
if (returndata.length > 0) {
// The easiest way to bubble the revert reason is using memory via assembly
// solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly
assembly {
let returndata_size := mload(returndata)
revert(add(32, returndata), returndata_size)
}
} else {
revert(errorMessage);
}
}
}
}
// File: @openzeppelin/contracts/token/ERC20/SafeERC20.sol
pragma solidity ^0.6.0;
/**
* @title SafeERC20
* @dev Wrappers around ERC20 operations that throw on failure (when the token
* contract returns false). Tokens that return no value (and instead revert or
* throw on failure) are also supported, non-reverting calls are assumed to be
* successful.
* To use this library you can add a `using SafeERC20 for IERC20;` statement to your contract,
* which allows you to call the safe operations as `token.safeTransfer(...)`, etc.
*/
library SafeERC20 {
using SafeMath for uint256;
using Address for address;
function safeTransfer(
IERC20 token,
address to,
uint256 value
) internal {
_callOptionalReturn(
token,
abi.encodeWithSelector(token.transfer.selector, to, value)
);
}
function safeTransferFrom(
IERC20 token,
address from,
address to,
uint256 value
) internal {
_callOptionalReturn(
token,
abi.encodeWithSelector(token.transferFrom.selector, from, to, value)
);
}
/**
* @dev Deprecated. This function has issues similar to the ones found in
* {IERC20-approve}, and its usage is discouraged.
*
* Whenever possible, use {safeIncreaseAllowance} and
* {safeDecreaseAllowance} instead.
*/
function safeApprove(
IERC20 token,
address spender,
uint256 value
) internal {
// safeApprove should only be called when setting an initial allowance,
// or when resetting it to zero. To increase and decrease it, use
// 'safeIncreaseAllowance' and 'safeDecreaseAllowance'
// solhint-disable-next-line max-line-length
require(
(value == 0) || (token.allowance(address(this), spender) == 0),
"SafeERC20: approve from non-zero to non-zero allowance"
);
_callOptionalReturn(
token,
abi.encodeWithSelector(token.approve.selector, spender, value)
);
}
function safeIncreaseAllowance(
IERC20 token,
address spender,
uint256 value
) internal {
uint256 newAllowance = token.allowance(address(this), spender).add(
value
);
_callOptionalReturn(
token,
abi.encodeWithSelector(
token.approve.selector,
spender,
newAllowance
)
);
}
function safeDecreaseAllowance(
IERC20 token,
address spender,
uint256 value
) internal {
uint256 newAllowance = token.allowance(address(this), spender).sub(
value,
"SafeERC20: decreased allowance below zero"
);
_callOptionalReturn(
token,
abi.encodeWithSelector(
token.approve.selector,
spender,
newAllowance
)
);
}
/**
* @dev Imitates a Solidity high-level call (i.e. a regular function call to a contract), relaxing the requirement
* on the return value: the return value is optional (but if data is returned, it must not be false).
* @param token The token targeted by the call.
* @param data The call data (encoded using abi.encode or one of its variants).
*/
function _callOptionalReturn(IERC20 token, bytes memory data) private {
// We need to perform a low level call here, to bypass Solidity's return data size checking mechanism, since
// we're implementing it ourselves. We use {Address.functionCall} to perform this call, which verifies that
// the target address contains contract code and also asserts for success in the low-level call.
bytes memory returndata = address(token).functionCall(
data,
"SafeERC20: low-level call failed"
);
if (returndata.length > 0) {
// Return data is optional
// solhint-disable-next-line max-line-length
require(
abi.decode(returndata, (bool)),
"SafeERC20: ERC20 operation did not succeed"
);
}
}
}
// File: contracts/v1.1/Rescuable.sol
/**
* Copyright (c) 2018-2020 CENTRE SECZ
*
* Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy
* of this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal
* in the Software without restriction, including without limitation the rights
* to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell
* copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is
* furnished to do so, subject to the following conditions:
*
* The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in
* copies or substantial portions of the Software.
*
* THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR
* IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY,
* FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
* AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER
* LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM,
* OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE
* SOFTWARE.
*/
pragma solidity 0.6.12;
contract Rescuable is Ownable {
using SafeERC20 for IERC20;
address private _rescuer;
event RescuerChanged(address indexed newRescuer);
/**
* @notice Returns current rescuer
* @return Rescuer's address
*/
function rescuer() external view returns (address) {
return _rescuer;
}
/**
* @notice Revert if called by any account other than the rescuer.
*/
modifier onlyRescuer() {
require(msg.sender == _rescuer, "Rescuable: caller is not the rescuer");
_;
}
/**
* @notice Rescue ERC20 tokens locked up in this contract.
* @param tokenContract ERC20 token contract address
* @param to Recipient address
* @param amount Amount to withdraw
*/
function rescueERC20(
IERC20 tokenContract,
address to,
uint256 amount
) external onlyRescuer {
tokenContract.safeTransfer(to, amount);
}
/**
* @notice Assign the rescuer role to a given address.
* @param newRescuer New rescuer's address
*/
function updateRescuer(address newRescuer) external onlyOwner {
require(
newRescuer != address(0),
"Rescuable: new rescuer is the zero address"
);
_rescuer = newRescuer;
emit RescuerChanged(newRescuer);
}
}
// File: contracts/v1.1/FiatTokenV1_1.sol
/**
* Copyright (c) 2018-2020 CENTRE SECZ
*
* Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy
* of this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal
* in the Software without restriction, including without limitation the rights
* to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell
* copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is
* furnished to do so, subject to the following conditions:
*
* The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in
* copies or substantial portions of the Software.
*
* THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR
* IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY,
* FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
* AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER
* LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM,
* OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE
* SOFTWARE.
*/
pragma solidity 0.6.12;
/**
* @title FiatTokenV1_1
* @dev ERC20 Token backed by fiat reserves
*/
contract FiatTokenV1_1 is FiatTokenV1, Rescuable {
}
// File: contracts/v2/AbstractFiatTokenV2.sol
/**
* Copyright (c) 2018-2020 CENTRE SECZ
*
* Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy
* of this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal
* in the Software without restriction, including without limitation the rights
* to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell
* copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is
* furnished to do so, subject to the following conditions:
*
* The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in
* copies or substantial portions of the Software.
*
* THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR
* IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY,
* FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
* AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER
* LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM,
* OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE
* SOFTWARE.
*/
pragma solidity 0.6.12;
abstract contract AbstractFiatTokenV2 is AbstractFiatTokenV1 {
function _increaseAllowance(
address owner,
address spender,
uint256 increment
) internal virtual;
function _decreaseAllowance(
address owner,
address spender,
uint256 decrement
) internal virtual;
}
// File: contracts/util/ECRecover.sol
/**
* Copyright (c) 2016-2019 zOS Global Limited
* Copyright (c) 2018-2020 CENTRE SECZ
*
* Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy
* of this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal
* in the Software without restriction, including without limitation the rights
* to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell
* copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is
* furnished to do so, subject to the following conditions:
*
* The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in
* copies or substantial portions of the Software.
*
* THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR
* IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY,
* FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
* AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER
* LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM,
* OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE
* SOFTWARE.
*/
pragma solidity 0.6.12;
/**
* @title ECRecover
* @notice A library that provides a safe ECDSA recovery function
*/
library ECRecover {
/**
* @notice Recover signer's address from a signed message
* @dev Adapted from: https://github.com/OpenZeppelin/openzeppelin-contracts/blob/65e4ffde586ec89af3b7e9140bdc9235d1254853/contracts/cryptography/ECDSA.sol
* Modifications: Accept v, r, and s as separate arguments
* @param digest Keccak-256 hash digest of the signed message
* @param v v of the signature
* @param r r of the signature
* @param s s of the signature
* @return Signer address
*/
function recover(
bytes32 digest,
uint8 v,
bytes32 r,
bytes32 s
) internal pure returns (address) {
// EIP-2 still allows signature malleability for ecrecover(). Remove this possibility and make the signature
// unique. Appendix F in the Ethereum Yellow paper (https://ethereum.github.io/yellowpaper/paper.pdf), defines
// the valid range for s in (281): 0 < s < secp256k1n ÷ 2 + 1, and for v in (282): v ∈ {27, 28}. Most
// signatures from current libraries generate a unique signature with an s-value in the lower half order.
//
// If your library generates malleable signatures, such as s-values in the upper range, calculate a new s-value
// with 0xFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFEBAAEDCE6AF48A03BBFD25E8CD0364141 - s1 and flip v from 27 to 28 or
// vice versa. If your library also generates signatures with 0/1 for v instead 27/28, add 27 to v to accept
// these malleable signatures as well.
if (
uint256(s) >
0x7FFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFF5D576E7357A4501DDFE92F46681B20A0
) {
revert("ECRecover: invalid signature 's' value");
}
if (v != 27 && v != 28) {
revert("ECRecover: invalid signature 'v' value");
}
// If the signature is valid (and not malleable), return the signer address
address signer = ecrecover(digest, v, r, s);
require(signer != address(0), "ECRecover: invalid signature");
return signer;
}
}
// File: contracts/util/EIP712.sol
/**
* Copyright (c) 2018-2020 CENTRE SECZ
*
* Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy
* of this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal
* in the Software without restriction, including without limitation the rights
* to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell
* copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is
* furnished to do so, subject to the following conditions:
*
* The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in
* copies or substantial portions of the Software.
*
* THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR
* IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY,
* FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
* AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER
* LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM,
* OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE
* SOFTWARE.
*/
pragma solidity 0.6.12;
/**
* @title EIP712
* @notice A library that provides EIP712 helper functions
*/
library EIP712 {
/**
* @notice Make EIP712 domain separator
* @param name Contract name
* @param version Contract version
* @return Domain separator
*/
function makeDomainSeparator(string memory name, string memory version)
internal
view
returns (bytes32)
{
uint256 chainId;
assembly {
chainId := chainid()
}
return
keccak256(
abi.encode(
// keccak256("EIP712Domain(string name,string version,uint256 chainId,address verifyingContract)")
0x8b73c3c69bb8fe3d512ecc4cf759cc79239f7b179b0ffacaa9a75d522b39400f,
keccak256(bytes(name)),
keccak256(bytes(version)),
chainId,
address(this)
)
);
}
/**
* @notice Recover signer's address from a EIP712 signature
* @param domainSeparator Domain separator
* @param v v of the signature
* @param r r of the signature
* @param s s of the signature
* @param typeHashAndData Type hash concatenated with data
* @return Signer's address
*/
function recover(
bytes32 domainSeparator,
uint8 v,
bytes32 r,
bytes32 s,
bytes memory typeHashAndData
) internal pure returns (address) {
bytes32 digest = keccak256(
abi.encodePacked(
"\x19\x01",
domainSeparator,
keccak256(typeHashAndData)
)
);
return ECRecover.recover(digest, v, r, s);
}
}
// File: contracts/v2/EIP712Domain.sol
/**
* Copyright (c) 2018-2020 CENTRE SECZ
*
* Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy
* of this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal
* in the Software without restriction, including without limitation the rights
* to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell
* copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is
* furnished to do so, subject to the following conditions:
*
* The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in
* copies or substantial portions of the Software.
*
* THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR
* IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY,
* FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
* AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER
* LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM,
* OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE
* SOFTWARE.
*/
pragma solidity 0.6.12;
/**
* @title EIP712 Domain
*/
contract EIP712Domain {
/**
* @dev EIP712 Domain Separator
*/
bytes32 public DOMAIN_SEPARATOR;
}
// File: contracts/v2/EIP3009.sol
/**
* Copyright (c) 2018-2020 CENTRE SECZ
*
* Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy
* of this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal
* in the Software without restriction, including without limitation the rights
* to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell
* copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is
* furnished to do so, subject to the following conditions:
*
* The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in
* copies or substantial portions of the Software.
*
* THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR
* IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY,
* FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
* AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER
* LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM,
* OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE
* SOFTWARE.
*/
pragma solidity 0.6.12;
/**
* @title EIP-3009
* @notice Provide internal implementation for gas-abstracted transfers
* @dev Contracts that inherit from this must wrap these with publicly
* accessible functions, optionally adding modifiers where necessary
*/
abstract contract EIP3009 is AbstractFiatTokenV2, EIP712Domain {
// keccak256("TransferWithAuthorization(address from,address to,uint256 value,uint256 validAfter,uint256 validBefore,bytes32 nonce)")
bytes32
public constant TRANSFER_WITH_AUTHORIZATION_TYPEHASH = 0x7c7c6cdb67a18743f49ec6fa9b35f50d52ed05cbed4cc592e13b44501c1a2267;
// keccak256("ReceiveWithAuthorization(address from,address to,uint256 value,uint256 validAfter,uint256 validBefore,bytes32 nonce)")
bytes32
public constant RECEIVE_WITH_AUTHORIZATION_TYPEHASH = 0xd099cc98ef71107a616c4f0f941f04c322d8e254fe26b3c6668db87aae413de8;
// keccak256("CancelAuthorization(address authorizer,bytes32 nonce)")
bytes32
public constant CANCEL_AUTHORIZATION_TYPEHASH = 0x158b0a9edf7a828aad02f63cd515c68ef2f50ba807396f6d12842833a1597429;
/**
* @dev authorizer address => nonce => bool (true if nonce is used)
*/
mapping(address => mapping(bytes32 => bool)) private _authorizationStates;
event AuthorizationUsed(address indexed authorizer, bytes32 indexed nonce);
event AuthorizationCanceled(
address indexed authorizer,
bytes32 indexed nonce
);
/**
* @notice Returns the state of an authorization
* @dev Nonces are randomly generated 32-byte data unique to the
* authorizer's address
* @param authorizer Authorizer's address
* @param nonce Nonce of the authorization
* @return True if the nonce is used
*/
function authorizationState(address authorizer, bytes32 nonce)
external
view
returns (bool)
{
return _authorizationStates[authorizer][nonce];
}
/**
* @notice Execute a transfer with a signed authorization
* @param from Payer's address (Authorizer)
* @param to Payee's address
* @param value Amount to be transferred
* @param validAfter The time after which this is valid (unix time)
* @param validBefore The time before which this is valid (unix time)
* @param nonce Unique nonce
* @param v v of the signature
* @param r r of the signature
* @param s s of the signature
*/
function _transferWithAuthorization(
address from,
address to,
uint256 value,
uint256 validAfter,
uint256 validBefore,
bytes32 nonce,
uint8 v,
bytes32 r,
bytes32 s
) internal {
_requireValidAuthorization(from, nonce, validAfter, validBefore);
bytes memory data = abi.encode(
TRANSFER_WITH_AUTHORIZATION_TYPEHASH,
from,
to,
value,
validAfter,
validBefore,
nonce
);
require(
EIP712.recover(DOMAIN_SEPARATOR, v, r, s, data) == from,
"FiatTokenV2: invalid signature"
);
_markAuthorizationAsUsed(from, nonce);
_transfer(from, to, value);
}
/**
* @notice Receive a transfer with a signed authorization from the payer
* @dev This has an additional check to ensure that the payee's address
* matches the caller of this function to prevent front-running attacks.
* @param from Payer's address (Authorizer)
* @param to Payee's address
* @param value Amount to be transferred
* @param validAfter The time after which this is valid (unix time)
* @param validBefore The time before which this is valid (unix time)
* @param nonce Unique nonce
* @param v v of the signature
* @param r r of the signature
* @param s s of the signature
*/
function _receiveWithAuthorization(
address from,
address to,
uint256 value,
uint256 validAfter,
uint256 validBefore,
bytes32 nonce,
uint8 v,
bytes32 r,
bytes32 s
) internal {
require(to == msg.sender, "FiatTokenV2: caller must be the payee");
_requireValidAuthorization(from, nonce, validAfter, validBefore);
bytes memory data = abi.encode(
RECEIVE_WITH_AUTHORIZATION_TYPEHASH,
from,
to,
value,
validAfter,
validBefore,
nonce
);
require(
EIP712.recover(DOMAIN_SEPARATOR, v, r, s, data) == from,
"FiatTokenV2: invalid signature"
);
_markAuthorizationAsUsed(from, nonce);
_transfer(from, to, value);
}
/**
* @notice Attempt to cancel an authorization
* @param authorizer Authorizer's address
* @param nonce Nonce of the authorization
* @param v v of the signature
* @param r r of the signature
* @param s s of the signature
*/
function _cancelAuthorization(
address authorizer,
bytes32 nonce,
uint8 v,
bytes32 r,
bytes32 s
) internal {
_requireUnusedAuthorization(authorizer, nonce);
bytes memory data = abi.encode(
CANCEL_AUTHORIZATION_TYPEHASH,
authorizer,
nonce
);
require(
EIP712.recover(DOMAIN_SEPARATOR, v, r, s, data) == authorizer,
"FiatTokenV2: invalid signature"
);
_authorizationStates[authorizer][nonce] = true;
emit AuthorizationCanceled(authorizer, nonce);
}
/**
* @notice Check that an authorization is unused
* @param authorizer Authorizer's address
* @param nonce Nonce of the authorization
*/
function _requireUnusedAuthorization(address authorizer, bytes32 nonce)
private
view
{
require(
!_authorizationStates[authorizer][nonce],
"FiatTokenV2: authorization is used or canceled"
);
}
/**
* @notice Check that authorization is valid
* @param authorizer Authorizer's address
* @param nonce Nonce of the authorization
* @param validAfter The time after which this is valid (unix time)
* @param validBefore The time before which this is valid (unix time)
*/
function _requireValidAuthorization(
address authorizer,
bytes32 nonce,
uint256 validAfter,
uint256 validBefore
) private view {
require(
now > validAfter,
"FiatTokenV2: authorization is not yet valid"
);
require(now < validBefore, "FiatTokenV2: authorization is expired");
_requireUnusedAuthorization(authorizer, nonce);
}
/**
* @notice Mark an authorization as used
* @param authorizer Authorizer's address
* @param nonce Nonce of the authorization
*/
function _markAuthorizationAsUsed(address authorizer, bytes32 nonce)
private
{
_authorizationStates[authorizer][nonce] = true;
emit AuthorizationUsed(authorizer, nonce);
}
}
// File: contracts/v2/EIP2612.sol
/**
* Copyright (c) 2018-2020 CENTRE SECZ
*
* Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy
* of this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal
* in the Software without restriction, including without limitation the rights
* to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell
* copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is
* furnished to do so, subject to the following conditions:
*
* The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in
* copies or substantial portions of the Software.
*
* THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR
* IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY,
* FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
* AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER
* LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM,
* OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE
* SOFTWARE.
*/
pragma solidity 0.6.12;
/**
* @title EIP-2612
* @notice Provide internal implementation for gas-abstracted approvals
*/
abstract contract EIP2612 is AbstractFiatTokenV2, EIP712Domain {
// keccak256("Permit(address owner,address spender,uint256 value,uint256 nonce,uint256 deadline)")
bytes32
public constant PERMIT_TYPEHASH = 0x6e71edae12b1b97f4d1f60370fef10105fa2faae0126114a169c64845d6126c9;
mapping(address => uint256) private _permitNonces;
/**
* @notice Nonces for permit
* @param owner Token owner's address (Authorizer)
* @return Next nonce
*/
function nonces(address owner) external view returns (uint256) {
return _permitNonces[owner];
}
/**
* @notice Verify a signed approval permit and execute if valid
* @param owner Token owner's address (Authorizer)
* @param spender Spender's address
* @param value Amount of allowance
* @param deadline The time at which this expires (unix time)
* @param v v of the signature
* @param r r of the signature
* @param s s of the signature
*/
function _permit(
address owner,
address spender,
uint256 value,
uint256 deadline,
uint8 v,
bytes32 r,
bytes32 s
) internal {
require(deadline >= now, "FiatTokenV2: permit is expired");
bytes memory data = abi.encode(
PERMIT_TYPEHASH,
owner,
spender,
value,
_permitNonces[owner]++,
deadline
);
require(
EIP712.recover(DOMAIN_SEPARATOR, v, r, s, data) == owner,
"EIP2612: invalid signature"
);
_approve(owner, spender, value);
}
}
// File: contracts/v2/FiatTokenV2.sol
/**
* Copyright (c) 2018-2020 CENTRE SECZ
*
* Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy
* of this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal
* in the Software without restriction, including without limitation the rights
* to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell
* copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is
* furnished to do so, subject to the following conditions:
*
* The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in
* copies or substantial portions of the Software.
*
* THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR
* IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY,
* FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
* AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER
* LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM,
* OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE
* SOFTWARE.
*/
pragma solidity 0.6.12;
/**
* @title FiatToken V2
* @notice ERC20 Token backed by fiat reserves, version 2
*/
contract FiatTokenV2 is FiatTokenV1_1, EIP3009, EIP2612 {
uint8 internal _initializedVersion;
/**
* @notice Initialize v2
* @param newName New token name
*/
function initializeV2(string calldata newName) external {
// solhint-disable-next-line reason-string
require(initialized && _initializedVersion == 0);
name = newName;
DOMAIN_SEPARATOR = EIP712.makeDomainSeparator(newName, "2");
_initializedVersion = 1;
}
/**
* @notice Increase the allowance by a given increment
* @param spender Spender's address
* @param increment Amount of increase in allowance
* @return True if successful
*/
function increaseAllowance(address spender, uint256 increment)
external
whenNotPaused
notBlacklisted(msg.sender)
notBlacklisted(spender)
returns (bool)
{
_increaseAllowance(msg.sender, spender, increment);
return true;
}
/**
* @notice Decrease the allowance by a given decrement
* @param spender Spender's address
* @param decrement Amount of decrease in allowance
* @return True if successful
*/
function decreaseAllowance(address spender, uint256 decrement)
external
whenNotPaused
notBlacklisted(msg.sender)
notBlacklisted(spender)
returns (bool)
{
_decreaseAllowance(msg.sender, spender, decrement);
return true;
}
/**
* @notice Execute a transfer with a signed authorization
* @param from Payer's address (Authorizer)
* @param to Payee's address
* @param value Amount to be transferred
* @param validAfter The time after which this is valid (unix time)
* @param validBefore The time before which this is valid (unix time)
* @param nonce Unique nonce
* @param v v of the signature
* @param r r of the signature
* @param s s of the signature
*/
function transferWithAuthorization(
address from,
address to,
uint256 value,
uint256 validAfter,
uint256 validBefore,
bytes32 nonce,
uint8 v,
bytes32 r,
bytes32 s
) external whenNotPaused notBlacklisted(from) notBlacklisted(to) {
_transferWithAuthorization(
from,
to,
value,
validAfter,
validBefore,
nonce,
v,
r,
s
);
}
/**
* @notice Receive a transfer with a signed authorization from the payer
* @dev This has an additional check to ensure that the payee's address
* matches the caller of this function to prevent front-running attacks.
* @param from Payer's address (Authorizer)
* @param to Payee's address
* @param value Amount to be transferred
* @param validAfter The time after which this is valid (unix time)
* @param validBefore The time before which this is valid (unix time)
* @param nonce Unique nonce
* @param v v of the signature
* @param r r of the signature
* @param s s of the signature
*/
function receiveWithAuthorization(
address from,
address to,
uint256 value,
uint256 validAfter,
uint256 validBefore,
bytes32 nonce,
uint8 v,
bytes32 r,
bytes32 s
) external whenNotPaused notBlacklisted(from) notBlacklisted(to) {
_receiveWithAuthorization(
from,
to,
value,
validAfter,
validBefore,
nonce,
v,
r,
s
);
}
/**
* @notice Attempt to cancel an authorization
* @dev Works only if the authorization is not yet used.
* @param authorizer Authorizer's address
* @param nonce Nonce of the authorization
* @param v v of the signature
* @param r r of the signature
* @param s s of the signature
*/
function cancelAuthorization(
address authorizer,
bytes32 nonce,
uint8 v,
bytes32 r,
bytes32 s
) external whenNotPaused {
_cancelAuthorization(authorizer, nonce, v, r, s);
}
/**
* @notice Update allowance with a signed permit
* @param owner Token owner's address (Authorizer)
* @param spender Spender's address
* @param value Amount of allowance
* @param deadline Expiration time, seconds since the epoch
* @param v v of the signature
* @param r r of the signature
* @param s s of the signature
*/
function permit(
address owner,
address spender,
uint256 value,
uint256 deadline,
uint8 v,
bytes32 r,
bytes32 s
) external whenNotPaused notBlacklisted(owner) notBlacklisted(spender) {
_permit(owner, spender, value, deadline, v, r, s);
}
/**
* @notice Internal function to increase the allowance by a given increment
* @param owner Token owner's address
* @param spender Spender's address
* @param increment Amount of increase
*/
function _increaseAllowance(
address owner,
address spender,
uint256 increment
) internal override {
_approve(owner, spender, allowed[owner][spender].add(increment));
}
/**
* @notice Internal function to decrease the allowance by a given decrement
* @param owner Token owner's address
* @param spender Spender's address
* @param decrement Amount of decrease
*/
function _decreaseAllowance(
address owner,
address spender,
uint256 decrement
) internal override {
_approve(
owner,
spender,
allowed[owner][spender].sub(
decrement,
"ERC20: decreased allowance below zero"
)
);
}
}
// File: contracts/v2/FiatTokenV2_1.sol
/**
* Copyright (c) 2018-2020 CENTRE SECZ
*
* Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy
* of this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal
* in the Software without restriction, including without limitation the rights
* to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell
* copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is
* furnished to do so, subject to the following conditions:
*
* The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in
* copies or substantial portions of the Software.
*
* THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR
* IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY,
* FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
* AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER
* LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM,
* OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE
* SOFTWARE.
*/
pragma solidity 0.6.12;
// solhint-disable func-name-mixedcase
/**
* @title FiatToken V2.1
* @notice ERC20 Token backed by fiat reserves, version 2.1
*/
contract FiatTokenV2_1 is FiatTokenV2 {
/**
* @notice Initialize v2.1
* @param lostAndFound The address to which the locked funds are sent
*/
function initializeV2_1(address lostAndFound) external {
// solhint-disable-next-line reason-string
require(_initializedVersion == 1);
uint256 lockedAmount = balances[address(this)];
if (lockedAmount > 0) {
_transfer(address(this), lostAndFound, lockedAmount);
}
blacklisted[address(this)] = true;
_initializedVersion = 2;
}
/**
* @notice Version string for the EIP712 domain separator
* @return Version string
*/
function version() external view returns (string memory) {
return "2";
}
}File 6 of 8: AggregationRouterV4
/*
,▄▓▓██▌ ,╓▄▄▓▓▓▓▓▓▓▓▄▄▄,,
,▓██▓███▓▄▓███▓╬╬╬╬╬╬╬╬╬╬╬╬╬▓███▓▄,
▄█ ▓██╬╣███████╬▓▀╬╬▓▓▓████████████▓█████▄,
▓██▌ ▓██╬╣██████╬▓▌ ██████████████████████▌╙╙▀ⁿ
▐████████╬▓████▓▓█╨ ▄ ╟█████████▓▓╬╬╬╬╬▓▓█████▓▄
└▀▓▓▄╓ ╟█▓╣█████▓██████▀ ╓█▌ ███████▓▓▓▓▓╬╬╬╬╬╬╬╬╬╬╬╬▓██▓▄
└▀████▓▄╥ ▐██╬╬██████████╙ Æ▀─ ▓███▀╚╠╬╩▀▀███████▓▓╬╬╬╬╬╬╬╬╬██▄
└▀██▓▀▀█████▓╬▓██████▀ ▄█████▒╠" └╙▓██████▓╬╬╬╬╬╬╬╬██▄
└▀██▄,└╙▀▀████▌└╙ ^"▀╙╙╙"╙██ @▄ ╙▀███████╬╬╬╬╬╬╬██µ
└▀██▓▄, ██▌ ╒ ╙█▓ ]▓█▓╔ ▀███████▓╬╬╬╬╬▓█▌
▀█████ ▓ ╟█▌ ]╠██▓░▒╓ ▀████████╬╬╬╬╣█▌
▐████ ╓█▀█▌ ,██▌ ╚Å███▓▒▒╠╓ ╙█████████╬╬╬╣█▌
└████ ▓█░░▓█ ▀▀▀ φ▒╫████▒▒▒▒╠╓ █████████▓╬╬▓█µ
╘███µ ▌▄█▓▄▓▀` ,▀ ,╔╠░▓██████▌╠▒▒▒φ ██████████╬╬██
▐████µ╙▓▀` ,▀╙,╔╔φφφ╠░▄▓███████▌░▓╙▒▒▒╠ └██╬███████╬▓█⌐
╫██ ▓▌ ▌φ▒▒░▓██████████████▌▒░▓╚▒▒▒╠ ▓██╬▓██████╣█▌
██▌ ▌╔▒▒▄████████████████▒▒▒░▌╠▒▒▒≥▐██▓╬╬███████▌
██▌ ,╓φ╠▓«▒▒▓████▀ ▀█████████▌▒▒▒╟░▒▒▒▒▐███╬╬╣████▓█▌
▐██ ╠▒▄▓▓███▓████└ ▀████████▌▒▒░▌╚▒▒▒▐███▓╬╬████ ╙▌
███ ) ╠▒░░░▒░╬████▀ └████████░▒▒░╬∩▒▒▓████╬╬╣███
▓██ ╠╠▒▒▐█▀▀▌`░╫██ ███████▒▒▒▒░▒▒½█████╬╬╣███
███ ,█▄ ╠▒▒▒╫▌,▄▀,▒╫██ ╟██████▒▒▒░╣⌠▒▓█████╬╬╣██▌
╘██µ ██` ╠▒▒░██╬φ╠▄▓██` ██████░░▌φ╠░▓█████▓╬╬▓██
╟██ .φ╠▒░▄█▀░░▄██▀└ █████▌▒╣φ▒░▓██████╬╬╣██
▀██▄▄▄╓▄███████▀ ▐█████░▓φ▒▄███████▓╬╣██
╙▀▀▀██▀└ ████▓▄▀φ▄▓████████╬▓█▀
▓███╬╩╔╣██████████▓██└
╓████▀▄▓████████▀████▀
,▓███████████████─]██╙
,▄▓██████████████▀└ ╙
,╓▄▓███████████████▀╙
`"▀▀▀████████▀▀▀▀`▄███▀▀└
└└
11\ 11\ 11\ 11\ 11\ 11\ 11\
1111 | \__| 11 | 111\ 11 | 11 | 11 |
\_11 | 11\ 1111111\ 1111111\ 1111111\ 1111\ 11 | 111111\ 111111\ 11\ 11\ 11\ 111111\ 111111\ 11 | 11\
11 | 11 |11 __11\ 11 _____|11 __11\ 11 11\11 |11 __11\\_11 _| 11 | 11 | 11 |11 __11\ 11 __11\ 11 | 11 |
11 | 11 |11 | 11 |11 / 11 | 11 | 11 \1111 |11111111 | 11 | 11 | 11 | 11 |11 / 11 |11 | \__|111111 /
11 | 11 |11 | 11 |11 | 11 | 11 | 11 |\111 |11 ____| 11 |11\ 11 | 11 | 11 |11 | 11 |11 | 11 _11<
111111\ 11 |11 | 11 |\1111111\ 11 | 11 | 11 | \11 |\1111111\ \1111 |\11111\1111 |\111111 |11 | 11 | \11\
\______|\__|\__| \__| \_______|\__| \__| \__| \__| \_______| \____/ \_____\____/ \______/ \__| \__| \__|
111111\ 11\ 11\
11 __11\ 11 | \__|
11 / 11 | 111111\ 111111\ 111111\ 111111\ 111111\ 111111\ 111111\ 11\ 111111\ 1111111\
11111111 |11 __11\ 11 __11\ 11 __11\ 11 __11\ 11 __11\ \____11\\_11 _| 11 |11 __11\ 11 __11\
11 __11 |11 / 11 |11 / 11 |11 | \__|11111111 |11 / 11 | 1111111 | 11 | 11 |11 / 11 |11 | 11 |
11 | 11 |11 | 11 |11 | 11 |11 | 11 ____|11 | 11 |11 __11 | 11 |11\ 11 |11 | 11 |11 | 11 |
11 | 11 |\1111111 |\1111111 |11 | \1111111\ \1111111 |\1111111 | \1111 |11 |\111111 |11 | 11 |
\__| \__| \____11 | \____11 |\__| \_______| \____11 | \_______| \____/ \__| \______/ \__| \__|
11\ 11 |11\ 11 | 11\ 11 |
\111111 |\111111 | \111111 |
\______/ \______/ \______/
1111111\ 11\
11 __11\ 11 |
11 | 11 | 111111\ 11\ 11\ 111111\ 111111\ 111111\
1111111 |11 __11\ 11 | 11 |\_11 _| 11 __11\ 11 __11\
11 __11< 11 / 11 |11 | 11 | 11 | 11111111 |11 | \__|
11 | 11 |11 | 11 |11 | 11 | 11 |11\ 11 ____|11 |
11 | 11 |\111111 |\111111 | \1111 |\1111111\ 11 |
\__| \__| \______/ \______/ \____/ \_______|\__|
*/
// File @openzeppelin/contracts/utils/[email protected]
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity >=0.6.0 <0.8.0;
/*
* @dev Provides information about the current execution context, including the
* sender of the transaction and its data. While these are generally available
* via msg.sender and msg.data, they should not be accessed in such a direct
* manner, since when dealing with GSN meta-transactions the account sending and
* paying for execution may not be the actual sender (as far as an application
* is concerned).
*
* This contract is only required for intermediate, library-like contracts.
*/
abstract contract Context {
function _msgSender() internal view virtual returns (address payable) {
return msg.sender;
}
function _msgData() internal view virtual returns (bytes memory) {
this; // silence state mutability warning without generating bytecode - see https://github.com/ethereum/solidity/issues/2691
return msg.data;
}
}
// File @openzeppelin/contracts/access/[email protected]
pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
/**
* @dev Contract module which provides a basic access control mechanism, where
* there is an account (an owner) that can be granted exclusive access to
* specific functions.
*
* By default, the owner account will be the one that deploys the contract. This
* can later be changed with {transferOwnership}.
*
* This module is used through inheritance. It will make available the modifier
* `onlyOwner`, which can be applied to your functions to restrict their use to
* the owner.
*/
abstract contract Ownable is Context {
address private _owner;
event OwnershipTransferred(address indexed previousOwner, address indexed newOwner);
/**
* @dev Initializes the contract setting the deployer as the initial owner.
*/
constructor () {
address msgSender = _msgSender();
_owner = msgSender;
emit OwnershipTransferred(address(0), msgSender);
}
/**
* @dev Returns the address of the current owner.
*/
function owner() public view virtual returns (address) {
return _owner;
}
/**
* @dev Throws if called by any account other than the owner.
*/
modifier onlyOwner() {
require(owner() == _msgSender(), "Ownable: caller is not the owner");
_;
}
/**
* @dev Leaves the contract without owner. It will not be possible to call
* `onlyOwner` functions anymore. Can only be called by the current owner.
*
* NOTE: Renouncing ownership will leave the contract without an owner,
* thereby removing any functionality that is only available to the owner.
*/
function renounceOwnership() public virtual onlyOwner {
emit OwnershipTransferred(_owner, address(0));
_owner = address(0);
}
/**
* @dev Transfers ownership of the contract to a new account (`newOwner`).
* Can only be called by the current owner.
*/
function transferOwnership(address newOwner) public virtual onlyOwner {
require(newOwner != address(0), "Ownable: new owner is the zero address");
emit OwnershipTransferred(_owner, newOwner);
_owner = newOwner;
}
}
// File @openzeppelin/contracts/token/ERC20/[email protected]
pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
/**
* @dev Interface of the ERC20 standard as defined in the EIP.
*/
interface IERC20 {
/**
* @dev Returns the amount of tokens in existence.
*/
function totalSupply() external view returns (uint256);
/**
* @dev Returns the amount of tokens owned by `account`.
*/
function balanceOf(address account) external view returns (uint256);
/**
* @dev Moves `amount` tokens from the caller's account to `recipient`.
*
* Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function transfer(address recipient, uint256 amount) external returns (bool);
/**
* @dev Returns the remaining number of tokens that `spender` will be
* allowed to spend on behalf of `owner` through {transferFrom}. This is
* zero by default.
*
* This value changes when {approve} or {transferFrom} are called.
*/
function allowance(address owner, address spender) external view returns (uint256);
/**
* @dev Sets `amount` as the allowance of `spender` over the caller's tokens.
*
* Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded.
*
* IMPORTANT: Beware that changing an allowance with this method brings the risk
* that someone may use both the old and the new allowance by unfortunate
* transaction ordering. One possible solution to mitigate this race
* condition is to first reduce the spender's allowance to 0 and set the
* desired value afterwards:
* https://github.com/ethereum/EIPs/issues/20#issuecomment-263524729
*
* Emits an {Approval} event.
*/
function approve(address spender, uint256 amount) external returns (bool);
/**
* @dev Moves `amount` tokens from `sender` to `recipient` using the
* allowance mechanism. `amount` is then deducted from the caller's
* allowance.
*
* Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function transferFrom(address sender, address recipient, uint256 amount) external returns (bool);
/**
* @dev Emitted when `value` tokens are moved from one account (`from`) to
* another (`to`).
*
* Note that `value` may be zero.
*/
event Transfer(address indexed from, address indexed to, uint256 value);
/**
* @dev Emitted when the allowance of a `spender` for an `owner` is set by
* a call to {approve}. `value` is the new allowance.
*/
event Approval(address indexed owner, address indexed spender, uint256 value);
}
// File @openzeppelin/contracts/math/[email protected]
pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
/**
* @dev Wrappers over Solidity's arithmetic operations with added overflow
* checks.
*
* Arithmetic operations in Solidity wrap on overflow. This can easily result
* in bugs, because programmers usually assume that an overflow raises an
* error, which is the standard behavior in high level programming languages.
* `SafeMath` restores this intuition by reverting the transaction when an
* operation overflows.
*
* Using this library instead of the unchecked operations eliminates an entire
* class of bugs, so it's recommended to use it always.
*/
library SafeMath {
/**
* @dev Returns the addition of two unsigned integers, with an overflow flag.
*
* _Available since v3.4._
*/
function tryAdd(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (bool, uint256) {
uint256 c = a + b;
if (c < a) return (false, 0);
return (true, c);
}
/**
* @dev Returns the substraction of two unsigned integers, with an overflow flag.
*
* _Available since v3.4._
*/
function trySub(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (bool, uint256) {
if (b > a) return (false, 0);
return (true, a - b);
}
/**
* @dev Returns the multiplication of two unsigned integers, with an overflow flag.
*
* _Available since v3.4._
*/
function tryMul(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (bool, uint256) {
// Gas optimization: this is cheaper than requiring 'a' not being zero, but the
// benefit is lost if 'b' is also tested.
// See: https://github.com/OpenZeppelin/openzeppelin-contracts/pull/522
if (a == 0) return (true, 0);
uint256 c = a * b;
if (c / a != b) return (false, 0);
return (true, c);
}
/**
* @dev Returns the division of two unsigned integers, with a division by zero flag.
*
* _Available since v3.4._
*/
function tryDiv(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (bool, uint256) {
if (b == 0) return (false, 0);
return (true, a / b);
}
/**
* @dev Returns the remainder of dividing two unsigned integers, with a division by zero flag.
*
* _Available since v3.4._
*/
function tryMod(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (bool, uint256) {
if (b == 0) return (false, 0);
return (true, a % b);
}
/**
* @dev Returns the addition of two unsigned integers, reverting on
* overflow.
*
* Counterpart to Solidity's `+` operator.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - Addition cannot overflow.
*/
function add(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
uint256 c = a + b;
require(c >= a, "SafeMath: addition overflow");
return c;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the subtraction of two unsigned integers, reverting on
* overflow (when the result is negative).
*
* Counterpart to Solidity's `-` operator.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - Subtraction cannot overflow.
*/
function sub(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
require(b <= a, "SafeMath: subtraction overflow");
return a - b;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the multiplication of two unsigned integers, reverting on
* overflow.
*
* Counterpart to Solidity's `*` operator.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - Multiplication cannot overflow.
*/
function mul(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
if (a == 0) return 0;
uint256 c = a * b;
require(c / a == b, "SafeMath: multiplication overflow");
return c;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the integer division of two unsigned integers, reverting on
* division by zero. The result is rounded towards zero.
*
* Counterpart to Solidity's `/` operator. Note: this function uses a
* `revert` opcode (which leaves remaining gas untouched) while Solidity
* uses an invalid opcode to revert (consuming all remaining gas).
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The divisor cannot be zero.
*/
function div(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
require(b > 0, "SafeMath: division by zero");
return a / b;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the remainder of dividing two unsigned integers. (unsigned integer modulo),
* reverting when dividing by zero.
*
* Counterpart to Solidity's `%` operator. This function uses a `revert`
* opcode (which leaves remaining gas untouched) while Solidity uses an
* invalid opcode to revert (consuming all remaining gas).
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The divisor cannot be zero.
*/
function mod(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
require(b > 0, "SafeMath: modulo by zero");
return a % b;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the subtraction of two unsigned integers, reverting with custom message on
* overflow (when the result is negative).
*
* CAUTION: This function is deprecated because it requires allocating memory for the error
* message unnecessarily. For custom revert reasons use {trySub}.
*
* Counterpart to Solidity's `-` operator.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - Subtraction cannot overflow.
*/
function sub(uint256 a, uint256 b, string memory errorMessage) internal pure returns (uint256) {
require(b <= a, errorMessage);
return a - b;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the integer division of two unsigned integers, reverting with custom message on
* division by zero. The result is rounded towards zero.
*
* CAUTION: This function is deprecated because it requires allocating memory for the error
* message unnecessarily. For custom revert reasons use {tryDiv}.
*
* Counterpart to Solidity's `/` operator. Note: this function uses a
* `revert` opcode (which leaves remaining gas untouched) while Solidity
* uses an invalid opcode to revert (consuming all remaining gas).
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The divisor cannot be zero.
*/
function div(uint256 a, uint256 b, string memory errorMessage) internal pure returns (uint256) {
require(b > 0, errorMessage);
return a / b;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the remainder of dividing two unsigned integers. (unsigned integer modulo),
* reverting with custom message when dividing by zero.
*
* CAUTION: This function is deprecated because it requires allocating memory for the error
* message unnecessarily. For custom revert reasons use {tryMod}.
*
* Counterpart to Solidity's `%` operator. This function uses a `revert`
* opcode (which leaves remaining gas untouched) while Solidity uses an
* invalid opcode to revert (consuming all remaining gas).
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The divisor cannot be zero.
*/
function mod(uint256 a, uint256 b, string memory errorMessage) internal pure returns (uint256) {
require(b > 0, errorMessage);
return a % b;
}
}
// File @openzeppelin/contracts/utils/[email protected]
pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
/**
* @dev Collection of functions related to the address type
*/
library Address {
/**
* @dev Returns true if `account` is a contract.
*
* [IMPORTANT]
* ====
* It is unsafe to assume that an address for which this function returns
* false is an externally-owned account (EOA) and not a contract.
*
* Among others, `isContract` will return false for the following
* types of addresses:
*
* - an externally-owned account
* - a contract in construction
* - an address where a contract will be created
* - an address where a contract lived, but was destroyed
* ====
*/
function isContract(address account) internal view returns (bool) {
// This method relies on extcodesize, which returns 0 for contracts in
// construction, since the code is only stored at the end of the
// constructor execution.
uint256 size;
// solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly
assembly { size := extcodesize(account) }
return size > 0;
}
/**
* @dev Replacement for Solidity's `transfer`: sends `amount` wei to
* `recipient`, forwarding all available gas and reverting on errors.
*
* https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-1884[EIP1884] increases the gas cost
* of certain opcodes, possibly making contracts go over the 2300 gas limit
* imposed by `transfer`, making them unable to receive funds via
* `transfer`. {sendValue} removes this limitation.
*
* https://diligence.consensys.net/posts/2019/09/stop-using-soliditys-transfer-now/[Learn more].
*
* IMPORTANT: because control is transferred to `recipient`, care must be
* taken to not create reentrancy vulnerabilities. Consider using
* {ReentrancyGuard} or the
* https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/v0.5.11/security-considerations.html#use-the-checks-effects-interactions-pattern[checks-effects-interactions pattern].
*/
function sendValue(address payable recipient, uint256 amount) internal {
require(address(this).balance >= amount, "Address: insufficient balance");
// solhint-disable-next-line avoid-low-level-calls, avoid-call-value
(bool success, ) = recipient.call{ value: amount }("");
require(success, "Address: unable to send value, recipient may have reverted");
}
/**
* @dev Performs a Solidity function call using a low level `call`. A
* plain`call` is an unsafe replacement for a function call: use this
* function instead.
*
* If `target` reverts with a revert reason, it is bubbled up by this
* function (like regular Solidity function calls).
*
* Returns the raw returned data. To convert to the expected return value,
* use https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/latest/units-and-global-variables.html?highlight=abi.decode#abi-encoding-and-decoding-functions[`abi.decode`].
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `target` must be a contract.
* - calling `target` with `data` must not revert.
*
* _Available since v3.1._
*/
function functionCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal returns (bytes memory) {
return functionCall(target, data, "Address: low-level call failed");
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`], but with
* `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts.
*
* _Available since v3.1._
*/
function functionCall(address target, bytes memory data, string memory errorMessage) internal returns (bytes memory) {
return functionCallWithValue(target, data, 0, errorMessage);
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
* but also transferring `value` wei to `target`.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - the calling contract must have an ETH balance of at least `value`.
* - the called Solidity function must be `payable`.
*
* _Available since v3.1._
*/
function functionCallWithValue(address target, bytes memory data, uint256 value) internal returns (bytes memory) {
return functionCallWithValue(target, data, value, "Address: low-level call with value failed");
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCallWithValue-address-bytes-uint256-}[`functionCallWithValue`], but
* with `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts.
*
* _Available since v3.1._
*/
function functionCallWithValue(address target, bytes memory data, uint256 value, string memory errorMessage) internal returns (bytes memory) {
require(address(this).balance >= value, "Address: insufficient balance for call");
require(isContract(target), "Address: call to non-contract");
// solhint-disable-next-line avoid-low-level-calls
(bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.call{ value: value }(data);
return _verifyCallResult(success, returndata, errorMessage);
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
* but performing a static call.
*
* _Available since v3.3._
*/
function functionStaticCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal view returns (bytes memory) {
return functionStaticCall(target, data, "Address: low-level static call failed");
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-string-}[`functionCall`],
* but performing a static call.
*
* _Available since v3.3._
*/
function functionStaticCall(address target, bytes memory data, string memory errorMessage) internal view returns (bytes memory) {
require(isContract(target), "Address: static call to non-contract");
// solhint-disable-next-line avoid-low-level-calls
(bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.staticcall(data);
return _verifyCallResult(success, returndata, errorMessage);
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
* but performing a delegate call.
*
* _Available since v3.4._
*/
function functionDelegateCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal returns (bytes memory) {
return functionDelegateCall(target, data, "Address: low-level delegate call failed");
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-string-}[`functionCall`],
* but performing a delegate call.
*
* _Available since v3.4._
*/
function functionDelegateCall(address target, bytes memory data, string memory errorMessage) internal returns (bytes memory) {
require(isContract(target), "Address: delegate call to non-contract");
// solhint-disable-next-line avoid-low-level-calls
(bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.delegatecall(data);
return _verifyCallResult(success, returndata, errorMessage);
}
function _verifyCallResult(bool success, bytes memory returndata, string memory errorMessage) private pure returns(bytes memory) {
if (success) {
return returndata;
} else {
// Look for revert reason and bubble it up if present
if (returndata.length > 0) {
// The easiest way to bubble the revert reason is using memory via assembly
// solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly
assembly {
let returndata_size := mload(returndata)
revert(add(32, returndata), returndata_size)
}
} else {
revert(errorMessage);
}
}
}
}
// File @openzeppelin/contracts/token/ERC20/[email protected]
pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
/**
* @title SafeERC20
* @dev Wrappers around ERC20 operations that throw on failure (when the token
* contract returns false). Tokens that return no value (and instead revert or
* throw on failure) are also supported, non-reverting calls are assumed to be
* successful.
* To use this library you can add a `using SafeERC20 for IERC20;` statement to your contract,
* which allows you to call the safe operations as `token.safeTransfer(...)`, etc.
*/
library SafeERC20 {
using SafeMath for uint256;
using Address for address;
function safeTransfer(IERC20 token, address to, uint256 value) internal {
_callOptionalReturn(token, abi.encodeWithSelector(token.transfer.selector, to, value));
}
function safeTransferFrom(IERC20 token, address from, address to, uint256 value) internal {
_callOptionalReturn(token, abi.encodeWithSelector(token.transferFrom.selector, from, to, value));
}
/**
* @dev Deprecated. This function has issues similar to the ones found in
* {IERC20-approve}, and its usage is discouraged.
*
* Whenever possible, use {safeIncreaseAllowance} and
* {safeDecreaseAllowance} instead.
*/
function safeApprove(IERC20 token, address spender, uint256 value) internal {
// safeApprove should only be called when setting an initial allowance,
// or when resetting it to zero. To increase and decrease it, use
// 'safeIncreaseAllowance' and 'safeDecreaseAllowance'
// solhint-disable-next-line max-line-length
require((value == 0) || (token.allowance(address(this), spender) == 0),
"SafeERC20: approve from non-zero to non-zero allowance"
);
_callOptionalReturn(token, abi.encodeWithSelector(token.approve.selector, spender, value));
}
function safeIncreaseAllowance(IERC20 token, address spender, uint256 value) internal {
uint256 newAllowance = token.allowance(address(this), spender).add(value);
_callOptionalReturn(token, abi.encodeWithSelector(token.approve.selector, spender, newAllowance));
}
function safeDecreaseAllowance(IERC20 token, address spender, uint256 value) internal {
uint256 newAllowance = token.allowance(address(this), spender).sub(value, "SafeERC20: decreased allowance below zero");
_callOptionalReturn(token, abi.encodeWithSelector(token.approve.selector, spender, newAllowance));
}
/**
* @dev Imitates a Solidity high-level call (i.e. a regular function call to a contract), relaxing the requirement
* on the return value: the return value is optional (but if data is returned, it must not be false).
* @param token The token targeted by the call.
* @param data The call data (encoded using abi.encode or one of its variants).
*/
function _callOptionalReturn(IERC20 token, bytes memory data) private {
// We need to perform a low level call here, to bypass Solidity's return data size checking mechanism, since
// we're implementing it ourselves. We use {Address.functionCall} to perform this call, which verifies that
// the target address contains contract code and also asserts for success in the low-level call.
bytes memory returndata = address(token).functionCall(data, "SafeERC20: low-level call failed");
if (returndata.length > 0) { // Return data is optional
// solhint-disable-next-line max-line-length
require(abi.decode(returndata, (bool)), "SafeERC20: ERC20 operation did not succeed");
}
}
}
// File contracts/helpers/EthReceiver.sol
pragma solidity ^0.7.6;
/// @title Base contract with common payable logics
abstract contract EthReceiver {
receive() external payable {
// solhint-disable-next-line avoid-tx-origin
require(msg.sender != tx.origin, "ETH deposit rejected");
}
}
// File @openzeppelin/contracts/drafts/[email protected]
pragma solidity >=0.6.0 <0.8.0;
/**
* @dev Interface of the ERC20 Permit extension allowing approvals to be made via signatures, as defined in
* https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2612[EIP-2612].
*
* Adds the {permit} method, which can be used to change an account's ERC20 allowance (see {IERC20-allowance}) by
* presenting a message signed by the account. By not relying on `{IERC20-approve}`, the token holder account doesn't
* need to send a transaction, and thus is not required to hold Ether at all.
*/
interface IERC20Permit {
/**
* @dev Sets `value` as the allowance of `spender` over `owner`'s tokens,
* given `owner`'s signed approval.
*
* IMPORTANT: The same issues {IERC20-approve} has related to transaction
* ordering also apply here.
*
* Emits an {Approval} event.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `spender` cannot be the zero address.
* - `deadline` must be a timestamp in the future.
* - `v`, `r` and `s` must be a valid `secp256k1` signature from `owner`
* over the EIP712-formatted function arguments.
* - the signature must use ``owner``'s current nonce (see {nonces}).
*
* For more information on the signature format, see the
* https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2612#specification[relevant EIP
* section].
*/
function permit(address owner, address spender, uint256 value, uint256 deadline, uint8 v, bytes32 r, bytes32 s) external;
/**
* @dev Returns the current nonce for `owner`. This value must be
* included whenever a signature is generated for {permit}.
*
* Every successful call to {permit} increases ``owner``'s nonce by one. This
* prevents a signature from being used multiple times.
*/
function nonces(address owner) external view returns (uint256);
/**
* @dev Returns the domain separator used in the encoding of the signature for `permit`, as defined by {EIP712}.
*/
// solhint-disable-next-line func-name-mixedcase
function DOMAIN_SEPARATOR() external view returns (bytes32);
}
// File contracts/helpers/RevertReasonParser.sol
pragma solidity ^0.7.6;
/// @title Library that allows to parse unsuccessful arbitrary calls revert reasons.
/// See https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/latest/control-structures.html#revert for details.
/// Note that we assume revert reason being abi-encoded as Error(string) so it may fail to parse reason
/// if structured reverts appear in the future.
///
/// All unsuccessful parsings get encoded as Unknown(data) string
library RevertReasonParser {
bytes4 constant private _PANIC_SELECTOR = bytes4(keccak256("Panic(uint256)"));
bytes4 constant private _ERROR_SELECTOR = bytes4(keccak256("Error(string)"));
function parse(bytes memory data, string memory prefix) internal pure returns (string memory) {
if (data.length >= 4) {
bytes4 selector;
assembly { // solhint-disable-line no-inline-assembly
selector := mload(add(data, 0x20))
}
// 68 = 4-byte selector + 32 bytes offset + 32 bytes length
if (selector == _ERROR_SELECTOR && data.length >= 68) {
uint256 offset;
bytes memory reason;
// solhint-disable no-inline-assembly
assembly {
// 36 = 32 bytes data length + 4-byte selector
offset := mload(add(data, 36))
reason := add(data, add(36, offset))
}
/*
revert reason is padded up to 32 bytes with ABI encoder: Error(string)
also sometimes there is extra 32 bytes of zeros padded in the end:
https://github.com/ethereum/solidity/issues/10170
because of that we can't check for equality and instead check
that offset + string length + extra 36 bytes is less than overall data length
*/
require(data.length >= 36 + offset + reason.length, "Invalid revert reason");
return string(abi.encodePacked(prefix, "Error(", reason, ")"));
}
// 36 = 4-byte selector + 32 bytes integer
else if (selector == _PANIC_SELECTOR && data.length == 36) {
uint256 code;
// solhint-disable no-inline-assembly
assembly {
// 36 = 32 bytes data length + 4-byte selector
code := mload(add(data, 36))
}
return string(abi.encodePacked(prefix, "Panic(", _toHex(code), ")"));
}
}
return string(abi.encodePacked(prefix, "Unknown(", _toHex(data), ")"));
}
function _toHex(uint256 value) private pure returns(string memory) {
return _toHex(abi.encodePacked(value));
}
function _toHex(bytes memory data) private pure returns(string memory) {
bytes16 alphabet = 0x30313233343536373839616263646566;
bytes memory str = new bytes(2 + data.length * 2);
str[0] = "0";
str[1] = "x";
for (uint256 i = 0; i < data.length; i++) {
str[2 * i + 2] = alphabet[uint8(data[i] >> 4)];
str[2 * i + 3] = alphabet[uint8(data[i] & 0x0f)];
}
return string(str);
}
}
// File contracts/interfaces/IDaiLikePermit.sol
pragma solidity ^0.7.6;
/// @title Interface for DAI-style permits
interface IDaiLikePermit {
function permit(address holder, address spender, uint256 nonce, uint256 expiry, bool allowed, uint8 v, bytes32 r, bytes32 s) external;
}
// File contracts/helpers/Permitable.sol
pragma solidity ^0.7.6;
/// @title Base contract with common permit handling logics
contract Permitable {
function _permit(address token, bytes calldata permit) internal {
if (permit.length > 0) {
bool success;
bytes memory result;
if (permit.length == 32 * 7) {
// solhint-disable-next-line avoid-low-level-calls
(success, result) = token.call(abi.encodePacked(IERC20Permit.permit.selector, permit));
} else if (permit.length == 32 * 8) {
// solhint-disable-next-line avoid-low-level-calls
(success, result) = token.call(abi.encodePacked(IDaiLikePermit.permit.selector, permit));
} else {
revert("Wrong permit length");
}
if (!success) {
revert(RevertReasonParser.parse(result, "Permit failed: "));
}
}
}
}
// File contracts/helpers/UniERC20.sol
pragma solidity ^0.7.6;
library UniERC20 {
using SafeMath for uint256;
using SafeERC20 for IERC20;
IERC20 private constant _ETH_ADDRESS = IERC20(0xEeeeeEeeeEeEeeEeEeEeeEEEeeeeEeeeeeeeEEeE);
IERC20 private constant _ZERO_ADDRESS = IERC20(0);
function isETH(IERC20 token) internal pure returns (bool) {
return (token == _ZERO_ADDRESS || token == _ETH_ADDRESS);
}
function uniBalanceOf(IERC20 token, address account) internal view returns (uint256) {
if (isETH(token)) {
return account.balance;
} else {
return token.balanceOf(account);
}
}
function uniTransfer(IERC20 token, address payable to, uint256 amount) internal {
if (amount > 0) {
if (isETH(token)) {
to.transfer(amount);
} else {
token.safeTransfer(to, amount);
}
}
}
function uniApprove(IERC20 token, address to, uint256 amount) internal {
require(!isETH(token), "Approve called on ETH");
// solhint-disable-next-line avoid-low-level-calls
(bool success, bytes memory returndata) = address(token).call(abi.encodeWithSelector(token.approve.selector, to, amount));
if (!success || (returndata.length > 0 && !abi.decode(returndata, (bool)))) {
_callOptionalReturn(token, abi.encodeWithSelector(token.approve.selector, to, 0));
_callOptionalReturn(token, abi.encodeWithSelector(token.approve.selector, to, amount));
}
}
function _callOptionalReturn(IERC20 token, bytes memory data) private {
// solhint-disable-next-line avoid-low-level-calls
(bool success, bytes memory result) = address(token).call(data);
if (!success) {
revert(RevertReasonParser.parse(result, "Low-level call failed: "));
}
if (result.length > 0) { // Return data is optional
require(abi.decode(result, (bool)), "ERC20 operation did not succeed");
}
}
}
// File contracts/interfaces/IAggregationExecutor.sol
pragma solidity ^0.7.6;
/// @title Interface for making arbitrary calls during swap
interface IAggregationExecutor {
/// @notice Make calls on `msgSender` with specified data
function callBytes(address msgSender, bytes calldata data) external payable; // 0x2636f7f8
}
// File @openzeppelin/contracts/drafts/[email protected]
pragma solidity >=0.6.0 <0.8.0;
/**
* @dev https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-712[EIP 712] is a standard for hashing and signing of typed structured data.
*
* The encoding specified in the EIP is very generic, and such a generic implementation in Solidity is not feasible,
* thus this contract does not implement the encoding itself. Protocols need to implement the type-specific encoding
* they need in their contracts using a combination of `abi.encode` and `keccak256`.
*
* This contract implements the EIP 712 domain separator ({_domainSeparatorV4}) that is used as part of the encoding
* scheme, and the final step of the encoding to obtain the message digest that is then signed via ECDSA
* ({_hashTypedDataV4}).
*
* The implementation of the domain separator was designed to be as efficient as possible while still properly updating
* the chain id to protect against replay attacks on an eventual fork of the chain.
*
* NOTE: This contract implements the version of the encoding known as "v4", as implemented by the JSON RPC method
* https://docs.metamask.io/guide/signing-data.html[`eth_signTypedDataV4` in MetaMask].
*
* _Available since v3.4._
*/
abstract contract EIP712 {
/* solhint-disable var-name-mixedcase */
// Cache the domain separator as an immutable value, but also store the chain id that it corresponds to, in order to
// invalidate the cached domain separator if the chain id changes.
bytes32 private immutable _CACHED_DOMAIN_SEPARATOR;
uint256 private immutable _CACHED_CHAIN_ID;
bytes32 private immutable _HASHED_NAME;
bytes32 private immutable _HASHED_VERSION;
bytes32 private immutable _TYPE_HASH;
/* solhint-enable var-name-mixedcase */
/**
* @dev Initializes the domain separator and parameter caches.
*
* The meaning of `name` and `version` is specified in
* https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-712#definition-of-domainseparator[EIP 712]:
*
* - `name`: the user readable name of the signing domain, i.e. the name of the DApp or the protocol.
* - `version`: the current major version of the signing domain.
*
* NOTE: These parameters cannot be changed except through a xref:learn::upgrading-smart-contracts.adoc[smart
* contract upgrade].
*/
constructor(string memory name, string memory version) {
bytes32 hashedName = keccak256(bytes(name));
bytes32 hashedVersion = keccak256(bytes(version));
bytes32 typeHash = keccak256("EIP712Domain(string name,string version,uint256 chainId,address verifyingContract)");
_HASHED_NAME = hashedName;
_HASHED_VERSION = hashedVersion;
_CACHED_CHAIN_ID = _getChainId();
_CACHED_DOMAIN_SEPARATOR = _buildDomainSeparator(typeHash, hashedName, hashedVersion);
_TYPE_HASH = typeHash;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the domain separator for the current chain.
*/
function _domainSeparatorV4() internal view virtual returns (bytes32) {
if (_getChainId() == _CACHED_CHAIN_ID) {
return _CACHED_DOMAIN_SEPARATOR;
} else {
return _buildDomainSeparator(_TYPE_HASH, _HASHED_NAME, _HASHED_VERSION);
}
}
function _buildDomainSeparator(bytes32 typeHash, bytes32 name, bytes32 version) private view returns (bytes32) {
return keccak256(
abi.encode(
typeHash,
name,
version,
_getChainId(),
address(this)
)
);
}
/**
* @dev Given an already https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-712#definition-of-hashstruct[hashed struct], this
* function returns the hash of the fully encoded EIP712 message for this domain.
*
* This hash can be used together with {ECDSA-recover} to obtain the signer of a message. For example:
*
* ```solidity
* bytes32 digest = _hashTypedDataV4(keccak256(abi.encode(
* keccak256("Mail(address to,string contents)"),
* mailTo,
* keccak256(bytes(mailContents))
* )));
* address signer = ECDSA.recover(digest, signature);
* ```
*/
function _hashTypedDataV4(bytes32 structHash) internal view virtual returns (bytes32) {
return keccak256(abi.encodePacked("\x19\x01", _domainSeparatorV4(), structHash));
}
function _getChainId() private view returns (uint256 chainId) {
this; // silence state mutability warning without generating bytecode - see https://github.com/ethereum/solidity/issues/2691
// solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly
assembly {
chainId := chainid()
}
}
}
// File contracts/helpers/ECDSA.sol
pragma solidity ^0.7.6;
/**
* @dev Simplified copy of OpenZeppelin ECDSA library downgraded to 0.7.6
* https://github.com/OpenZeppelin/openzeppelin-contracts/blob/541e82144f691aa171c53ba8c3b32ef7f05b99a5/contracts/utils/cryptography/ECDSA.sol
*
* Elliptic Curve Digital Signature Algorithm (ECDSA) operations.
*
* These functions can be used to verify that a message was signed by the holder
* of the private keys of a given address.
*/
library ECDSA {
/**
* @dev Returns the address that signed a hashed message (`hash`) with
* `signature` or error string. This address can then be used for verification purposes.
*
* The `ecrecover` EVM opcode allows for malleable (non-unique) signatures:
* this function rejects them by requiring the `s` value to be in the lower
* half order, and the `v` value to be either 27 or 28.
*
* IMPORTANT: `hash` _must_ be the result of a hash operation for the
* verification to be secure: it is possible to craft signatures that
* recover to arbitrary addresses for non-hashed data. A safe way to ensure
* this is by receiving a hash of the original message (which may otherwise
* be too long), and then calling {toEthSignedMessageHash} on it.
*
* Documentation for signature generation:
* - with https://web3js.readthedocs.io/en/v1.3.4/web3-eth-accounts.html#sign[Web3.js]
* - with https://docs.ethers.io/v5/api/signer/#Signer-signMessage[ethers]
*
* _Available since v4.3._
*/
function tryRecover(bytes32 hash, bytes memory signature) internal pure returns (address) {
// Check the signature length
// - case 65: r,s,v signature (standard)
// - case 64: r,vs signature (cf https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2098) _Available since v4.1._
if (signature.length == 65) {
bytes32 r;
bytes32 s;
uint8 v;
// ecrecover takes the signature parameters, and the only way to get them
// currently is to use assembly.
assembly { // solhint-disable-line no-inline-assembly
r := mload(add(signature, 0x20))
s := mload(add(signature, 0x40))
v := byte(0, mload(add(signature, 0x60)))
}
return tryRecover(hash, v, r, s);
} else if (signature.length == 64) {
bytes32 r;
bytes32 vs;
// ecrecover takes the signature parameters, and the only way to get them
// currently is to use assembly.
assembly { // solhint-disable-line no-inline-assembly
r := mload(add(signature, 0x20))
vs := mload(add(signature, 0x40))
}
return tryRecover(hash, r, vs);
} else {
return address(0);
}
}
/**
* @dev Overload of {ECDSA-tryRecover} that receives the `r` and `vs` short-signature fields separately.
*
* See https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2098[EIP-2098 short signatures]
*
* _Available since v4.3._
*/
function tryRecover(
bytes32 hash,
bytes32 r,
bytes32 vs
) internal pure returns (address) {
bytes32 s;
uint8 v;
assembly { // solhint-disable-line no-inline-assembly
s := and(vs, 0x7fffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffff)
v := add(shr(255, vs), 27)
}
return tryRecover(hash, v, r, s);
}
/**
* @dev Overload of {ECDSA-tryRecover} that receives the `v`,
* `r` and `s` signature fields separately.
*
* _Available since v4.3._
*/
function tryRecover(
bytes32 hash,
uint8 v,
bytes32 r,
bytes32 s
) internal pure returns (address) {
// EIP-2 still allows signature malleability for ecrecover(). Remove this possibility and make the signature
// unique. Appendix F in the Ethereum Yellow paper (https://ethereum.github.io/yellowpaper/paper.pdf), defines
// the valid range for s in (301): 0 < s < secp256k1n ÷ 2 + 1, and for v in (302): v ∈ {27, 28}. Most
// signatures from current libraries generate a unique signature with an s-value in the lower half order.
//
// If your library generates malleable signatures, such as s-values in the upper range, calculate a new s-value
// with 0xFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFEBAAEDCE6AF48A03BBFD25E8CD0364141 - s1 and flip v from 27 to 28 or
// vice versa. If your library also generates signatures with 0/1 for v instead 27/28, add 27 to v to accept
// these malleable signatures as well.
if (uint256(s) > 0x7FFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFF5D576E7357A4501DDFE92F46681B20A0) {
return address(0);
}
if (v != 27 && v != 28) {
return address(0);
}
// If the signature is valid (and not malleable), return the signer address
address signer = ecrecover(hash, v, r, s);
if (signer == address(0)) {
return address(0);
}
return signer;
}
}
// File contracts/interfaces/IERC1271.sol
pragma solidity ^0.7.6;
/**
* @dev Interface of the ERC1271 standard signature validation method for
* contracts as defined in https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-1271[ERC-1271].
*/
interface IERC1271 {
/**
* @dev Should return whether the signature provided is valid for the provided data
* @param hash Hash of the data to be signed
* @param signature Signature byte array associated with _data
*/
function isValidSignature(bytes32 hash, bytes memory signature) external view returns (bytes4 magicValue);
}
// File contracts/interfaces/IWETH.sol
pragma solidity ^0.7.6;
/// @title Interface for WETH tokens
interface IWETH is IERC20 {
function deposit() external payable;
function withdraw(uint256 amount) external;
}
// File contracts/LimitOrderProtocolRFQ.sol
pragma solidity ^0.7.6;
pragma abicoder v2;
contract LimitOrderProtocolRFQ is EthReceiver, EIP712("1inch RFQ", "2"), Permitable {
using SafeMath for uint256;
using SafeERC20 for IERC20;
event OrderFilledRFQ(
bytes32 orderHash,
uint256 makingAmount
);
struct OrderRFQ {
// lowest 64 bits is the order id, next 64 bits is the expiration timestamp
// highest bit is unwrap WETH flag which is set on taker's side
// [unwrap eth(1 bit) | unused (127 bits) | expiration timestamp(64 bits) | orderId (64 bits)]
uint256 info;
IERC20 makerAsset;
IERC20 takerAsset;
address maker;
address allowedSender; // equals to Zero address on public orders
uint256 makingAmount;
uint256 takingAmount;
}
bytes32 constant public LIMIT_ORDER_RFQ_TYPEHASH = keccak256(
"OrderRFQ(uint256 info,address makerAsset,address takerAsset,address maker,address allowedSender,uint256 makingAmount,uint256 takingAmount)"
);
uint256 private constant _UNWRAP_WETH_MASK = 1 << 255;
IWETH private immutable _WETH; // solhint-disable-line var-name-mixedcase
mapping(address => mapping(uint256 => uint256)) private _invalidator;
constructor(address weth) {
_WETH = IWETH(weth);
}
// solhint-disable-next-line func-name-mixedcase
function DOMAIN_SEPARATOR() external view returns(bytes32) {
return _domainSeparatorV4();
}
/// @notice Returns bitmask for double-spend invalidators based on lowest byte of order.info and filled quotes
/// @return Result Each bit represents whenever corresponding quote was filled
function invalidatorForOrderRFQ(address maker, uint256 slot) external view returns(uint256) {
return _invalidator[maker][slot];
}
/// @notice Cancels order's quote
function cancelOrderRFQ(uint256 orderInfo) external {
_invalidateOrder(msg.sender, orderInfo);
}
/// @notice Fills order's quote, fully or partially (whichever is possible)
/// @param order Order quote to fill
/// @param signature Signature to confirm quote ownership
/// @param makingAmount Making amount
/// @param takingAmount Taking amount
function fillOrderRFQ(
OrderRFQ memory order,
bytes calldata signature,
uint256 makingAmount,
uint256 takingAmount
) external payable returns(uint256 /* actualMakingAmount */, uint256 /* actualTakingAmount */) {
return fillOrderRFQTo(order, signature, makingAmount, takingAmount, payable(msg.sender));
}
/// @notice Fills Same as `fillOrderRFQ` but calls permit first,
/// allowing to approve token spending and make a swap in one transaction.
/// Also allows to specify funds destination instead of `msg.sender`
/// @param order Order quote to fill
/// @param signature Signature to confirm quote ownership
/// @param makingAmount Making amount
/// @param takingAmount Taking amount
/// @param target Address that will receive swap funds
/// @param permit Should consist of abiencoded token address and encoded `IERC20Permit.permit` call.
/// See tests for examples
function fillOrderRFQToWithPermit(
OrderRFQ memory order,
bytes calldata signature,
uint256 makingAmount,
uint256 takingAmount,
address payable target,
bytes calldata permit
) external returns(uint256 /* actualMakingAmount */, uint256 /* actualTakingAmount */) {
_permit(address(order.takerAsset), permit);
return fillOrderRFQTo(order, signature, makingAmount, takingAmount, target);
}
/// @notice Same as `fillOrderRFQ` but allows to specify funds destination instead of `msg.sender`
/// @param order Order quote to fill
/// @param signature Signature to confirm quote ownership
/// @param makingAmount Making amount
/// @param takingAmount Taking amount
/// @param target Address that will receive swap funds
function fillOrderRFQTo(
OrderRFQ memory order,
bytes calldata signature,
uint256 makingAmount,
uint256 takingAmount,
address payable target
) public payable returns(uint256 /* actualMakingAmount */, uint256 /* actualTakingAmount */) {
address maker = order.maker;
bool unwrapWETH = (order.info & _UNWRAP_WETH_MASK) > 0;
order.info = order.info & (_UNWRAP_WETH_MASK - 1); // zero-out unwrap weth flag as it is taker-only
{ // Stack too deep
uint256 info = order.info;
// Check time expiration
uint256 expiration = uint128(info) >> 64;
require(expiration == 0 || block.timestamp <= expiration, "LOP: order expired"); // solhint-disable-line not-rely-on-time
_invalidateOrder(maker, info);
}
{ // stack too deep
uint256 orderMakingAmount = order.makingAmount;
uint256 orderTakingAmount = order.takingAmount;
// Compute partial fill if needed
if (takingAmount == 0 && makingAmount == 0) {
// Two zeros means whole order
makingAmount = orderMakingAmount;
takingAmount = orderTakingAmount;
}
else if (takingAmount == 0) {
require(makingAmount <= orderMakingAmount, "LOP: making amount exceeded");
takingAmount = orderTakingAmount.mul(makingAmount).add(orderMakingAmount - 1).div(orderMakingAmount);
}
else if (makingAmount == 0) {
require(takingAmount <= orderTakingAmount, "LOP: taking amount exceeded");
makingAmount = orderMakingAmount.mul(takingAmount).div(orderTakingAmount);
}
else {
revert("LOP: one of amounts should be 0");
}
}
require(makingAmount > 0 && takingAmount > 0, "LOP: can't swap 0 amount");
// Validate order
require(order.allowedSender == address(0) || order.allowedSender == msg.sender, "LOP: private order");
bytes32 orderHash = _hashTypedDataV4(keccak256(abi.encode(LIMIT_ORDER_RFQ_TYPEHASH, order)));
_validate(maker, orderHash, signature);
// Maker => Taker
if (order.makerAsset == _WETH && unwrapWETH) {
order.makerAsset.safeTransferFrom(maker, address(this), makingAmount);
_WETH.withdraw(makingAmount);
target.transfer(makingAmount);
} else {
order.makerAsset.safeTransferFrom(maker, target, makingAmount);
}
// Taker => Maker
if (order.takerAsset == _WETH && msg.value > 0) {
require(msg.value == takingAmount, "LOP: wrong msg.value");
_WETH.deposit{ value: takingAmount }();
_WETH.transfer(maker, takingAmount);
} else {
require(msg.value == 0, "LOP: wrong msg.value");
order.takerAsset.safeTransferFrom(msg.sender, maker, takingAmount);
}
emit OrderFilledRFQ(orderHash, makingAmount);
return (makingAmount, takingAmount);
}
function _validate(address signer, bytes32 orderHash, bytes calldata signature) private view {
if (ECDSA.tryRecover(orderHash, signature) != signer) {
(bool success, bytes memory result) = signer.staticcall(
abi.encodeWithSelector(IERC1271.isValidSignature.selector, orderHash, signature)
);
require(success && result.length == 32 && abi.decode(result, (bytes4)) == IERC1271.isValidSignature.selector, "LOP: bad signature");
}
}
function _invalidateOrder(address maker, uint256 orderInfo) private {
uint256 invalidatorSlot = uint64(orderInfo) >> 8;
uint256 invalidatorBit = 1 << uint8(orderInfo);
mapping(uint256 => uint256) storage invalidatorStorage = _invalidator[maker];
uint256 invalidator = invalidatorStorage[invalidatorSlot];
require(invalidator & invalidatorBit == 0, "LOP: invalidated order");
invalidatorStorage[invalidatorSlot] = invalidator | invalidatorBit;
}
}
// File contracts/UnoswapRouter.sol
pragma solidity ^0.7.6;
contract UnoswapRouter is EthReceiver, Permitable {
uint256 private constant _TRANSFER_FROM_CALL_SELECTOR_32 = 0x23b872dd00000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000;
uint256 private constant _WETH_DEPOSIT_CALL_SELECTOR_32 = 0xd0e30db000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000;
uint256 private constant _WETH_WITHDRAW_CALL_SELECTOR_32 = 0x2e1a7d4d00000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000;
uint256 private constant _ERC20_TRANSFER_CALL_SELECTOR_32 = 0xa9059cbb00000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000;
uint256 private constant _ADDRESS_MASK = 0x000000000000000000000000ffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffff;
uint256 private constant _REVERSE_MASK = 0x8000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000;
uint256 private constant _WETH_MASK = 0x4000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000;
uint256 private constant _NUMERATOR_MASK = 0x0000000000000000ffffffff0000000000000000000000000000000000000000;
/// @dev WETH address is network-specific and needs to be changed before deployment.
/// It can not be moved to immutable as immutables are not supported in assembly
uint256 private constant _WETH = 0x000000000000000000000000C02aaA39b223FE8D0A0e5C4F27eAD9083C756Cc2;
uint256 private constant _UNISWAP_PAIR_RESERVES_CALL_SELECTOR_32 = 0x0902f1ac00000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000;
uint256 private constant _UNISWAP_PAIR_SWAP_CALL_SELECTOR_32 = 0x022c0d9f00000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000;
uint256 private constant _DENOMINATOR = 1000000000;
uint256 private constant _NUMERATOR_OFFSET = 160;
/// @notice Same as `unoswap` but calls permit first,
/// allowing to approve token spending and make a swap in one transaction.
/// @param srcToken Source token
/// @param amount Amount of source tokens to swap
/// @param minReturn Minimal allowed returnAmount to make transaction commit
/// @param pools Pools chain used for swaps. Pools src and dst tokens should match to make swap happen
/// @param permit Should contain valid permit that can be used in `IERC20Permit.permit` calls.
/// See tests for examples
function unoswapWithPermit(
IERC20 srcToken,
uint256 amount,
uint256 minReturn,
bytes32[] calldata pools,
bytes calldata permit
) external returns(uint256 returnAmount) {
_permit(address(srcToken), permit);
return unoswap(srcToken, amount, minReturn, pools);
}
/// @notice Performs swap using Uniswap exchange. Wraps and unwraps ETH if required.
/// Sending non-zero `msg.value` for anything but ETH swaps is prohibited
/// @param srcToken Source token
/// @param amount Amount of source tokens to swap
/// @param minReturn Minimal allowed returnAmount to make transaction commit
/// @param pools Pools chain used for swaps. Pools src and dst tokens should match to make swap happen
function unoswap(
IERC20 srcToken,
uint256 amount,
uint256 minReturn,
// solhint-disable-next-line no-unused-vars
bytes32[] calldata pools
) public payable returns(uint256 returnAmount) {
assembly { // solhint-disable-line no-inline-assembly
function reRevert() {
returndatacopy(0, 0, returndatasize())
revert(0, returndatasize())
}
function revertWithReason(m, len) {
mstore(0, 0x08c379a000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000)
mstore(0x20, 0x0000002000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000)
mstore(0x40, m)
revert(0, len)
}
function swap(emptyPtr, swapAmount, pair, reversed, numerator, dst) -> ret {
mstore(emptyPtr, _UNISWAP_PAIR_RESERVES_CALL_SELECTOR_32)
if iszero(staticcall(gas(), pair, emptyPtr, 0x4, emptyPtr, 0x40)) {
reRevert()
}
if iszero(eq(returndatasize(), 0x60)) {
revertWithReason(0x0000001472657365727665732063616c6c206661696c65640000000000000000, 0x59) // "reserves call failed"
}
let reserve0 := mload(emptyPtr)
let reserve1 := mload(add(emptyPtr, 0x20))
if reversed {
let tmp := reserve0
reserve0 := reserve1
reserve1 := tmp
}
ret := mul(swapAmount, numerator)
ret := div(mul(ret, reserve1), add(ret, mul(reserve0, _DENOMINATOR)))
mstore(emptyPtr, _UNISWAP_PAIR_SWAP_CALL_SELECTOR_32)
switch reversed
case 0 {
mstore(add(emptyPtr, 0x04), 0)
mstore(add(emptyPtr, 0x24), ret)
}
default {
mstore(add(emptyPtr, 0x04), ret)
mstore(add(emptyPtr, 0x24), 0)
}
mstore(add(emptyPtr, 0x44), dst)
mstore(add(emptyPtr, 0x64), 0x80)
mstore(add(emptyPtr, 0x84), 0)
if iszero(call(gas(), pair, 0, emptyPtr, 0xa4, 0, 0)) {
reRevert()
}
}
let emptyPtr := mload(0x40)
mstore(0x40, add(emptyPtr, 0xc0))
let poolsOffset := add(calldataload(0x64), 0x4)
let poolsEndOffset := calldataload(poolsOffset)
poolsOffset := add(poolsOffset, 0x20)
poolsEndOffset := add(poolsOffset, mul(0x20, poolsEndOffset))
let rawPair := calldataload(poolsOffset)
switch srcToken
case 0 {
if iszero(eq(amount, callvalue())) {
revertWithReason(0x00000011696e76616c6964206d73672e76616c75650000000000000000000000, 0x55) // "invalid msg.value"
}
mstore(emptyPtr, _WETH_DEPOSIT_CALL_SELECTOR_32)
if iszero(call(gas(), _WETH, amount, emptyPtr, 0x4, 0, 0)) {
reRevert()
}
mstore(emptyPtr, _ERC20_TRANSFER_CALL_SELECTOR_32)
mstore(add(emptyPtr, 0x4), and(rawPair, _ADDRESS_MASK))
mstore(add(emptyPtr, 0x24), amount)
if iszero(call(gas(), _WETH, 0, emptyPtr, 0x44, 0, 0)) {
reRevert()
}
}
default {
if callvalue() {
revertWithReason(0x00000011696e76616c6964206d73672e76616c75650000000000000000000000, 0x55) // "invalid msg.value"
}
mstore(emptyPtr, _TRANSFER_FROM_CALL_SELECTOR_32)
mstore(add(emptyPtr, 0x4), caller())
mstore(add(emptyPtr, 0x24), and(rawPair, _ADDRESS_MASK))
mstore(add(emptyPtr, 0x44), amount)
if iszero(call(gas(), srcToken, 0, emptyPtr, 0x64, 0, 0)) {
reRevert()
}
}
returnAmount := amount
for {let i := add(poolsOffset, 0x20)} lt(i, poolsEndOffset) {i := add(i, 0x20)} {
let nextRawPair := calldataload(i)
returnAmount := swap(
emptyPtr,
returnAmount,
and(rawPair, _ADDRESS_MASK),
and(rawPair, _REVERSE_MASK),
shr(_NUMERATOR_OFFSET, and(rawPair, _NUMERATOR_MASK)),
and(nextRawPair, _ADDRESS_MASK)
)
rawPair := nextRawPair
}
switch and(rawPair, _WETH_MASK)
case 0 {
returnAmount := swap(
emptyPtr,
returnAmount,
and(rawPair, _ADDRESS_MASK),
and(rawPair, _REVERSE_MASK),
shr(_NUMERATOR_OFFSET, and(rawPair, _NUMERATOR_MASK)),
caller()
)
}
default {
returnAmount := swap(
emptyPtr,
returnAmount,
and(rawPair, _ADDRESS_MASK),
and(rawPair, _REVERSE_MASK),
shr(_NUMERATOR_OFFSET, and(rawPair, _NUMERATOR_MASK)),
address()
)
mstore(emptyPtr, _WETH_WITHDRAW_CALL_SELECTOR_32)
mstore(add(emptyPtr, 0x04), returnAmount)
if iszero(call(gas(), _WETH, 0, emptyPtr, 0x24, 0, 0)) {
reRevert()
}
if iszero(call(gas(), caller(), returnAmount, 0, 0, 0, 0)) {
reRevert()
}
}
if lt(returnAmount, minReturn) {
revertWithReason(0x000000164d696e2072657475726e206e6f742072656163686564000000000000, 0x5a) // "Min return not reached"
}
}
}
}
// File @openzeppelin/contracts/utils/[email protected]
pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
/**
* @dev Wrappers over Solidity's uintXX/intXX casting operators with added overflow
* checks.
*
* Downcasting from uint256/int256 in Solidity does not revert on overflow. This can
* easily result in undesired exploitation or bugs, since developers usually
* assume that overflows raise errors. `SafeCast` restores this intuition by
* reverting the transaction when such an operation overflows.
*
* Using this library instead of the unchecked operations eliminates an entire
* class of bugs, so it's recommended to use it always.
*
* Can be combined with {SafeMath} and {SignedSafeMath} to extend it to smaller types, by performing
* all math on `uint256` and `int256` and then downcasting.
*/
library SafeCast {
/**
* @dev Returns the downcasted uint128 from uint256, reverting on
* overflow (when the input is greater than largest uint128).
*
* Counterpart to Solidity's `uint128` operator.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - input must fit into 128 bits
*/
function toUint128(uint256 value) internal pure returns (uint128) {
require(value < 2**128, "SafeCast: value doesn\'t fit in 128 bits");
return uint128(value);
}
/**
* @dev Returns the downcasted uint64 from uint256, reverting on
* overflow (when the input is greater than largest uint64).
*
* Counterpart to Solidity's `uint64` operator.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - input must fit into 64 bits
*/
function toUint64(uint256 value) internal pure returns (uint64) {
require(value < 2**64, "SafeCast: value doesn\'t fit in 64 bits");
return uint64(value);
}
/**
* @dev Returns the downcasted uint32 from uint256, reverting on
* overflow (when the input is greater than largest uint32).
*
* Counterpart to Solidity's `uint32` operator.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - input must fit into 32 bits
*/
function toUint32(uint256 value) internal pure returns (uint32) {
require(value < 2**32, "SafeCast: value doesn\'t fit in 32 bits");
return uint32(value);
}
/**
* @dev Returns the downcasted uint16 from uint256, reverting on
* overflow (when the input is greater than largest uint16).
*
* Counterpart to Solidity's `uint16` operator.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - input must fit into 16 bits
*/
function toUint16(uint256 value) internal pure returns (uint16) {
require(value < 2**16, "SafeCast: value doesn\'t fit in 16 bits");
return uint16(value);
}
/**
* @dev Returns the downcasted uint8 from uint256, reverting on
* overflow (when the input is greater than largest uint8).
*
* Counterpart to Solidity's `uint8` operator.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - input must fit into 8 bits.
*/
function toUint8(uint256 value) internal pure returns (uint8) {
require(value < 2**8, "SafeCast: value doesn\'t fit in 8 bits");
return uint8(value);
}
/**
* @dev Converts a signed int256 into an unsigned uint256.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - input must be greater than or equal to 0.
*/
function toUint256(int256 value) internal pure returns (uint256) {
require(value >= 0, "SafeCast: value must be positive");
return uint256(value);
}
/**
* @dev Returns the downcasted int128 from int256, reverting on
* overflow (when the input is less than smallest int128 or
* greater than largest int128).
*
* Counterpart to Solidity's `int128` operator.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - input must fit into 128 bits
*
* _Available since v3.1._
*/
function toInt128(int256 value) internal pure returns (int128) {
require(value >= -2**127 && value < 2**127, "SafeCast: value doesn\'t fit in 128 bits");
return int128(value);
}
/**
* @dev Returns the downcasted int64 from int256, reverting on
* overflow (when the input is less than smallest int64 or
* greater than largest int64).
*
* Counterpart to Solidity's `int64` operator.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - input must fit into 64 bits
*
* _Available since v3.1._
*/
function toInt64(int256 value) internal pure returns (int64) {
require(value >= -2**63 && value < 2**63, "SafeCast: value doesn\'t fit in 64 bits");
return int64(value);
}
/**
* @dev Returns the downcasted int32 from int256, reverting on
* overflow (when the input is less than smallest int32 or
* greater than largest int32).
*
* Counterpart to Solidity's `int32` operator.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - input must fit into 32 bits
*
* _Available since v3.1._
*/
function toInt32(int256 value) internal pure returns (int32) {
require(value >= -2**31 && value < 2**31, "SafeCast: value doesn\'t fit in 32 bits");
return int32(value);
}
/**
* @dev Returns the downcasted int16 from int256, reverting on
* overflow (when the input is less than smallest int16 or
* greater than largest int16).
*
* Counterpart to Solidity's `int16` operator.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - input must fit into 16 bits
*
* _Available since v3.1._
*/
function toInt16(int256 value) internal pure returns (int16) {
require(value >= -2**15 && value < 2**15, "SafeCast: value doesn\'t fit in 16 bits");
return int16(value);
}
/**
* @dev Returns the downcasted int8 from int256, reverting on
* overflow (when the input is less than smallest int8 or
* greater than largest int8).
*
* Counterpart to Solidity's `int8` operator.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - input must fit into 8 bits.
*
* _Available since v3.1._
*/
function toInt8(int256 value) internal pure returns (int8) {
require(value >= -2**7 && value < 2**7, "SafeCast: value doesn\'t fit in 8 bits");
return int8(value);
}
/**
* @dev Converts an unsigned uint256 into a signed int256.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - input must be less than or equal to maxInt256.
*/
function toInt256(uint256 value) internal pure returns (int256) {
require(value < 2**255, "SafeCast: value doesn't fit in an int256");
return int256(value);
}
}
// File contracts/interfaces/IUniswapV3Pool.sol
pragma solidity ^0.7.6;
interface IUniswapV3Pool {
/// @notice Swap token0 for token1, or token1 for token0
/// @dev The caller of this method receives a callback in the form of IUniswapV3SwapCallback#uniswapV3SwapCallback
/// @param recipient The address to receive the output of the swap
/// @param zeroForOne The direction of the swap, true for token0 to token1, false for token1 to token0
/// @param amountSpecified The amount of the swap, which implicitly configures the swap as exact input (positive), or exact output (negative)
/// @param sqrtPriceLimitX96 The Q64.96 sqrt price limit. If zero for one, the price cannot be less than this
/// value after the swap. If one for zero, the price cannot be greater than this value after the swap
/// @param data Any data to be passed through to the callback
/// @return amount0 The delta of the balance of token0 of the pool, exact when negative, minimum when positive
/// @return amount1 The delta of the balance of token1 of the pool, exact when negative, minimum when positive
function swap(
address recipient,
bool zeroForOne,
int256 amountSpecified,
uint160 sqrtPriceLimitX96,
bytes calldata data
) external returns (int256 amount0, int256 amount1);
/// @notice The first of the two tokens of the pool, sorted by address
/// @return The token contract address
function token0() external view returns (address);
/// @notice The second of the two tokens of the pool, sorted by address
/// @return The token contract address
function token1() external view returns (address);
/// @notice The pool's fee in hundredths of a bip, i.e. 1e-6
/// @return The fee
function fee() external view returns (uint24);
}
// File contracts/interfaces/IUniswapV3SwapCallback.sol
pragma solidity ^0.7.6;
/// @title Callback for IUniswapV3PoolActions#swap
/// @notice Any contract that calls IUniswapV3PoolActions#swap must implement this interface
interface IUniswapV3SwapCallback {
/// @notice Called to `msg.sender` after executing a swap via IUniswapV3Pool#swap.
/// @dev In the implementation you must pay the pool tokens owed for the swap.
/// The caller of this method must be checked to be a UniswapV3Pool deployed by the canonical UniswapV3Factory.
/// amount0Delta and amount1Delta can both be 0 if no tokens were swapped.
/// @param amount0Delta The amount of token0 that was sent (negative) or must be received (positive) by the pool by
/// the end of the swap. If positive, the callback must send that amount of token0 to the pool.
/// @param amount1Delta The amount of token1 that was sent (negative) or must be received (positive) by the pool by
/// the end of the swap. If positive, the callback must send that amount of token1 to the pool.
/// @param data Any data passed through by the caller via the IUniswapV3PoolActions#swap call
function uniswapV3SwapCallback(
int256 amount0Delta,
int256 amount1Delta,
bytes calldata data
) external;
}
// File contracts/UnoswapV3Router.sol
pragma solidity ^0.7.6;
contract UnoswapV3Router is EthReceiver, Permitable, IUniswapV3SwapCallback {
using Address for address payable;
using SafeERC20 for IERC20;
using SafeMath for uint256;
uint256 private constant _ONE_FOR_ZERO_MASK = 1 << 255;
uint256 private constant _WETH_WRAP_MASK = 1 << 254;
uint256 private constant _WETH_UNWRAP_MASK = 1 << 253;
bytes32 private constant _POOL_INIT_CODE_HASH = 0xe34f199b19b2b4f47f68442619d555527d244f78a3297ea89325f843f87b8b54;
bytes32 private constant _FF_FACTORY = 0xff1F98431c8aD98523631AE4a59f267346ea31F9840000000000000000000000;
bytes32 private constant _SELECTORS = 0x0dfe1681d21220a7ddca3f430000000000000000000000000000000000000000;
uint256 private constant _ADDRESS_MASK = 0x000000000000000000000000ffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffff;
/// @dev The minimum value that can be returned from #getSqrtRatioAtTick. Equivalent to getSqrtRatioAtTick(MIN_TICK)
uint160 private constant _MIN_SQRT_RATIO = 4295128739 + 1;
/// @dev The maximum value that can be returned from #getSqrtRatioAtTick. Equivalent to getSqrtRatioAtTick(MAX_TICK)
uint160 private constant _MAX_SQRT_RATIO = 1461446703485210103287273052203988822378723970342 - 1;
IWETH private immutable _WETH; // solhint-disable-line var-name-mixedcase
constructor(address weth) {
_WETH = IWETH(weth);
}
/// @notice Same as `uniswapV3SwapTo` but calls permit first,
/// allowing to approve token spending and make a swap in one transaction.
/// @param recipient Address that will receive swap funds
/// @param srcToken Source token
/// @param amount Amount of source tokens to swap
/// @param minReturn Minimal allowed returnAmount to make transaction commit
/// @param pools Pools chain used for swaps. Pools src and dst tokens should match to make swap happen
/// @param permit Should contain valid permit that can be used in `IERC20Permit.permit` calls.
/// See tests for examples
function uniswapV3SwapToWithPermit(
address payable recipient,
IERC20 srcToken,
uint256 amount,
uint256 minReturn,
uint256[] calldata pools,
bytes calldata permit
) external returns(uint256 returnAmount) {
_permit(address(srcToken), permit);
return uniswapV3SwapTo(recipient, amount, minReturn, pools);
}
/// @notice Same as `uniswapV3SwapTo` but uses `msg.sender` as recipient
/// @param amount Amount of source tokens to swap
/// @param minReturn Minimal allowed returnAmount to make transaction commit
/// @param pools Pools chain used for swaps. Pools src and dst tokens should match to make swap happen
function uniswapV3Swap(
uint256 amount,
uint256 minReturn,
uint256[] calldata pools
) external payable returns(uint256 returnAmount) {
return uniswapV3SwapTo(msg.sender, amount, minReturn, pools);
}
/// @notice Performs swap using Uniswap V3 exchange. Wraps and unwraps ETH if required.
/// Sending non-zero `msg.value` for anything but ETH swaps is prohibited
/// @param recipient Address that will receive swap funds
/// @param amount Amount of source tokens to swap
/// @param minReturn Minimal allowed returnAmount to make transaction commit
/// @param pools Pools chain used for swaps. Pools src and dst tokens should match to make swap happen
function uniswapV3SwapTo(
address payable recipient,
uint256 amount,
uint256 minReturn,
uint256[] calldata pools
) public payable returns(uint256 returnAmount) {
uint256 len = pools.length;
require(len > 0, "UNIV3R: empty pools");
uint256 lastIndex = len - 1;
returnAmount = amount;
bool wrapWeth = pools[0] & _WETH_WRAP_MASK > 0;
bool unwrapWeth = pools[lastIndex] & _WETH_UNWRAP_MASK > 0;
if (wrapWeth) {
require(msg.value == amount, "UNIV3R: wrong msg.value");
_WETH.deposit{value: amount}();
} else {
require(msg.value == 0, "UNIV3R: msg.value should be 0");
}
if (len > 1) {
returnAmount = _makeSwap(address(this), wrapWeth ? address(this) : msg.sender, pools[0], returnAmount);
for (uint256 i = 1; i < lastIndex; i++) {
returnAmount = _makeSwap(address(this), address(this), pools[i], returnAmount);
}
returnAmount = _makeSwap(unwrapWeth ? address(this) : recipient, address(this), pools[lastIndex], returnAmount);
} else {
returnAmount = _makeSwap(unwrapWeth ? address(this) : recipient, wrapWeth ? address(this) : msg.sender, pools[0], returnAmount);
}
require(returnAmount >= minReturn, "UNIV3R: min return");
if (unwrapWeth) {
_WETH.withdraw(returnAmount);
recipient.sendValue(returnAmount);
}
}
/// @inheritdoc IUniswapV3SwapCallback
function uniswapV3SwapCallback(
int256 amount0Delta,
int256 amount1Delta,
bytes calldata /* data */
) external override {
IERC20 token0;
IERC20 token1;
bytes32 ffFactoryAddress = _FF_FACTORY;
bytes32 poolInitCodeHash = _POOL_INIT_CODE_HASH;
address payer;
assembly { // solhint-disable-line no-inline-assembly
function reRevert() {
returndatacopy(0, 0, returndatasize())
revert(0, returndatasize())
}
function revertWithReason(m, len) {
mstore(0x00, 0x08c379a000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000)
mstore(0x20, 0x0000002000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000)
mstore(0x40, m)
revert(0, len)
}
let emptyPtr := mload(0x40)
let resultPtr := add(emptyPtr, 0x20)
mstore(emptyPtr, _SELECTORS)
if iszero(staticcall(gas(), caller(), emptyPtr, 0x4, resultPtr, 0x20)) {
reRevert()
}
token0 := mload(resultPtr)
if iszero(staticcall(gas(), caller(), add(emptyPtr, 0x4), 0x4, resultPtr, 0x20)) {
reRevert()
}
token1 := mload(resultPtr)
if iszero(staticcall(gas(), caller(), add(emptyPtr, 0x8), 0x4, resultPtr, 0x20)) {
reRevert()
}
let fee := mload(resultPtr)
let p := emptyPtr
mstore(p, ffFactoryAddress)
p := add(p, 21)
// Compute the inner hash in-place
mstore(p, token0)
mstore(add(p, 32), token1)
mstore(add(p, 64), fee)
mstore(p, keccak256(p, 96))
p := add(p, 32)
mstore(p, poolInitCodeHash)
let pool := and(keccak256(emptyPtr, 85), _ADDRESS_MASK)
if iszero(eq(pool, caller())) {
revertWithReason(0x00000010554e495633523a2062616420706f6f6c000000000000000000000000, 0x54) // UNIV3R: bad pool
}
calldatacopy(emptyPtr, 0x84, 0x20)
payer := mload(emptyPtr)
}
if (amount0Delta > 0) {
if (payer == address(this)) {
token0.safeTransfer(msg.sender, uint256(amount0Delta));
} else {
token0.safeTransferFrom(payer, msg.sender, uint256(amount0Delta));
}
}
if (amount1Delta > 0) {
if (payer == address(this)) {
token1.safeTransfer(msg.sender, uint256(amount1Delta));
} else {
token1.safeTransferFrom(payer, msg.sender, uint256(amount1Delta));
}
}
}
function _makeSwap(address recipient, address payer, uint256 pool, uint256 amount) private returns (uint256) {
bool zeroForOne = pool & _ONE_FOR_ZERO_MASK == 0;
if (zeroForOne) {
(, int256 amount1) = IUniswapV3Pool(pool).swap(
recipient,
zeroForOne,
SafeCast.toInt256(amount),
_MIN_SQRT_RATIO,
abi.encode(payer)
);
return SafeCast.toUint256(-amount1);
} else {
(int256 amount0,) = IUniswapV3Pool(pool).swap(
recipient,
zeroForOne,
SafeCast.toInt256(amount),
_MAX_SQRT_RATIO,
abi.encode(payer)
);
return SafeCast.toUint256(-amount0);
}
}
}
// File contracts/interfaces/IClipperExchangeInterface.sol
pragma solidity ^0.7.6;
/// @title Clipper interface subset used in swaps
interface IClipperExchangeInterface {
function sellTokenForToken(IERC20 inputToken, IERC20 outputToken, address recipient, uint256 minBuyAmount, bytes calldata auxiliaryData) external returns (uint256 boughtAmount);
function sellEthForToken(IERC20 outputToken, address recipient, uint256 minBuyAmount, bytes calldata auxiliaryData) external payable returns (uint256 boughtAmount);
function sellTokenForEth(IERC20 inputToken, address payable recipient, uint256 minBuyAmount, bytes calldata auxiliaryData) external returns (uint256 boughtAmount);
function theExchange() external returns (address payable);
}
// File contracts/ClipperRouter.sol
pragma solidity ^0.7.6;
/// @title Clipper router that allows to use `ClipperExchangeInterface` for swaps
contract ClipperRouter is EthReceiver, Permitable {
using SafeERC20 for IERC20;
IWETH private immutable _WETH; // solhint-disable-line var-name-mixedcase
IERC20 private constant _ETH = IERC20(address(0));
bytes private constant _INCH_TAG = "1INCH";
IClipperExchangeInterface private immutable _clipperExchange;
address payable private immutable _clipperPool;
constructor(
address weth,
IClipperExchangeInterface clipperExchange
) {
_clipperExchange = clipperExchange;
_clipperPool = clipperExchange.theExchange();
_WETH = IWETH(weth);
}
/// @notice Same as `clipperSwapTo` but calls permit first,
/// allowing to approve token spending and make a swap in one transaction.
/// @param recipient Address that will receive swap funds
/// @param srcToken Source token
/// @param dstToken Destination token
/// @param amount Amount of source tokens to swap
/// @param minReturn Minimal allowed returnAmount to make transaction commit
/// @param permit Should contain valid permit that can be used in `IERC20Permit.permit` calls.
/// See tests for examples
function clipperSwapToWithPermit(
address payable recipient,
IERC20 srcToken,
IERC20 dstToken,
uint256 amount,
uint256 minReturn,
bytes calldata permit
) external returns(uint256 returnAmount) {
_permit(address(srcToken), permit);
return clipperSwapTo(recipient, srcToken, dstToken, amount, minReturn);
}
/// @notice Same as `clipperSwapTo` but uses `msg.sender` as recipient
/// @param srcToken Source token
/// @param dstToken Destination token
/// @param amount Amount of source tokens to swap
/// @param minReturn Minimal allowed returnAmount to make transaction commit
function clipperSwap(
IERC20 srcToken,
IERC20 dstToken,
uint256 amount,
uint256 minReturn
) external payable returns(uint256 returnAmount) {
return clipperSwapTo(msg.sender, srcToken, dstToken, amount, minReturn);
}
/// @notice Performs swap using Clipper exchange. Wraps and unwraps ETH if required.
/// Sending non-zero `msg.value` for anything but ETH swaps is prohibited
/// @param recipient Address that will receive swap funds
/// @param srcToken Source token
/// @param dstToken Destination token
/// @param amount Amount of source tokens to swap
/// @param minReturn Minimal allowed returnAmount to make transaction commit
function clipperSwapTo(
address payable recipient,
IERC20 srcToken,
IERC20 dstToken,
uint256 amount,
uint256 minReturn
) public payable returns(uint256 returnAmount) {
bool srcETH;
if (srcToken == _WETH) {
require(msg.value == 0, "CL1IN: msg.value should be 0");
_WETH.transferFrom(msg.sender, address(this), amount);
_WETH.withdraw(amount);
srcETH = true;
}
else if (srcToken == _ETH) {
require(msg.value == amount, "CL1IN: wrong msg.value");
srcETH = true;
}
else {
require(msg.value == 0, "CL1IN: msg.value should be 0");
srcToken.safeTransferFrom(msg.sender, _clipperPool, amount);
}
if (srcETH) {
_clipperPool.transfer(amount);
returnAmount = _clipperExchange.sellEthForToken(dstToken, recipient, minReturn, _INCH_TAG);
} else if (dstToken == _WETH) {
returnAmount = _clipperExchange.sellTokenForEth(srcToken, address(this), minReturn, _INCH_TAG);
_WETH.deposit{ value: returnAmount }();
_WETH.transfer(recipient, returnAmount);
} else if (dstToken == _ETH) {
returnAmount = _clipperExchange.sellTokenForEth(srcToken, recipient, minReturn, _INCH_TAG);
} else {
returnAmount = _clipperExchange.sellTokenForToken(srcToken, dstToken, recipient, minReturn, _INCH_TAG);
}
}
}
// File contracts/AggregationRouterV4.sol
pragma solidity ^0.7.6;
contract AggregationRouterV4 is Ownable, EthReceiver, Permitable, UnoswapRouter, UnoswapV3Router, LimitOrderProtocolRFQ, ClipperRouter {
using SafeMath for uint256;
using UniERC20 for IERC20;
using SafeERC20 for IERC20;
uint256 private constant _PARTIAL_FILL = 1 << 0;
uint256 private constant _REQUIRES_EXTRA_ETH = 1 << 1;
struct SwapDescription {
IERC20 srcToken;
IERC20 dstToken;
address payable srcReceiver;
address payable dstReceiver;
uint256 amount;
uint256 minReturnAmount;
uint256 flags;
bytes permit;
}
constructor(address weth, IClipperExchangeInterface _clipperExchange)
UnoswapV3Router(weth)
LimitOrderProtocolRFQ(weth)
ClipperRouter(weth, _clipperExchange)
{} // solhint-disable-line no-empty-blocks
/// @notice Performs a swap, delegating all calls encoded in `data` to `caller`. See tests for usage examples
/// @param caller Aggregation executor that executes calls described in `data`
/// @param desc Swap description
/// @param data Encoded calls that `caller` should execute in between of swaps
/// @return returnAmount Resulting token amount
/// @return spentAmount Source token amount
/// @return gasLeft Gas left
function swap(
IAggregationExecutor caller,
SwapDescription calldata desc,
bytes calldata data
)
external
payable
returns (
uint256 returnAmount,
uint256 spentAmount,
uint256 gasLeft
)
{
require(desc.minReturnAmount > 0, "Min return should not be 0");
require(data.length > 0, "data should not be empty");
uint256 flags = desc.flags;
IERC20 srcToken = desc.srcToken;
IERC20 dstToken = desc.dstToken;
bool srcETH = srcToken.isETH();
if (flags & _REQUIRES_EXTRA_ETH != 0) {
require(msg.value > (srcETH ? desc.amount : 0), "Invalid msg.value");
} else {
require(msg.value == (srcETH ? desc.amount : 0), "Invalid msg.value");
}
if (!srcETH) {
_permit(address(srcToken), desc.permit);
srcToken.safeTransferFrom(msg.sender, desc.srcReceiver, desc.amount);
}
{
bytes memory callData = abi.encodePacked(caller.callBytes.selector, bytes12(0), msg.sender, data);
// solhint-disable-next-line avoid-low-level-calls
(bool success, bytes memory result) = address(caller).call{value: msg.value}(callData);
if (!success) {
revert(RevertReasonParser.parse(result, "callBytes failed: "));
}
}
spentAmount = desc.amount;
returnAmount = dstToken.uniBalanceOf(address(this));
if (flags & _PARTIAL_FILL != 0) {
uint256 unspentAmount = srcToken.uniBalanceOf(address(this));
if (unspentAmount > 0) {
spentAmount = spentAmount.sub(unspentAmount);
srcToken.uniTransfer(msg.sender, unspentAmount);
}
require(returnAmount.mul(desc.amount) >= desc.minReturnAmount.mul(spentAmount), "Return amount is not enough");
} else {
require(returnAmount >= desc.minReturnAmount, "Return amount is not enough");
}
address payable dstReceiver = (desc.dstReceiver == address(0)) ? msg.sender : desc.dstReceiver;
dstToken.uniTransfer(dstReceiver, returnAmount);
gasLeft = gasleft();
}
function rescueFunds(IERC20 token, uint256 amount) external onlyOwner {
token.uniTransfer(msg.sender, amount);
}
function destroy() external onlyOwner {
selfdestruct(msg.sender);
}
}File 7 of 8: Proxy
pragma solidity ^0.5.3; /// @title Proxy - Generic proxy contract allows to execute all transactions applying the code of a master contract. /// @author Stefan George - <[email protected]> /// @author Richard Meissner - <[email protected]> contract Proxy { // masterCopy always needs to be first declared variable, to ensure that it is at the same location in the contracts to which calls are delegated. // To reduce deployment costs this variable is internal and needs to be retrieved via `getStorageAt` address internal masterCopy; /// @dev Constructor function sets address of master copy contract. /// @param _masterCopy Master copy address. constructor(address _masterCopy) public { require(_masterCopy != address(0), "Invalid master copy address provided"); masterCopy = _masterCopy; } /// @dev Fallback function forwards all transactions and returns all received return data. function () external payable { // solium-disable-next-line security/no-inline-assembly assembly { let masterCopy := and(sload(0), 0xffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffff) // 0xa619486e == keccak("masterCopy()"). The value is right padded to 32-bytes with 0s if eq(calldataload(0), 0xa619486e00000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000) { mstore(0, masterCopy) return(0, 0x20) } calldatacopy(0, 0, calldatasize()) let success := delegatecall(gas, masterCopy, 0, calldatasize(), 0, 0) returndatacopy(0, 0, returndatasize()) if eq(success, 0) { revert(0, returndatasize()) } return(0, returndatasize()) } } }
File 8 of 8: GnosisSafe
pragma solidity >=0.5.0 <0.7.0; /// @title SelfAuthorized - authorizes current contract to perform actions /// @author Richard Meissner - <[email protected]> contract SelfAuthorized { modifier authorized() { require(msg.sender == address(this), "Method can only be called from this contract"); _; } } /// @title MasterCopy - Base for master copy contracts (should always be first super contract) /// This contract is tightly coupled to our proxy contract (see `proxies/Proxy.sol`) /// @author Richard Meissner - <[email protected]> contract MasterCopy is SelfAuthorized { event ChangedMasterCopy(address masterCopy); // masterCopy always needs to be first declared variable, to ensure that it is at the same location as in the Proxy contract. // It should also always be ensured that the address is stored alone (uses a full word) address private masterCopy; /// @dev Allows to upgrade the contract. This can only be done via a Safe transaction. /// @param _masterCopy New contract address. function changeMasterCopy(address _masterCopy) public authorized { // Master copy address cannot be null. require(_masterCopy != address(0), "Invalid master copy address provided"); masterCopy = _masterCopy; emit ChangedMasterCopy(_masterCopy); } } /// @title Module - Base class for modules. /// @author Stefan George - <[email protected]> /// @author Richard Meissner - <[email protected]> contract Module is MasterCopy { ModuleManager public manager; modifier authorized() { require(msg.sender == address(manager), "Method can only be called from manager"); _; } function setManager() internal { // manager can only be 0 at initalization of contract. // Check ensures that setup function can only be called once. require(address(manager) == address(0), "Manager has already been set"); manager = ModuleManager(msg.sender); } } /// @title Enum - Collection of enums /// @author Richard Meissner - <[email protected]> contract Enum { enum Operation { Call, DelegateCall } } /// @title Executor - A contract that can execute transactions /// @author Richard Meissner - <[email protected]> contract Executor { function execute(address to, uint256 value, bytes memory data, Enum.Operation operation, uint256 txGas) internal returns (bool success) { if (operation == Enum.Operation.Call) success = executeCall(to, value, data, txGas); else if (operation == Enum.Operation.DelegateCall) success = executeDelegateCall(to, data, txGas); else success = false; } function executeCall(address to, uint256 value, bytes memory data, uint256 txGas) internal returns (bool success) { // solium-disable-next-line security/no-inline-assembly assembly { success := call(txGas, to, value, add(data, 0x20), mload(data), 0, 0) } } function executeDelegateCall(address to, bytes memory data, uint256 txGas) internal returns (bool success) { // solium-disable-next-line security/no-inline-assembly assembly { success := delegatecall(txGas, to, add(data, 0x20), mload(data), 0, 0) } } } /// @title SecuredTokenTransfer - Secure token transfer /// @author Richard Meissner - <[email protected]> contract SecuredTokenTransfer { /// @dev Transfers a token and returns if it was a success /// @param token Token that should be transferred /// @param receiver Receiver to whom the token should be transferred /// @param amount The amount of tokens that should be transferred function transferToken ( address token, address receiver, uint256 amount ) internal returns (bool transferred) { bytes memory data = abi.encodeWithSignature("transfer(address,uint256)", receiver, amount); // solium-disable-next-line security/no-inline-assembly assembly { let success := call(sub(gas, 10000), token, 0, add(data, 0x20), mload(data), 0, 0) let ptr := mload(0x40) mstore(0x40, add(ptr, returndatasize())) returndatacopy(ptr, 0, returndatasize()) switch returndatasize() case 0 { transferred := success } case 0x20 { transferred := iszero(or(iszero(success), iszero(mload(ptr)))) } default { transferred := 0 } } } } /// @title Module Manager - A contract that manages modules that can execute transactions via this contract /// @author Stefan George - <[email protected]> /// @author Richard Meissner - <[email protected]> contract ModuleManager is SelfAuthorized, Executor { event EnabledModule(Module module); event DisabledModule(Module module); event ExecutionFromModuleSuccess(address indexed module); event ExecutionFromModuleFailure(address indexed module); address internal constant SENTINEL_MODULES = address(0x1); mapping (address => address) internal modules; function setupModules(address to, bytes memory data) internal { require(modules[SENTINEL_MODULES] == address(0), "Modules have already been initialized"); modules[SENTINEL_MODULES] = SENTINEL_MODULES; if (to != address(0)) // Setup has to complete successfully or transaction fails. require(executeDelegateCall(to, data, gasleft()), "Could not finish initialization"); } /// @dev Allows to add a module to the whitelist. /// This can only be done via a Safe transaction. /// @param module Module to be whitelisted. function enableModule(Module module) public authorized { // Module address cannot be null or sentinel. require(address(module) != address(0) && address(module) != SENTINEL_MODULES, "Invalid module address provided"); // Module cannot be added twice. require(modules[address(module)] == address(0), "Module has already been added"); modules[address(module)] = modules[SENTINEL_MODULES]; modules[SENTINEL_MODULES] = address(module); emit EnabledModule(module); } /// @dev Allows to remove a module from the whitelist. /// This can only be done via a Safe transaction. /// @param prevModule Module that pointed to the module to be removed in the linked list /// @param module Module to be removed. function disableModule(Module prevModule, Module module) public authorized { // Validate module address and check that it corresponds to module index. require(address(module) != address(0) && address(module) != SENTINEL_MODULES, "Invalid module address provided"); require(modules[address(prevModule)] == address(module), "Invalid prevModule, module pair provided"); modules[address(prevModule)] = modules[address(module)]; modules[address(module)] = address(0); emit DisabledModule(module); } /// @dev Allows a Module to execute a Safe transaction without any further confirmations. /// @param to Destination address of module transaction. /// @param value Ether value of module transaction. /// @param data Data payload of module transaction. /// @param operation Operation type of module transaction. function execTransactionFromModule(address to, uint256 value, bytes memory data, Enum.Operation operation) public returns (bool success) { // Only whitelisted modules are allowed. require(msg.sender != SENTINEL_MODULES && modules[msg.sender] != address(0), "Method can only be called from an enabled module"); // Execute transaction without further confirmations. success = execute(to, value, data, operation, gasleft()); if (success) emit ExecutionFromModuleSuccess(msg.sender); else emit ExecutionFromModuleFailure(msg.sender); } /// @dev Allows a Module to execute a Safe transaction without any further confirmations and return data /// @param to Destination address of module transaction. /// @param value Ether value of module transaction. /// @param data Data payload of module transaction. /// @param operation Operation type of module transaction. function execTransactionFromModuleReturnData(address to, uint256 value, bytes memory data, Enum.Operation operation) public returns (bool success, bytes memory returnData) { success = execTransactionFromModule(to, value, data, operation); // solium-disable-next-line security/no-inline-assembly assembly { // Load free memory location let ptr := mload(0x40) // We allocate memory for the return data by setting the free memory location to // current free memory location + data size + 32 bytes for data size value mstore(0x40, add(ptr, add(returndatasize(), 0x20))) // Store the size mstore(ptr, returndatasize()) // Store the data returndatacopy(add(ptr, 0x20), 0, returndatasize()) // Point the return data to the correct memory location returnData := ptr } } /// @dev Returns array of first 10 modules. /// @return Array of modules. function getModules() public view returns (address[] memory) { (address[] memory array,) = getModulesPaginated(SENTINEL_MODULES, 10); return array; } /// @dev Returns array of modules. /// @param start Start of the page. /// @param pageSize Maximum number of modules that should be returned. /// @return Array of modules. function getModulesPaginated(address start, uint256 pageSize) public view returns (address[] memory array, address next) { // Init array with max page size array = new address[](pageSize); // Populate return array uint256 moduleCount = 0; address currentModule = modules[start]; while(currentModule != address(0x0) && currentModule != SENTINEL_MODULES && moduleCount < pageSize) { array[moduleCount] = currentModule; currentModule = modules[currentModule]; moduleCount++; } next = currentModule; // Set correct size of returned array // solium-disable-next-line security/no-inline-assembly assembly { mstore(array, moduleCount) } } } /// @title OwnerManager - Manages a set of owners and a threshold to perform actions. /// @author Stefan George - <[email protected]> /// @author Richard Meissner - <[email protected]> contract OwnerManager is SelfAuthorized { event AddedOwner(address owner); event RemovedOwner(address owner); event ChangedThreshold(uint256 threshold); address internal constant SENTINEL_OWNERS = address(0x1); mapping(address => address) internal owners; uint256 ownerCount; uint256 internal threshold; /// @dev Setup function sets initial storage of contract. /// @param _owners List of Safe owners. /// @param _threshold Number of required confirmations for a Safe transaction. function setupOwners(address[] memory _owners, uint256 _threshold) internal { // Threshold can only be 0 at initialization. // Check ensures that setup function can only be called once. require(threshold == 0, "Owners have already been setup"); // Validate that threshold is smaller than number of added owners. require(_threshold <= _owners.length, "Threshold cannot exceed owner count"); // There has to be at least one Safe owner. require(_threshold >= 1, "Threshold needs to be greater than 0"); // Initializing Safe owners. address currentOwner = SENTINEL_OWNERS; for (uint256 i = 0; i < _owners.length; i++) { // Owner address cannot be null. address owner = _owners[i]; require(owner != address(0) && owner != SENTINEL_OWNERS, "Invalid owner address provided"); // No duplicate owners allowed. require(owners[owner] == address(0), "Duplicate owner address provided"); owners[currentOwner] = owner; currentOwner = owner; } owners[currentOwner] = SENTINEL_OWNERS; ownerCount = _owners.length; threshold = _threshold; } /// @dev Allows to add a new owner to the Safe and update the threshold at the same time. /// This can only be done via a Safe transaction. /// @param owner New owner address. /// @param _threshold New threshold. function addOwnerWithThreshold(address owner, uint256 _threshold) public authorized { // Owner address cannot be null. require(owner != address(0) && owner != SENTINEL_OWNERS, "Invalid owner address provided"); // No duplicate owners allowed. require(owners[owner] == address(0), "Address is already an owner"); owners[owner] = owners[SENTINEL_OWNERS]; owners[SENTINEL_OWNERS] = owner; ownerCount++; emit AddedOwner(owner); // Change threshold if threshold was changed. if (threshold != _threshold) changeThreshold(_threshold); } /// @dev Allows to remove an owner from the Safe and update the threshold at the same time. /// This can only be done via a Safe transaction. /// @param prevOwner Owner that pointed to the owner to be removed in the linked list /// @param owner Owner address to be removed. /// @param _threshold New threshold. function removeOwner(address prevOwner, address owner, uint256 _threshold) public authorized { // Only allow to remove an owner, if threshold can still be reached. require(ownerCount - 1 >= _threshold, "New owner count needs to be larger than new threshold"); // Validate owner address and check that it corresponds to owner index. require(owner != address(0) && owner != SENTINEL_OWNERS, "Invalid owner address provided"); require(owners[prevOwner] == owner, "Invalid prevOwner, owner pair provided"); owners[prevOwner] = owners[owner]; owners[owner] = address(0); ownerCount--; emit RemovedOwner(owner); // Change threshold if threshold was changed. if (threshold != _threshold) changeThreshold(_threshold); } /// @dev Allows to swap/replace an owner from the Safe with another address. /// This can only be done via a Safe transaction. /// @param prevOwner Owner that pointed to the owner to be replaced in the linked list /// @param oldOwner Owner address to be replaced. /// @param newOwner New owner address. function swapOwner(address prevOwner, address oldOwner, address newOwner) public authorized { // Owner address cannot be null. require(newOwner != address(0) && newOwner != SENTINEL_OWNERS, "Invalid owner address provided"); // No duplicate owners allowed. require(owners[newOwner] == address(0), "Address is already an owner"); // Validate oldOwner address and check that it corresponds to owner index. require(oldOwner != address(0) && oldOwner != SENTINEL_OWNERS, "Invalid owner address provided"); require(owners[prevOwner] == oldOwner, "Invalid prevOwner, owner pair provided"); owners[newOwner] = owners[oldOwner]; owners[prevOwner] = newOwner; owners[oldOwner] = address(0); emit RemovedOwner(oldOwner); emit AddedOwner(newOwner); } /// @dev Allows to update the number of required confirmations by Safe owners. /// This can only be done via a Safe transaction. /// @param _threshold New threshold. function changeThreshold(uint256 _threshold) public authorized { // Validate that threshold is smaller than number of owners. require(_threshold <= ownerCount, "Threshold cannot exceed owner count"); // There has to be at least one Safe owner. require(_threshold >= 1, "Threshold needs to be greater than 0"); threshold = _threshold; emit ChangedThreshold(threshold); } function getThreshold() public view returns (uint256) { return threshold; } function isOwner(address owner) public view returns (bool) { return owner != SENTINEL_OWNERS && owners[owner] != address(0); } /// @dev Returns array of owners. /// @return Array of Safe owners. function getOwners() public view returns (address[] memory) { address[] memory array = new address[](ownerCount); // populate return array uint256 index = 0; address currentOwner = owners[SENTINEL_OWNERS]; while(currentOwner != SENTINEL_OWNERS) { array[index] = currentOwner; currentOwner = owners[currentOwner]; index ++; } return array; } } /// @title Fallback Manager - A contract that manages fallback calls made to this contract /// @author Richard Meissner - <[email protected]> contract FallbackManager is SelfAuthorized { // keccak256("fallback_manager.handler.address") bytes32 internal constant FALLBACK_HANDLER_STORAGE_SLOT = 0x6c9a6c4a39284e37ed1cf53d337577d14212a4870fb976a4366c693b939918d5; function internalSetFallbackHandler(address handler) internal { bytes32 slot = FALLBACK_HANDLER_STORAGE_SLOT; // solium-disable-next-line security/no-inline-assembly assembly { sstore(slot, handler) } } /// @dev Allows to add a contract to handle fallback calls. /// Only fallback calls without value and with data will be forwarded. /// This can only be done via a Safe transaction. /// @param handler contract to handle fallbacks calls. function setFallbackHandler(address handler) public authorized { internalSetFallbackHandler(handler); } function () external payable { // Only calls without value and with data will be forwarded if (msg.value > 0 || msg.data.length == 0) { return; } bytes32 slot = FALLBACK_HANDLER_STORAGE_SLOT; address handler; // solium-disable-next-line security/no-inline-assembly assembly { handler := sload(slot) } if (handler != address(0)) { // solium-disable-next-line security/no-inline-assembly assembly { calldatacopy(0, 0, calldatasize()) let success := call(gas, handler, 0, 0, calldatasize(), 0, 0) returndatacopy(0, 0, returndatasize()) if eq(success, 0) { revert(0, returndatasize()) } return(0, returndatasize()) } } } } /// @title SignatureDecoder - Decodes signatures that a encoded as bytes /// @author Ricardo Guilherme Schmidt (Status Research & Development GmbH) /// @author Richard Meissner - <[email protected]> contract SignatureDecoder { /// @dev Recovers address who signed the message /// @param messageHash operation ethereum signed message hash /// @param messageSignature message `txHash` signature /// @param pos which signature to read function recoverKey ( bytes32 messageHash, bytes memory messageSignature, uint256 pos ) internal pure returns (address) { uint8 v; bytes32 r; bytes32 s; (v, r, s) = signatureSplit(messageSignature, pos); return ecrecover(messageHash, v, r, s); } /// @dev divides bytes signature into `uint8 v, bytes32 r, bytes32 s`. /// @notice Make sure to peform a bounds check for @param pos, to avoid out of bounds access on @param signatures /// @param pos which signature to read. A prior bounds check of this parameter should be performed, to avoid out of bounds access /// @param signatures concatenated rsv signatures function signatureSplit(bytes memory signatures, uint256 pos) internal pure returns (uint8 v, bytes32 r, bytes32 s) { // The signature format is a compact form of: // {bytes32 r}{bytes32 s}{uint8 v} // Compact means, uint8 is not padded to 32 bytes. // solium-disable-next-line security/no-inline-assembly assembly { let signaturePos := mul(0x41, pos) r := mload(add(signatures, add(signaturePos, 0x20))) s := mload(add(signatures, add(signaturePos, 0x40))) // Here we are loading the last 32 bytes, including 31 bytes // of 's'. There is no 'mload8' to do this. // // 'byte' is not working due to the Solidity parser, so lets // use the second best option, 'and' v := and(mload(add(signatures, add(signaturePos, 0x41))), 0xff) } } } contract ISignatureValidatorConstants { // bytes4(keccak256("isValidSignature(bytes,bytes)") bytes4 constant internal EIP1271_MAGIC_VALUE = 0x20c13b0b; } contract ISignatureValidator is ISignatureValidatorConstants { /** * @dev Should return whether the signature provided is valid for the provided data * @param _data Arbitrary length data signed on the behalf of address(this) * @param _signature Signature byte array associated with _data * * MUST return the bytes4 magic value 0x20c13b0b when function passes. * MUST NOT modify state (using STATICCALL for solc < 0.5, view modifier for solc > 0.5) * MUST allow external calls */ function isValidSignature( bytes memory _data, bytes memory _signature) public view returns (bytes4); } /** * @title SafeMath * @dev Math operations with safety checks that revert on error * TODO: remove once open zeppelin update to solc 0.5.0 */ library SafeMath { /** * @dev Multiplies two numbers, reverts on overflow. */ function mul(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { // Gas optimization: this is cheaper than requiring 'a' not being zero, but the // benefit is lost if 'b' is also tested. // See: https://github.com/OpenZeppelin/openzeppelin-solidity/pull/522 if (a == 0) { return 0; } uint256 c = a * b; require(c / a == b); return c; } /** * @dev Integer division of two numbers truncating the quotient, reverts on division by zero. */ function div(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { require(b > 0); // Solidity only automatically asserts when dividing by 0 uint256 c = a / b; // assert(a == b * c + a % b); // There is no case in which this doesn't hold return c; } /** * @dev Subtracts two numbers, reverts on overflow (i.e. if subtrahend is greater than minuend). */ function sub(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { require(b <= a); uint256 c = a - b; return c; } /** * @dev Adds two numbers, reverts on overflow. */ function add(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { uint256 c = a + b; require(c >= a); return c; } /** * @dev Divides two numbers and returns the remainder (unsigned integer modulo), * reverts when dividing by zero. */ function mod(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) { require(b != 0); return a % b; } } /// @title Gnosis Safe - A multisignature wallet with support for confirmations using signed messages based on ERC191. /// @author Stefan George - <[email protected]> /// @author Richard Meissner - <[email protected]> /// @author Ricardo Guilherme Schmidt - (Status Research & Development GmbH) - Gas Token Payment contract GnosisSafe is MasterCopy, ModuleManager, OwnerManager, SignatureDecoder, SecuredTokenTransfer, ISignatureValidatorConstants, FallbackManager { using SafeMath for uint256; string public constant NAME = "Gnosis Safe"; string public constant VERSION = "1.1.1"; //keccak256( // "EIP712Domain(address verifyingContract)" //); bytes32 private constant DOMAIN_SEPARATOR_TYPEHASH = 0x035aff83d86937d35b32e04f0ddc6ff469290eef2f1b692d8a815c89404d4749; //keccak256( // "SafeTx(address to,uint256 value,bytes data,uint8 operation,uint256 safeTxGas,uint256 baseGas,uint256 gasPrice,address gasToken,address refundReceiver,uint256 nonce)" //); bytes32 private constant SAFE_TX_TYPEHASH = 0xbb8310d486368db6bd6f849402fdd73ad53d316b5a4b2644ad6efe0f941286d8; //keccak256( // "SafeMessage(bytes message)" //); bytes32 private constant SAFE_MSG_TYPEHASH = 0x60b3cbf8b4a223d68d641b3b6ddf9a298e7f33710cf3d3a9d1146b5a6150fbca; event ApproveHash( bytes32 indexed approvedHash, address indexed owner ); event SignMsg( bytes32 indexed msgHash ); event ExecutionFailure( bytes32 txHash, uint256 payment ); event ExecutionSuccess( bytes32 txHash, uint256 payment ); uint256 public nonce; bytes32 public domainSeparator; // Mapping to keep track of all message hashes that have been approve by ALL REQUIRED owners mapping(bytes32 => uint256) public signedMessages; // Mapping to keep track of all hashes (message or transaction) that have been approve by ANY owners mapping(address => mapping(bytes32 => uint256)) public approvedHashes; // This constructor ensures that this contract can only be used as a master copy for Proxy contracts constructor() public { // By setting the threshold it is not possible to call setup anymore, // so we create a Safe with 0 owners and threshold 1. // This is an unusable Safe, perfect for the mastercopy threshold = 1; } /// @dev Setup function sets initial storage of contract. /// @param _owners List of Safe owners. /// @param _threshold Number of required confirmations for a Safe transaction. /// @param to Contract address for optional delegate call. /// @param data Data payload for optional delegate call. /// @param fallbackHandler Handler for fallback calls to this contract /// @param paymentToken Token that should be used for the payment (0 is ETH) /// @param payment Value that should be paid /// @param paymentReceiver Adddress that should receive the payment (or 0 if tx.origin) function setup( address[] calldata _owners, uint256 _threshold, address to, bytes calldata data, address fallbackHandler, address paymentToken, uint256 payment, address payable paymentReceiver ) external { require(domainSeparator == 0, "Domain Separator already set!"); domainSeparator = keccak256(abi.encode(DOMAIN_SEPARATOR_TYPEHASH, this)); setupOwners(_owners, _threshold); if (fallbackHandler != address(0)) internalSetFallbackHandler(fallbackHandler); // As setupOwners can only be called if the contract has not been initialized we don't need a check for setupModules setupModules(to, data); if (payment > 0) { // To avoid running into issues with EIP-170 we reuse the handlePayment function (to avoid adjusting code of that has been verified we do not adjust the method itself) // baseGas = 0, gasPrice = 1 and gas = payment => amount = (payment + 0) * 1 = payment handlePayment(payment, 0, 1, paymentToken, paymentReceiver); } } /// @dev Allows to execute a Safe transaction confirmed by required number of owners and then pays the account that submitted the transaction. /// Note: The fees are always transfered, even if the user transaction fails. /// @param to Destination address of Safe transaction. /// @param value Ether value of Safe transaction. /// @param data Data payload of Safe transaction. /// @param operation Operation type of Safe transaction. /// @param safeTxGas Gas that should be used for the Safe transaction. /// @param baseGas Gas costs for that are indipendent of the transaction execution(e.g. base transaction fee, signature check, payment of the refund) /// @param gasPrice Gas price that should be used for the payment calculation. /// @param gasToken Token address (or 0 if ETH) that is used for the payment. /// @param refundReceiver Address of receiver of gas payment (or 0 if tx.origin). /// @param signatures Packed signature data ({bytes32 r}{bytes32 s}{uint8 v}) function execTransaction( address to, uint256 value, bytes calldata data, Enum.Operation operation, uint256 safeTxGas, uint256 baseGas, uint256 gasPrice, address gasToken, address payable refundReceiver, bytes calldata signatures ) external returns (bool success) { bytes32 txHash; // Use scope here to limit variable lifetime and prevent `stack too deep` errors { bytes memory txHashData = encodeTransactionData( to, value, data, operation, // Transaction info safeTxGas, baseGas, gasPrice, gasToken, refundReceiver, // Payment info nonce ); // Increase nonce and execute transaction. nonce++; txHash = keccak256(txHashData); checkSignatures(txHash, txHashData, signatures, true); } require(gasleft() >= safeTxGas, "Not enough gas to execute safe transaction"); // Use scope here to limit variable lifetime and prevent `stack too deep` errors { uint256 gasUsed = gasleft(); // If no safeTxGas has been set and the gasPrice is 0 we assume that all available gas can be used success = execute(to, value, data, operation, safeTxGas == 0 && gasPrice == 0 ? gasleft() : safeTxGas); gasUsed = gasUsed.sub(gasleft()); // We transfer the calculated tx costs to the tx.origin to avoid sending it to intermediate contracts that have made calls uint256 payment = 0; if (gasPrice > 0) { payment = handlePayment(gasUsed, baseGas, gasPrice, gasToken, refundReceiver); } if (success) emit ExecutionSuccess(txHash, payment); else emit ExecutionFailure(txHash, payment); } } function handlePayment( uint256 gasUsed, uint256 baseGas, uint256 gasPrice, address gasToken, address payable refundReceiver ) private returns (uint256 payment) { // solium-disable-next-line security/no-tx-origin address payable receiver = refundReceiver == address(0) ? tx.origin : refundReceiver; if (gasToken == address(0)) { // For ETH we will only adjust the gas price to not be higher than the actual used gas price payment = gasUsed.add(baseGas).mul(gasPrice < tx.gasprice ? gasPrice : tx.gasprice); // solium-disable-next-line security/no-send require(receiver.send(payment), "Could not pay gas costs with ether"); } else { payment = gasUsed.add(baseGas).mul(gasPrice); require(transferToken(gasToken, receiver, payment), "Could not pay gas costs with token"); } } /** * @dev Checks whether the signature provided is valid for the provided data, hash. Will revert otherwise. * @param dataHash Hash of the data (could be either a message hash or transaction hash) * @param data That should be signed (this is passed to an external validator contract) * @param signatures Signature data that should be verified. Can be ECDSA signature, contract signature (EIP-1271) or approved hash. * @param consumeHash Indicates that in case of an approved hash the storage can be freed to save gas */ function checkSignatures(bytes32 dataHash, bytes memory data, bytes memory signatures, bool consumeHash) internal { // Load threshold to avoid multiple storage loads uint256 _threshold = threshold; // Check that a threshold is set require(_threshold > 0, "Threshold needs to be defined!"); // Check that the provided signature data is not too short require(signatures.length >= _threshold.mul(65), "Signatures data too short"); // There cannot be an owner with address 0. address lastOwner = address(0); address currentOwner; uint8 v; bytes32 r; bytes32 s; uint256 i; for (i = 0; i < _threshold; i++) { (v, r, s) = signatureSplit(signatures, i); // If v is 0 then it is a contract signature if (v == 0) { // When handling contract signatures the address of the contract is encoded into r currentOwner = address(uint256(r)); // Check that signature data pointer (s) is not pointing inside the static part of the signatures bytes // This check is not completely accurate, since it is possible that more signatures than the threshold are send. // Here we only check that the pointer is not pointing inside the part that is being processed require(uint256(s) >= _threshold.mul(65), "Invalid contract signature location: inside static part"); // Check that signature data pointer (s) is in bounds (points to the length of data -> 32 bytes) require(uint256(s).add(32) <= signatures.length, "Invalid contract signature location: length not present"); // Check if the contract signature is in bounds: start of data is s + 32 and end is start + signature length uint256 contractSignatureLen; // solium-disable-next-line security/no-inline-assembly assembly { contractSignatureLen := mload(add(add(signatures, s), 0x20)) } require(uint256(s).add(32).add(contractSignatureLen) <= signatures.length, "Invalid contract signature location: data not complete"); // Check signature bytes memory contractSignature; // solium-disable-next-line security/no-inline-assembly assembly { // The signature data for contract signatures is appended to the concatenated signatures and the offset is stored in s contractSignature := add(add(signatures, s), 0x20) } require(ISignatureValidator(currentOwner).isValidSignature(data, contractSignature) == EIP1271_MAGIC_VALUE, "Invalid contract signature provided"); // If v is 1 then it is an approved hash } else if (v == 1) { // When handling approved hashes the address of the approver is encoded into r currentOwner = address(uint256(r)); // Hashes are automatically approved by the sender of the message or when they have been pre-approved via a separate transaction require(msg.sender == currentOwner || approvedHashes[currentOwner][dataHash] != 0, "Hash has not been approved"); // Hash has been marked for consumption. If this hash was pre-approved free storage if (consumeHash && msg.sender != currentOwner) { approvedHashes[currentOwner][dataHash] = 0; } } else if (v > 30) { // To support eth_sign and similar we adjust v and hash the messageHash with the Ethereum message prefix before applying ecrecover currentOwner = ecrecover(keccak256(abi.encodePacked("\x19Ethereum Signed Message:\n32", dataHash)), v - 4, r, s); } else { // Use ecrecover with the messageHash for EOA signatures currentOwner = ecrecover(dataHash, v, r, s); } require ( currentOwner > lastOwner && owners[currentOwner] != address(0) && currentOwner != SENTINEL_OWNERS, "Invalid owner provided" ); lastOwner = currentOwner; } } /// @dev Allows to estimate a Safe transaction. /// This method is only meant for estimation purpose, therefore two different protection mechanism against execution in a transaction have been made: /// 1.) The method can only be called from the safe itself /// 2.) The response is returned with a revert /// When estimating set `from` to the address of the safe. /// Since the `estimateGas` function includes refunds, call this method to get an estimated of the costs that are deducted from the safe with `execTransaction` /// @param to Destination address of Safe transaction. /// @param value Ether value of Safe transaction. /// @param data Data payload of Safe transaction. /// @param operation Operation type of Safe transaction. /// @return Estimate without refunds and overhead fees (base transaction and payload data gas costs). function requiredTxGas(address to, uint256 value, bytes calldata data, Enum.Operation operation) external authorized returns (uint256) { uint256 startGas = gasleft(); // We don't provide an error message here, as we use it to return the estimate // solium-disable-next-line error-reason require(execute(to, value, data, operation, gasleft())); uint256 requiredGas = startGas - gasleft(); // Convert response to string and return via error message revert(string(abi.encodePacked(requiredGas))); } /** * @dev Marks a hash as approved. This can be used to validate a hash that is used by a signature. * @param hashToApprove The hash that should be marked as approved for signatures that are verified by this contract. */ function approveHash(bytes32 hashToApprove) external { require(owners[msg.sender] != address(0), "Only owners can approve a hash"); approvedHashes[msg.sender][hashToApprove] = 1; emit ApproveHash(hashToApprove, msg.sender); } /** * @dev Marks a message as signed * @param _data Arbitrary length data that should be marked as signed on the behalf of address(this) */ function signMessage(bytes calldata _data) external authorized { bytes32 msgHash = getMessageHash(_data); signedMessages[msgHash] = 1; emit SignMsg(msgHash); } /** * Implementation of ISignatureValidator (see `interfaces/ISignatureValidator.sol`) * @dev Should return whether the signature provided is valid for the provided data. * The save does not implement the interface since `checkSignatures` is not a view method. * The method will not perform any state changes (see parameters of `checkSignatures`) * @param _data Arbitrary length data signed on the behalf of address(this) * @param _signature Signature byte array associated with _data * @return a bool upon valid or invalid signature with corresponding _data */ function isValidSignature(bytes calldata _data, bytes calldata _signature) external returns (bytes4) { bytes32 messageHash = getMessageHash(_data); if (_signature.length == 0) { require(signedMessages[messageHash] != 0, "Hash not approved"); } else { // consumeHash needs to be false, as the state should not be changed checkSignatures(messageHash, _data, _signature, false); } return EIP1271_MAGIC_VALUE; } /// @dev Returns hash of a message that can be signed by owners. /// @param message Message that should be hashed /// @return Message hash. function getMessageHash( bytes memory message ) public view returns (bytes32) { bytes32 safeMessageHash = keccak256( abi.encode(SAFE_MSG_TYPEHASH, keccak256(message)) ); return keccak256( abi.encodePacked(byte(0x19), byte(0x01), domainSeparator, safeMessageHash) ); } /// @dev Returns the bytes that are hashed to be signed by owners. /// @param to Destination address. /// @param value Ether value. /// @param data Data payload. /// @param operation Operation type. /// @param safeTxGas Fas that should be used for the safe transaction. /// @param baseGas Gas costs for data used to trigger the safe transaction. /// @param gasPrice Maximum gas price that should be used for this transaction. /// @param gasToken Token address (or 0 if ETH) that is used for the payment. /// @param refundReceiver Address of receiver of gas payment (or 0 if tx.origin). /// @param _nonce Transaction nonce. /// @return Transaction hash bytes. function encodeTransactionData( address to, uint256 value, bytes memory data, Enum.Operation operation, uint256 safeTxGas, uint256 baseGas, uint256 gasPrice, address gasToken, address refundReceiver, uint256 _nonce ) public view returns (bytes memory) { bytes32 safeTxHash = keccak256( abi.encode(SAFE_TX_TYPEHASH, to, value, keccak256(data), operation, safeTxGas, baseGas, gasPrice, gasToken, refundReceiver, _nonce) ); return abi.encodePacked(byte(0x19), byte(0x01), domainSeparator, safeTxHash); } /// @dev Returns hash to be signed by owners. /// @param to Destination address. /// @param value Ether value. /// @param data Data payload. /// @param operation Operation type. /// @param safeTxGas Fas that should be used for the safe transaction. /// @param baseGas Gas costs for data used to trigger the safe transaction. /// @param gasPrice Maximum gas price that should be used for this transaction. /// @param gasToken Token address (or 0 if ETH) that is used for the payment. /// @param refundReceiver Address of receiver of gas payment (or 0 if tx.origin). /// @param _nonce Transaction nonce. /// @return Transaction hash. function getTransactionHash( address to, uint256 value, bytes memory data, Enum.Operation operation, uint256 safeTxGas, uint256 baseGas, uint256 gasPrice, address gasToken, address refundReceiver, uint256 _nonce ) public view returns (bytes32) { return keccak256(encodeTransactionData(to, value, data, operation, safeTxGas, baseGas, gasPrice, gasToken, refundReceiver, _nonce)); } }